US20140363491A1 - Novel liposome compositions - Google Patents

Novel liposome compositions Download PDF

Info

Publication number
US20140363491A1
US20140363491A1 US14/274,377 US201414274377A US2014363491A1 US 20140363491 A1 US20140363491 A1 US 20140363491A1 US 201414274377 A US201414274377 A US 201414274377A US 2014363491 A1 US2014363491 A1 US 2014363491A1
Authority
US
United States
Prior art keywords
lipid
liposome
drug
dicarboxylic acid
phosphatidyl ethanolamine
Prior art date
Legal status (The legal status is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the status listed.)
Abandoned
Application number
US14/274,377
Inventor
Kazushi Okada
Tadayuki Ibuki
Donghyun Kim
Tadashi Fujisawa
Current Assignee (The listed assignees may be inaccurate. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation or warranty as to the accuracy of the list.)
Mebiopharm Co Ltd
Original Assignee
Mebiopharm Co Ltd
Priority date (The priority date is an assumption and is not a legal conclusion. Google has not performed a legal analysis and makes no representation as to the accuracy of the date listed.)
Filing date
Publication date
Application filed by Mebiopharm Co Ltd filed Critical Mebiopharm Co Ltd
Priority to US14/274,377 priority Critical patent/US20140363491A1/en
Assigned to MEBIOPHARM CO., LTD. reassignment MEBIOPHARM CO., LTD. ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST (SEE DOCUMENT FOR DETAILS). Assignors: FUJISAWA, TADASHI, IBUKI, TADAYUKI, KIM, DONGHYUN, OKADA, KAZUSHI
Publication of US20140363491A1 publication Critical patent/US20140363491A1/en
Abandoned legal-status Critical Current

Links

Images

Classifications

    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/10Dispersions; Emulsions
    • A61K9/127Liposomes
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K9/00Medicinal preparations characterised by special physical form
    • A61K9/10Dispersions; Emulsions
    • A61K9/127Liposomes
    • A61K9/1271Non-conventional liposomes, e.g. PEGylated liposomes, liposomes coated with polymers
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K31/00Medicinal preparations containing organic active ingredients
    • A61K31/28Compounds containing heavy metals
    • A61K31/282Platinum compounds
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61KPREPARATIONS FOR MEDICAL, DENTAL OR TOILETRY PURPOSES
    • A61K47/00Medicinal preparations characterised by the non-active ingredients used, e.g. carriers or inert additives; Targeting or modifying agents chemically bound to the active ingredient
    • A61K47/30Macromolecular organic or inorganic compounds, e.g. inorganic polyphosphates
    • A61K47/42Proteins; Polypeptides; Degradation products thereof; Derivatives thereof, e.g. albumin, gelatin or zein
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P35/00Antineoplastic agents
    • AHUMAN NECESSITIES
    • A61MEDICAL OR VETERINARY SCIENCE; HYGIENE
    • A61PSPECIFIC THERAPEUTIC ACTIVITY OF CHEMICAL COMPOUNDS OR MEDICINAL PREPARATIONS
    • A61P43/00Drugs for specific purposes, not provided for in groups A61P1/00-A61P41/00

Definitions

  • treatment regimens require the use of drugs with deleterious side effects, including, for example, alopecia, nausea, vomiting, tiredness, etc.
  • Some treatment regimens may also entail the use of drugs that are not stable under physiological conditions, for example, bio-therapeutics (e.g., genes or gene products) and/or other drugs that are easily degraded or otherwise altered upon administration and thereby loose their effectiveness before achieving the desired therapeutic result.
  • bio-therapeutics e.g., genes or gene products
  • Such instability also makes the drugs more difficult and costly to store and prepare for administration.
  • Anticancer agents may be classified according to several criteria, such as class of compound and disease state treated. Certain agents have been developed to take advantage of the rapid division of cancer cells and target specific phases in the cell cycle, providing another method of classification. Agents can also be grouped according to the type and severity of their side effects or method of delivery. However, the most common classification of non-biotherapeutic based anticancer agents is by class of chemical compound, which broadly encompasses the mechanism of action of these compounds.
  • anticancer agents Depending on the reference source consulted, there are slight differences in the classification of anticancer agents.
  • the classes of compounds are described in the Physician's Desk Reference as follows: alkaloids; alkylating agents; anti-tumor antibiotics; antimetabolites; hormones and hormone analogs; immunomodulators; photosensitizing agents; and miscellaneous other agents.
  • the alkaloid class of compounds may also be referred to as mitotic inhibitors, as they are cell cycle phase specific and serve to inhibit mitosis or inhibit the enzymes required for mitosis. They are derived generally from plant alkaloids and other natural products and work during the M-phase of the cell cycle. This class of compounds is often used to treat neoplasias such as acute lymphoblastic leukemia, Hodgkin's and non-Hodgkin's lymphoma; neuroblastomas and cancers of the lung, breast and testes.
  • mitotic inhibitors are cell cycle phase specific and serve to inhibit mitosis or inhibit the enzymes required for mitosis. They are derived generally from plant alkaloids and other natural products and work during the M-phase of the cell cycle. This class of compounds is often used to treat neoplasias such as acute lymphoblastic leukemia, Hodgkin's and non-Hodgkin's lymphoma; neuroblastomas and cancers of the lung, breast
  • Alkylating agents make up a large class of chemotherapeutic agents, including of the following sub-classes, which each represent a number of individual drugs: alkyl sulfonates; aziridines; ethylenimines and methylmelamines; nitrogen mustards; nitrosoureas; and others, including platinum compounds.
  • Alkylating agents attack neoplastic cells by directly alkylating the DNA of cells and therefore causing the DNA to be replication incompetent. This class of compounds is commonly used to treat a variety of diseases, including chronic leukemias, non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, Hodgkin's lymphoma, multiple myeloma and certain lung, breast and ovarian cancers.
  • Nitrosoureas are often categorized as alkylating agents, and have a similar mechanism of action, but instead of directly alkylating DNA, they inhibit DNA repair enzymes causing replication failure. These compounds have the advantage of being able to cross the blood-brain barrier and therefore can be used to treat brain tumors.
  • Antitumor antibiotics have antimicrobial and cytotoxic activity and also interfere with DNA by chemically inhibiting enzymes and mitosis or by altering cell membranes. They are not cell cycle phase specific and are widely used to treat a variety of cancers.
  • the antimetabolite class of anticancer agents interfere with the growth of DNA and RNA and are specific to the S-phase of the cell-cycle. They can be broken down further by type of compound, which include folic acid analogs, purine analogs, and pyrimidine analogs. They are often employed in the treatment of chronic leukemia, breast, ovary, and gastrointestinal tumors.
  • corticosteroid hormones There are two classes of hormones or hormone analogs used as anticancer agents, the corticosteroid hormones and sex hormones. While some corticosteroid hormones can both kill cancer cells and slow the growth of tumors, and are used in the treatment of lymphoma, leukemias, etc., sex hormones function primarily to slow the growth of breast, prostate and endometrial cancers. There are numerous subclasses of hormones and hormone analogs, including, androgens, antiadrenals, antiandrogens, antiestrogens, aromatase inhibitors, estrogens, leutenizing hormone releasing hormone (LHRH) analogs and progestins.
  • LHRH leutenizing hormone releasing hormone
  • An additional smaller class of anticancer agents is classified as immunotherapy. These are agents that are intended to stimulate the immune system to more effectively attack the neoplastic (cancerous) cells. This therapy is often used in combination with other therapies.
  • campothectins which are generally listed as ‘other’ anticancer agents and can be used to treat a variety of neoplasias.
  • Combinations of anticancer agents are also utilized in the treatment of a number of cancers.
  • Sanofi Syntholabo markets ELOXATINTM (oxaliplatin for injection) for the treatment of colorectal cancer for use in combination with 5-fluorouracil and leuvocorin.
  • ELOXATINTM oxaliplatin for injection
  • Oxaliplatin is an alkylating agent that is believed to act by inhibiting both DNA replication and transcription. Unlike other platinum agents, oxaliplatin has demonstrated a decreased likelihood of resistance development. Oxaliplatin is further described in U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • the therapeutic index describes the balance between the required dose to accomplish the destruction of the cancer cells compared to the dose at which the substance is unacceptably toxic to the individual.
  • the drawback to most anticancer agents is the relatively small range of the therapeutic index, (i.e., the narrow dosage range in which cancer cells are destroyed without unacceptable toxicity to the individual). This characteristic limits the frequency and dosage where an agent is useful, and often the side effects become intolerable before the cancer can be fully eradicated.
  • hair loss alopecia
  • appetite loss alopecia
  • weight loss alopecia
  • taste changes stomatitis and esophagitis (inflammation and sores); constipation; diarrhea; fatigue; heart damage; nervous system changes; lung damage; reproductive tissue damage; liver damage; kidney and urinary system damage.
  • Liposomes are formed when phospholipids and their derivatives are dispersed in water. Upon dispersion in water the phospholipids form closed vesicles called “liposomes”, which are characterized by lipid bilayers encapsulating an aqueous core.
  • Various liposomes have been used as carriers for entrapped therapeutic agents, such as drugs, enzymes and genetic sequences for use in medical science, in pharmaceutical science and in biochemistry.
  • liposome compositions include U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,983,397; 6,476,068; 5,834,012; 5,756,069; 6,387,397; 5,534,241; 4,789,633; 4,925,661; 6,153,596; 6,057,299; 5,648,478; 6,723,338; 6,627218; U.S. Pat. App.
  • liposomes that were modified by the incorporation of polyethylene glycol or other hydrophilic polymers (e.g., a PEG liposome where one or more of the constituent lipids was modified by attachment of PEG). PEG-modified liposomes were also often referred to as “shielded” liposomes.
  • DoxilTM doxorubicin HCl liposome injection
  • PEG adjunct polyethylene glycol
  • liposomes examples include U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,983,397; 5,013,556; 6,316,024; 6,056,973; 5,945,122; 5,891,468; 6,126,966; 5,593,622, 5,676,971; 6,586,559; and 5,846,458 U.S. Pat. App. Publication. Nos. 2003/0224037; 2004/0022842; 2003/0113262; 2002/0136707; International Patent Applications WO 99/30686; WO 02/41870 Alimi ⁇ ana et al., Prep. Biochem. Biotech . (2004) 34(1): 77-96. Liposomes are also described in U.S. Pat. Nos.
  • liposomes that aimed to specifically target particular cell types by incorporating targeting factors (also referred to as targeting ligands) for particular cell types.
  • targeting factors also referred to as targeting ligands
  • targeting factors/ligands include asialoglycoprotein, folate, transferrin, antibodies, etc.
  • one or more of the constituent lipids could be modified by the attachment of a targeting factor.
  • lipid compositions including targeting factors include U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,049,390; 5,780,052; 5,786,214; 6,316,024; 6,056,973; 6,245,427; 6,524,613; 6,749,863; 6,177,059; 6,530,944; U.S. Pat. App. Publication. Nos. 2004/0022842; 2003/0224037; 2003/143742; 2003/0228285; 2002/0198164; 2003/0220284; 2003/0165934; 2003/0027779; International Patent Application Nos.
  • Iinuma et al. developed a Tf-PEG-liposome, with transferrin (Tf) attached at the surface of the liposome.
  • Tf transferrin
  • Iinuma et al. showed that a greater number of liposomes were bound to the surface of the tumor cells, and there was a greater uptake of liposomes by the tumor cells for Tf-PEG-liposome as compared to PEG-liposome (Inuma et al., ibid; Ishida et al., ibid).
  • liposome compositions for the delivery of drugs and labeled compounds to specific cells and/or tissues that achieve a therapeutic or diagnostic effect.
  • drug formulations with improved specificity and reduced toxicity are need to ensure therapeutic benefit without adversely effecting healthy cells and which also do not result in deleterious side effects for the individual being treated.
  • labeled compounds that can be used to detect conditions, particularly life-threatening conditions at an early stage (e.g., with high specificity and/or high sensitivity) and also accurately monitor the severity/extent of the condition (e.g., progression and/or regression with or without treatment) would also significantly improve the quality and success of therapy.
  • the present invention relates to novel lipid-containing compositions (including liposomes (e.g., targeted liposomes, blank liposomes), lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions) that may optionally incorporate a drug or labeled compound, or may be used in the preparation of formulations that incorporate a drug or labeled compound, where the lipid-containing composition confers the benefit of reducing side effects from the drug or labeled compound and/or also prevents degradation and/or loss of efficacy of the drug or labeled compound.
  • the invention also includes methods of making and using the lipid-containing compositions described herein.
  • the lipid-containing compositions may be used to treat or diagnose cancer (e.g., breast cancer, gastric cancer, colorectal cancer, colon cancer, cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovarian cancer, or hematological malignancies (e.g., leukemia, lymphoma, multiple myeloma, etc.).
  • cancer e.g., breast cancer, gastric cancer, colorectal cancer, colon cancer, cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovarian cancer, or hematological malignancies (e.g., leukemia, lymphoma, multiple myeloma, etc.).
  • cancer e.g., breast cancer, gastric cancer, colorectal cancer, colon cancer, cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer
  • targeted liposomes comprising one or more phospholipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, an encapsulated drug or labeled compound and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • blank liposomes comprising one or more phospholipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid
  • the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, and m and p are 3.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC, and the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl, m and p are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC and the additional lipid is cholesterol.
  • m and p are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and p are equal and are 3. In certain embodiments, R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R 1 and are R 2 are the same, and R 5 and R 6 are the same. In other embodiments, R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are the same. In particular embodiments, R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl.
  • lipid mixtures comprising a mixture of one or more phospholipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • m and n are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and n are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and n are equal and are 3.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl.
  • R 1 and are R 2 are the same, and R 3 and R 4 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl or stearoyl.
  • m and n are 3, where the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC and the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl
  • m and n are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC and the additional lipid is cholesterol.
  • lipid mixtures comprising a mixture of one or more phospholipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • m and p are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In certain embodiments, m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and p are equal and are 3.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl.
  • R 1 and are R 2 are the same, and R 5 and R 6 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl or stearoyl.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, m and p are 3, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC, the at least one additional lipid is cholesterol, and the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl, m and p are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC, the additional lipid is cholesterol and the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • liposome-containing compositions comprising liposomes comprising one or more phospholipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • m and n are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In certain embodiments, m and n are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and n are equal are 3.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl.
  • R 1 and are R 2 are the same, and R 3 and R 4 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl or stearoyl.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl or stearoyl, and m and n are 3 and the one or more phospholipids is DMPC, DSPC, POPC or DPPC.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R4 6 are oleoyl, m and n are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC and the additional lipid is cholesterol.
  • liposome-containing compositions comprising liposomes comprising one or more phospholipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • m and p are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and p are equal are 3.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl.
  • R 1 and are R 2 are the same, and R 5 and R 6 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl or stearoyl.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC, the at least one additional lipid cholesterol, and the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl, m and p are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC, the additional lipid is cholesterol and the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • the liposome-containing compositions a drug is included.
  • the one or more phospholipid is DMPC or DSPC, R 1 , R 2 and, where present, R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, m and, where present, p are 3, the at least one additional lipid, where present, is cholesterol, the drug is oxaliplatin, and the targeting ligand, where present, is transferrin.
  • the composition further includes a sugar at a concentration of from about 1 to about 20% percent sugar (v/v).
  • the one or more phospholipid is DMPC or DSPC, R 1 , R 2 and, where present, R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl, m and, where present, p are 3, the at least one additional lipid, where present, is cholesterol, the drug is oxaliplatin, and the targeting ligand, where present, is transferrin.
  • a labeled compound is included.
  • the labeled compound comprises a radioisotopic moiety.
  • the at least one additional lipid is present.
  • the at least one additional lipid is cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative.
  • the one or more phospholipids is a phosphatidylcholine, phosphatidic acid, phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylglycerol.
  • the one or more phospholipids is a neutral phospholipid.
  • the one or more phospholipids is a phosphatidylcholine.
  • the phosphatidyl choline includes a moiety of a saturated fatty acid.
  • the one or more phospholipids is DMPC, DSPC, POPC or DPPC.
  • the at least one additional lipid is present.
  • the at least one additional lipid is cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative.
  • DMPC and cholesterol, DSPC and cholesterol, POPC and cholesterol, or DPPC and cholesterol are incorporated.
  • DMPC and cholesterol are incorporated.
  • targeting ligand is directed to a target cell.
  • the targeting ligand is directed to a cell surface receptor of a target cell.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid, a sugar chain or a fragment of a monoclonal antibody.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid or a sugar chain.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid or a sugar chain.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid or a sugar chain.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • the transferrin is in a holo-form but not in an apo-form.
  • the transferrin is in a holo-form.
  • the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 50 nm to about 250 nm. In others, the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 90 nm to about 200 nm.
  • the zeta potential of the liposome is negative.
  • the zeta potential is from about ⁇ 75 mV to about ⁇ 90 mV. In others, the zeta potential is from about ⁇ 80 mV to about ⁇ 85 mV.
  • the formulations further include a solution.
  • the drug is present.
  • the drug is oxaliplatin.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol.
  • the drug is an anticancer agent.
  • the drug is a cytotoxic drug.
  • the drug is a topoisomerase I inhibitor.
  • the topoisomerase I inhibitor is topotecan or irinotecan.
  • the drug is a vinca alkaloid.
  • the vinca alkaloid is vincristine, vinblastine, vinleurosine, vinrodisine, vinorelbine or vindesine.
  • the drug is a nucleic acid.
  • the nucleic acid is an antisense oligonucleotide or a ribozyme.
  • the drug is an alkylating agent. In particular embodiments, the drug is a taxanes. In other embodiments, the drug is a metabolic antagonist. In certain embodiments, the drug is an antitumour antibiotic. In some embodiments, the drug is a hormone therapy drug. In some embodiments, the drug is a molecular target drug.
  • the drug is a platinum compound.
  • the platinum compound is biplatin, cisplatin, carboplatin, ormaplatin, oxaliplatin, zeniplatin, enloplatin, lobaplatin or spiroplatin.
  • the platinum compound is oxaliplatin.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC, and the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC, and the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol.
  • the targeted liposomes and liposome-containing compositions are free of other lipid components.
  • the oxaliplatin is dissolved in an aqueous solution of a sugar selected from the group consisting of trehalose, maltose, sucrose, mannose, lactose, mannitol, glycerol and dextrose.
  • the sugar is at a concentration of from about 1 to about 20% percent sugar (v/v).
  • the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 25 mg/ml within the liposome.
  • the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 10 mg/ml within the liposome.
  • the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml.
  • the labeled compound is present.
  • the labeled compound includes a radioisotopic moiety.
  • the radioisotopic moiety incorporates 125 I.
  • the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome is from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 3.0 mg/ml. In others, the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome is from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.5 mg/ml.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • the transferrin is in a holo-form.
  • ferric iron is in a concentration of from about 0.4 to about 3.0 ⁇ g/ml. In other embodiments, ferric iron is in a concentration of from about 0.4 to about 1.5 ⁇ g/ml.
  • the liposomes, lipid mixtures or liposome-containing composition does not comprise a cationic lipid.
  • the liposomes, lipid mixtures or liposome-containing composition do not comprise an anionic lipid.
  • the liposomes, lipid liposome, lipid mixtures or liposome-containing composition do not comprise either an anionic lipid or a cationic lipid.
  • the formulations further include a solution.
  • the lipid mixtures are free of solution.
  • the solution is an aqueous solution or a mixture of an aqueous solution and a water-miscible solvent.
  • the formulations further include sucrose.
  • compositions described herein are provided pharmaceutical formulations of the lipid-containing compositions described herein.
  • Particular embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes and blank liposomes include the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes or blank liposomes as described herein and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives.
  • kits including the lipid-containing compositions described herein.
  • Certain embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes and blank liposomes include the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes or blank liposomes as described herein, packaging and instructions for use.
  • the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes or blank liposomes as described herein is contained in a first container and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives are contained in a second container.
  • kits incorporating the pharmaceutical formulations described herein, packaging and instructions for use.
  • step (a) adding a drug or labeled compound to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • step (d) purifying the liposome of step (c).
  • the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing.
  • step (c) comprises sonication or stirring.
  • step (c) comprises extrusion.
  • lipid mixture a) mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, the at least one additional lipid, to form a lipid mixture
  • succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • step (a) adding drug or labeled compound to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • the method also includes a step (e), purifying the liposome of step (d).
  • step (b) the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing.
  • step (c) comprises sonication or stirring.
  • step (c) comprises extrusion.
  • step (c) comprises stirring.
  • the method further comprises a step (c), purifying the liposome of step (b).
  • step (b) comprises sonication or stirring. In some embodiments, step (b) comprises extrusion.
  • succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • the methods further include a step (d), purifying the liposome of step (c).
  • step (b) comprises sonication or stirring. In some embodiments, step (b) comprises extrusion.
  • methods of making the lipid-containing compositions as described herein comprising the step of mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • methods of making the lipid-containing compositions where the at least one additional lipid is present comprising the step of mixing the one or more phospholipids, the at least one additional lipid, the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • methods of making the lipid-containing compositions as described herein comprising the step of mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • methods of making the lipid-containing compositions, where the at least one additional lipid is present comprising the step of mixing the one or more phospholipids, the at least one additional lipid, the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • step (a) adding a drug to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • aqueous solution In certain embodiments of the methods of making the various lipid-containing compositions (targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposome-containing compositions), where a drug is present, the drug is in an aqueous solution.
  • step a) is performed in the presence of organic solvent.
  • aqueous solution further comprises a sugar.
  • the aqueous solution may also include a water-miscible organic solvent.
  • step (a) adding a labeled compound to the lipid mixture formed in step (a).
  • the labeled compound is in an aqueous solution.
  • step a) is performed in the presence of organic solvent.
  • the aqueous solution may also include a water-miscible organic solvent.
  • liposome-containing compositions as described herein, wherein the liposome-containing composition includes a targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, comprising the steps of
  • step (b) adding solvent to the mixture formed in step (a) to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • the mixing step (a) is performed in the presence of an organic solvent.
  • the solvent in step (b) is an aqueous solution or a mixture of aqueous solution and a water-miscible solvent.
  • step (b) comprises sonication or stirring. In some embodiments, step (b) comprises extrusion.
  • step (a) in step (a) the at least one additional lipid is present.
  • step (a) in step (a) the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present.
  • the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present.
  • methods for treating cancer comprising, a) administering a targeted liposome as described herein to an individual in need thereof in an amount effective to treat cancer, wherein the targeted liposome comprises a drug, and the drug is an anticancer agent.
  • the individual is a mammal. In particular embodiments, the individual is a human.
  • the cancer is breast, gastric, colon, colorectal cancer, cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovary cancer, or a hematological malignancies.
  • step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after combined modality cancer therapy.
  • the combined modality cancer therapy comprises chemotherapy, radiation therapy, or surgery.
  • step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after adjunctive cancer therapy.
  • the adjunctive cancer therapy comprises administration of one or more agents to reduce hair loss, vomiting, immune suppression, nausea, diarrhea, rash, sensory disturbance, anemia, fatigue, stomatitis, or hand foot syndrome.
  • step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after administration of one or more additional anticancer agents.
  • the one or more additional anticancer agents comprise 5-fluorouracil, leucovorin, capecitabine, UFT/LV (tegafur-uracil and leucovorin), irinotecan, an-anti EGFR antibody, an anti-VEGF antibody, a tyrosine kinase inhibitor, or combinations thereof.
  • the targeted liposome is administered via parenteral administration.
  • the parenteral administration is via injection or intravenous infusion.
  • Also provided are methods of diagnosis comprising the steps of
  • the methods further comprise a step (c), comparing a level of labeled compound detected with the amount of labeled compound detected at a previous point in time.
  • step (b) comprises detection via a gamma counter.
  • N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines where the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • p is an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, p is 3.
  • R 5 and R 6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In particular embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are the same. In some embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl and p is 3.
  • a pharmaceutical formulations comprising the transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines as described herein and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives.
  • lipid mixtures comprising a mixture of at least two different neutral lipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are each, independently, an acyl group, m and n are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the mixture does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol.
  • liposome-containing compositions comprising at least two different neutral lipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are each, independently, an acyl group; m and n are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the mixture does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol.
  • m and n are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In certain embodiments, m and n are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In other embodiments, m and n are equal and are 3.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl.
  • R 1 and are R 2 are the same, and R 3 and R 4 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl
  • the molar ratio of neutral lipids:N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine:succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is about 95:4:1.
  • the molar ratio of DMPC:cholesterol:(N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine+succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine) is 50:45:5.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NHS-NG-DOPE.
  • targeted liposomes comprising at least two different neutral lipids, a N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and, wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are each, independently, an acyl group, and m and p are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the liposome does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol, and wherein the targeting ligand is not an intact antibody.
  • targeted liposome comprising a neutral phosphatidyl choline, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and encapsulated oxaliplatin, wherein the transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises transferrin linked by a carboxylic acid amide bond to a second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2
  • the second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are each, independently, an acyl group, and m and p are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the liposome does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol.
  • the targeted liposome is substantially free of EDC and/or DCC.
  • m and p are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and p are equal are 3.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl.
  • R 1 and are R 2 are the same, and R 5 and R 6 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 5 and R 6 are the same.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl or stearoyl.
  • R 1 , R 2 , R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl.
  • the targeting ligand is directed to a target cell.
  • the targeting ligand is directed to a cell surface receptor of a target cell.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid, a sugar chain or a fragment of a monoclonal antibody.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid or a sugar chain.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin. In some of these embodiments, the transferrin is in a holo-form but not in an apo-form. In other embodiments, the transferring is in an apo-form.
  • the formulations do not comprise an anionic lipid. In some embodiments, the formulations do not comprise a cationic lipid. In some embodiments, the formulations do not comprise a cationic lipid or an anionic lipid. In certain embodiments, the formulation do not comprise a phosphatidyl glycerol or derivative thereof. In particular embodiments, the formulations do not comprise egg phosphatidylcholine.
  • the at least two different neutral lipids are one or more phospholipids and cholesterol or a cholesterol derivatives. In some embodiments, at least one of the at least two different neutral lipids is a phospholipid. In certain embodiments of the lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, the at least two different neutral lipids are a phosphatidyl choline and cholesterol. In particular embodiments, one of the at least two different neutral lipids is DMPC, DSPC or DPPC. In some of the embodiments, one of the at least two different neutral lipids is cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative. In particular embodiments, the at least two different neutral lipids are DMPC and cholesterol, DSPC and cholesterol, or DPPC and cholesterol. In particular embodiments, the at least two different neutral lipids are DMPC and cholesterol.
  • the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 50 nm to about 250 nm. In certain embodiments, the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 90 nm to about 200 nm. In particular embodiments, the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 100 nm to about 140 nm.
  • the zeta potential of the liposome is negative.
  • the zeta potential is from about ⁇ 75 mV to about ⁇ 90 mV.
  • the zeta potential is from about ⁇ 80 mV to about ⁇ 85 mV.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE (where NG-DOPE is equivalent to R 1 and R 2 being oleoyl and m being 3) and, where present, the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NHS-NG-DOPE (where NHS-NG-DOPE is equivalent to R 3 and R 4 being oleoyl and n being 3) or, where present the targeting-factor modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DOPE (where TF-NG-DOPE is equivalent to R 5 and R 6 being oleoyl and p being 3).
  • the formulations further include a solution.
  • the molar ratio of neutral lipids:N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine:targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is about 95:4:1.
  • the molar ratio of DMPC:cholesterol:(N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine+targeting-factor modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine) is 50:45:5.
  • a labeled compound is present.
  • the labeled compound includes a radioisotopic moiety.
  • the labeled compound includes 125 I.
  • a drug is present.
  • the drug is an anticancer agent.
  • the drug is a cytotoxic drug.
  • the drug is a topoisomerase I inhibitor.
  • the topoisomerase I inhibitor is topotecan or irinotecan.
  • the drug is a vinca alkaloid.
  • the vinca alkaloid is vincristine, vinblastine, vinleurosine, vinrodisine, vinorelbine or vindesine.
  • drug is a nucleic acid.
  • the nucleic acid is an antisense oligonucleotide or a ribozyme.
  • the drug is a platinum compound.
  • the platinum compound is biplatin, cisplatin, carboplatin, ormaplatin, oxaliplatin, zeniplatin, enloplatin, lobaplatin or spiroplatin.
  • the platinum compound is oxaliplatin.
  • drug is an alkylating agent.
  • the drug is a taxanes.
  • the drug is a metabolic antagonist.
  • the drug is an antitumour antibiotic.
  • the drug is a hormone therapy drug.
  • the drug is a molecular target drug.
  • the oxaliplatin is dissolved in an aqueous solution of a sugar selected from the group consisting of trehalose, maltose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, mannitol, glycerol and dextrose.
  • the sugar is at a concentration of from about 1 to about 20% percent sugar (v/v).
  • the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 25 mg/ml within the liposome.
  • the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 10 mg/ml within the liposome.
  • the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml.
  • the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome is from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 3.0 mg/ml. In certain embodiments, the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome is from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.5 mg/ml.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • the transferrin is in a holo-form but not in an apo-form. In certain embodiments, the transferrin is in a holo-form.
  • the ferric iron is in a concentration of from about 0.4 to about 3.0 ⁇ g/ml. In other embodiments, the ferric iron is in a concentration of from about 0.4 to about 1.5 ⁇ g/ml.
  • liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes formulations are free of lipid components other than two different neutral lipids, the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the targeting-factor modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • the formulations are free of lipid components other than phosphatidyl choline, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • compositions comprising a targeted liposome or liposome-containing composition as described herein and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives.
  • kits containing one or more of the lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions or targeted liposomes described herein, packaging and instructions for use.
  • the kit includes targeted liposomes.
  • the targeted liposome is contained in a first container and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives are contained in a second container.
  • the lipid-containing compositions as described herein are intended for use in the methods of treatment and diagnosis as described herein and may be incorporated in the pharmaceutical formulations and kits described herein.
  • the lipid-containing compositions described herein (including lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions), liposomes (including targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, etc.)) may, unless otherwise noted, be made by the methods of production as described herein.
  • methods for making the lipid-containing compositions described herein comprising the step of mixing the at least two different neutral lipids, the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • step (a) adding a drug to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • the mixing step (a) is performed in the presence of an organic solvent.
  • the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing.
  • step (c) comprises sonication or stirring. In particular embodiments, step (c) comprises extrusion.
  • step (a) adding drug or labeled compound to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • the method further comprising a step (e), purifying the liposome of step (d).
  • the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing.
  • step (c) comprises sonication or stirring.
  • step (c) comprises extrusion.
  • Also provided are additional methods of making a targeted liposome comprising the steps of
  • step (a) adding oxaliplatin to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • the method further comprises a step (f) of purifying the liposome of step (e).
  • the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing.
  • step (c) comprises sonication or stirring.
  • lipid-containing compositions including targeted liposomes
  • formulations thereof as described herein in the manufacture of a medicament.
  • pharmaceutical formulations thereof, variously described herein are also intended for use in the manufacture of a medicament for use in treatment and diagnosis of the conditions and, in accordance with the methods, described herein, unless otherwise noted.
  • a targeted liposome as described herein is provided in a further aspect of the invention.
  • the individual is a mammal. In particular embodiments, the individual is a human.
  • the cancer is breast, gastric, colon, colorectal cancer, cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovary cancer, or a hematological malignancies.
  • step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after combined modality cancer therapy.
  • the combined modality cancer therapy comprises chemotherapy, radiation therapy, or surgery.
  • step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after adjunctive cancer therapy.
  • the adjunctive cancer therapy comprises administration of one or more agents to reduce hair loss, vomiting, immune suppression, nausea, diarrhea, rash, sensory disturbance, anemia, fatigue, stomatitis, or hand foot syndrome.
  • step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after administration of one or more additional anticancer agents.
  • the one or more additional anticancer agents include 5-fluorouracil, leucovorin, capecitabine, UFT/LV (tegafur-uracil and leucovorin), irinotecan, an-anti EGFR antibody, an anti-VEGF antibody, a tyrosine kinase inhibitor, or combinations thereof.
  • the targeted liposome is administered via parenteral administration.
  • the parenteral administration is via injection or intravenous infusion.
  • FIG. 1 shows a schematic representation of a targeted liposome.
  • FIG. 2 shows a schematic representation of the active drug targeting of tumor cells using targeted liposomes.
  • FIG. 3 shows a schematic representation of the proposed mode of action of targeted liposomes containing oxaliplatin.
  • FIG. 4 shows a schematic depiction of production process A for targeted liposomes.
  • FIG. 5 shows a schematic of production process B for targeted liposomes.
  • FIG. 6 shows the cytotoxicity of oxaliplatin on AsPC-1 cells at various oxaliplatin concentrations.
  • FIG. 7 shows the number of transferrin receptors present on the cell surface of normal leukocytes and tumor-derived cell lines.
  • FIG. 8 shows the results of size distribution for the liposome-containing mixtures prepared in Example 6 and obtained by QELS; A) Entry 1, B) Entry 2, C) Entry 3, D) Entry 4, E) Entry 5, F) Entry 6.
  • FIG. 9 shows the concentrations of liposomes in the blood, where ( ⁇ ) indicates the Tf-PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9, ( ⁇ ) indicates the Tf-NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8, and ( ) indicates the Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9.
  • FIG. 10 shows the concentrations of liposomes in cancer tissues; where ( ⁇ ) indicates the Tf-PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9, ( ⁇ ) indicates the Tf-NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8, and ( ) indicates the Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9.
  • FIG. 12 shows the inhibitory effects of liposomes on tumor growth by plotting the tumor growth ratio vs. days after initial treatment, where ( ⁇ ) indicates the Tf-PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9; ( ⁇ ) indicates the PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9 without Tf; ( ) indicates the Tf-NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8; ( ⁇ ) indicates the NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8, without Tf; (*) indicates the Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9; ( ⁇ ) indicates the PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9, without Tf; (+) indicates l-OHP solution; and ( ⁇ ) indicates no treatment.
  • FIG. 13 shows the effect of varying concentration of NG-PE (NG-DSPE) on the percentage of drug dose detected in blood, where concentration (% of total lipid content) of NG-DSPE is as follows: ( ⁇ ) 0%, ( ⁇ ) 1%; ( ) 3%; (x) 6%; ( ⁇ ) 12%; and with the following lipids: ( ⁇ ) MPB 6%; (+) PDP 6%.
  • concentration (% of total lipid content) of NG-DSPE is as follows: ( ⁇ ) 0%, ( ⁇ ) 1%; ( ) 3%; (x) 6%; ( ⁇ ) 12%; and with the following lipids: ( ⁇ ) MPB 6%; (+) PDP 6%.
  • FIG. 14 shows the blood retention of liposomes with various dicarboxylic acid linkers, with and without Tf; where ( ⁇ ) Tf-NGPE, ( ⁇ ) Tf-NSPE; ( ) TF-MPB; (x) NGPE (no Tf), (*) MPB (no Tf).
  • FIG. 15 shows exemplary analysis of liposomes by electrophoresis: lane 6 (transferrin-N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine-liposome (Tf-NG-DSPE liposome)); lane 5 (transferrin-polyethyleneglycol-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine-liposome (Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome)) are shown. Lanes 1-4, contain h-apo-Tf (240 ng), h-apo-Tf (120 ng), h-apo-Tf (60 ng), and h-apo-Tf (30 ng), respectively.
  • FIG. 16 shows the amount of transferrin binding to Tf-NG-DSPE liposomes with (lane 5) and without (lane 4) non-NG-DSPE incorporated into the liposome.
  • Lanes 1-3 contain h-apo-Tf (400 ng), h-apo-Tf (200 ng), and h-apo-Tf (50 ng), respectively.
  • FIG. 17 shows the accumulation oxaliplatin in blood after administration of ( ⁇ ) NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 5 mg/kg and ( ⁇ ) Tf-PEG liposomes at 5 mg/kg.
  • FIG. 18 shows the accumulation oxaliplatin in colon 26 tumors after administration of ( ⁇ ) NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 5 mg/kg and ( ⁇ ) Tf-PEG liposomes at 5 mg/kg in mouse colon 26 tumors.
  • FIG. 19 shows the antitumor effect in colon 26 tumor-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where ( ⁇ ) indicates vehicle control (9% sucrose); ( ) indicates l-OHP solution at 5 mg/kg, ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 5 mg/kg and ( ⁇ ) indicates Tf-PEG liposomes at 5 mg/kg.
  • FIG. 20 shows the antitumor effect in HCT-116 human colon tumor xenograft-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where ( ⁇ ) indicates vehicle control (300 mM (10.27%) sucrose); ( ⁇ ) indicates blank (no drug) liposomes, ( ) indicates l-OHP solution at 15 mg/kg, ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 10 mg/kg and ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 15 mg/kg. All liposomes were administered by exact body weight with an injection volume of 0.103 mL/10 g body weight.
  • FIG. 21 shows the antitumor effect in HT-29 human colon tumor xenograft-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where ( ⁇ ) indicates vehicle control (300 mM (10.27%) sucrose), ( ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 15 mg/kg, ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 10 mg/kg, and ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 6.7 mg/kg.
  • FIG. 22 shows the antitumor effect in MKN45 gastric human tumor xenograft-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where ( ⁇ ) indicates vehicle control (300 mM (10.27%) sucrose), ( ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 15 mg/kg, ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 10 mg/kg, and ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 6.7 mg/kg.
  • FIG. 23 shows the antitumor effect in COLO 205 human tumor xenograft-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where ( ⁇ ) indicates vehicle control (9% sucrose); ( ) indicates l-OHP solution at 5 mg/kg q4d ⁇ 3 (day 16), 10 mg/kg q2d ⁇ 2 (day 47), 2 mg/kg q2d ⁇ 6 (day 51); ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 5 mg/kg q4d ⁇ 3 (day 16), 10 mg/kg q2d ⁇ 2 (day 47), 2 mg/kg q2d ⁇ 6 (day 51); and ( ⁇ ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 10 mg/kg q4d ⁇ 3 (day 16), 15 mg/kg q2d ⁇ 2 (day 47), 4 mg/kg q2d ⁇ 6 (day
  • FIG. 24 shows the pattern of SDS-PAGE after reduction with 2-mercaptoethanol, where lane 1 is the molecular weight markers, lane 2 is holo-transferrin, lanes 3-5 are NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, and lane 6 is Tf-NG-DOPE.
  • FIG. 25 shows an exemplary HPLC chromatogram of system suitability.
  • lipid-containing compositions including targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposome-containing compositions, lipid mixtures, etc.
  • methods of making and using the lipid-containing compositions described herein are suitable for the preparation of pharmaceutical formulations and for use in the treatment or diagnosis of a variety of conditions, including cancer.
  • the compositions, including the pharmaceutical formulations provide for more effective treatment and diagnosis regimens with reduced adverse effects associated with the drug or labeled compound being delivered to the individual.
  • the increased efficacy and reduced adverse effects should increase the therapeutic index of the drug formulation and provide an opportunity for successful treatment of a variety of conditions, including cancer and should also increase the efficacy and reduce the adverse effects associated with diagnosis.
  • the increased specificity of the drug formulations with the concomitant reduction in adverse effects should ensure therapeutic benefit to a greater number and range of individuals being treated, thus, saving or prolonging lives and improving the quality of life of individuals in need of treatment.
  • the increased specificity of the labeled compound formulations with the concomitant reduction in adverse effects should increase the number of individuals who can be successfully diagnosed, for example, able to tolerate the diagnosis formulation, and also increase the accuracy (e.g., sensitivity, etc.) of diagnosis, including allowing for earlier diagnosis of conditions and more effective monitoring of the severity of the disease (e.g., progression or regression with or without therapy).
  • compositions presently described are pharmaceutical formulations of the lipid-containing compositions.
  • the lipid-containing compositions described herein include, but are not limited to, liposomes that encapsulate drugs and labeled compounds and can be used in the treatment or diagnosis of disease or other conditions requiring treatment or diagnosis, including, for example, cancer (e.g., breast, gastric, colorectal or colon cancer).
  • cancer e.g., breast, gastric, colorectal or colon cancer
  • Encapsulation of a drug in a liposome composition prior to administration may result in a one or more benefits, including reducing the adverse effect(s) of the drug on a normal cell, protecting the drug until it arrives at a target pathological cell in the case where the drug may be unstable, prolonging the presence of the drug in the circulatory system to enable delivery to pathological cells, and/or in facilitating delivery of the drug to a particular target pathological cell. More specific targeting of the drug and the reduction of loss of drug by uptake in the RES also includes the benefit of reducing the amount of drug that needs to be administered and thereby also reduces the cost of therapy, as well as the other benefits described herein.
  • labeled compounds have adverse effects and/or may be degraded in the time between administration and diagnosis (e.g., the time at which the diagnostic technique is performed—for example, radioisotope detection, magnetic resonance imaging, ultrasound, etc.).
  • Incorporation of the labeled compounds in the lipid-containing compositions described herein should increase the efficacy of the labeled compound, such as, for example, the threshold of detection may be achieved at lower doses of labeled compound, reducing the adverse effects of the agent, and/or extending the window of time in which the diagnosis can be performed.
  • the lipid-containing compositions also include lipids modified with targeting ligands (e.g., targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposome-containing compositions, lipid mixtures) or other derivatization.
  • targeting ligands e.g., targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposome-containing compositions, lipid mixtures
  • liposomal compositions incorporating targeting factor e.g., transferrin, folate, etc.
  • derivatized lipids e.g., N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • anticancer agents e.g., oxaliplatin, etc.
  • This improved bioavailability and tumor-targeting should result in improved safety and increased antitumor activity, and therefore a greater likelihood of effective treatment for individuals in need thereof, while also reducing the adverse effects associated with many drugs, particularly the severe adverse effects associated with most anticancer agents.
  • derivatization and targeting factors may also be employed to efficiently target particular sites (e.g., tumor types, organs, tissues, etc.) for delivery of labeled compounds.
  • the invention also provides transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines, which can be used in the lipid-containing compositions and formulations thereof described herein.
  • lipid-containing compositions including the liposomes, described herein, may be made by the methods herein described, as well as methods for liposome manufacture known to the skilled artisan and appropriate in view of the teaching provide in the present specification.
  • the liposomes and liposome-containing compositions described herein can be incorporated without limitation in pharmaceutical formulations and/or kits, including pharmaceutical formulations and/or kits as described herein and, additionally, those that would be apparent to a skilled artisan in view of the teaching provided in the present specification.
  • liposomes and liposome-containing compositions and pharmaceutical formulations incorporating the liposomes and liposome-containing compositions may be used without limitation, unless otherwise noted, in the methods of treatment or diagnosis consistent with the description provided throughout the present specification and in accordance with the practice of skill artisans in view of the teaching provided herein.
  • targeted liposome refers generally to a liposome with components including at least one or more phospholipid(s), N ⁇ PE, TF-N ⁇ PE and which also incorporates a drug or labeled compound as described herein.
  • phospholipid(s) including at least one or more phospholipid(s), N ⁇ PE, TF-N ⁇ PE and which also incorporates a drug or labeled compound as described herein.
  • Each of these components as described throughout the specification, without limitation, can be incorporated into the targeted liposomes of the present invention in keeping with the teaching provided herein.
  • blank liposomes described in greater detail herein, can also be “targeted,” in that they can incorporate TF-modified N ⁇ PEs, but generally do not incorporate a drug or labeled compound.
  • compositions described herein incorporate at least one N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine according to Formula 1, below:
  • R 1 and R 2 are, independently, an acyl group, and m is and integer from 1 to 10.
  • N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine refers to the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 1 as provided herein.
  • N ⁇ PE is used to refer to the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 1 (e.g., N ⁇ -DOPE, N ⁇ -DSPE, NG-DOPE, etc.), and, for example NG-PE refers to N-glutaryl phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) of Formula 1, unless otherwise noted.
  • phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) incorporated in the lipid-containing compositions (including targeted liposomes) described herein are N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines of Formula 1 or succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines of Formula 2 or the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines of Formula 3, as described in greater detail below.
  • non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine refers to phosphatidyl ethanolamine, semi-synthetic phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s), synthetic phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) and/or derivatives thereof that are not encompassed by Formula 1, Formula 2 or Formula 3.
  • acyl groups represented by R 1 and R 2 , may be used in Formula 1, as is well understood by those of ordinary skill in the field.
  • the acyl group is derived from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having 12-22 carbon atoms.
  • exemplary acyl groups include, but are not limited to, acyl groups derived from lauric acid, tridecanoic acid, myristic acid, pentadecanoic acid, palmitic acid, margaric acid, stearic acid, nonadecanoic acid, arachic acid, heneicosanic acid, behenic acid, 2-lauroleic acid, 5-lauroleic acid, 11-lauroreic acid, 5-myristoleic acid, myristoleic acid, 2-palmitoleic acid, 7-palmitoleic acid, cis-9-palmitoleic acid, trans-9-palmitoleic acid, petroselinic acid, petroselidinic acid, oleic acid, elaidic acid, vaccenic acid, gondoic acid, trans-gondoic acid, erucic acid,
  • the acyl group is derived from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having 14-18 carbon atoms.
  • exemplary acyl groups of this type include, but are not limited to those derived from oleic acid (18 carbons), palmitic acid (16 carbons), stearic acid (18 carbons), or myristic acid (14 carbons).
  • the corresponding acyl groups are oleoyl, palmitoyl, stearoyl, and myristoyl, respectively.
  • the acyl groups are derived from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having 14-18, 14-20, 14-22, 16-18, 16-20, 16-22, 18-20, 18-22, 12, 14, 16, 18, 20 or 22 carbons. In certain embodiments, the acyl groups are derived from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having an even number of carbons.
  • the acyl groups are derived from oleic acid (oleoyl), stearic acid (stearoyl), palmitic acid (palmitoyl), linoleic acid (linoleoyl, 18 carbons), or myristic acid (myristoyl).
  • the acyl groups are derived from oleic acid (oleoyl).
  • the acyl groups are derived from stearic acid (stearoyl).
  • the acyl groups are derived from palmitic acid (palmitoyl).
  • the acyl groups are derived from myristic acid (myristoyl).
  • the acyl group is derived from a saturated aliphatic carboxylic acid, such as, but not limited to palmitic acid (16 carbons), stearic acid (18 carbons), or myristic acid (14 carbons).
  • the acyl group is derived from an unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acid, such as, but not limited to oleic acid (oleoyl, 18 carbons), linoleic acid (linoleoyl, 18 carbons) or linolenic acid (linolenoyl, 18 carbons).
  • the acyl group is derived from linoleic acid.
  • m is 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10. In other embodiments, m is an integer from 1-8, 1-6, 1-5, 1-7, 1-3, 1-2, 2-8, 2-6, 2-5, 2-4, 2-3, 3-4, 3-5, or 3-6. In some embodiments, m is an integer from 2-4. In other embodiments, m is 1, 2 or 3.
  • m is an integer from 1 to 4.
  • m is 3 (glutaric acid).
  • R 1 and R 2 are the same acyl group. In other embodiments, R 1 and R 2 are different acyl groups. In certain embodiments, R 1 and R 2 are oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R 1 and R 2 are oleoyl. In other embodiments, R 1 and R 2 are stearoyl. In particular embodiments, R 1 and R 2 are palmitoyl. In other embodiments, R 1 and R 2 are myristoyl.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 1 is N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DOPE (i.e., where R 1 and R 2 are oleoyl and m is 3)). In other embodiments, it is N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DSPE (i.e., where R 1 and R 2 are stearoyl and m is 3).
  • NG-DOPE N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • NG-DSPE N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • N-glutaryl-dimyristoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine NG-DMPE (i.e., where R 1 and R 2 are myristoyl and m is 3)
  • NG-DPPE N-glutaryl-dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • NS-DSPE N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • N-adipinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (i.e., where R 1 and R 2 are stearoyl and m is 4)).
  • N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 1 is NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines described herein can be obtained by binding a dicarboxylic acid to the amino group of phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • Phospholipids including phosphatidyl ethanolamines and their derivatives utilized for the purposes described herein, must be of high purity and should ideally be homogeneous.
  • Known methods for the preparation of high purity phospholipids include extraction of the lipid from a buffer solution and purification using column chromatography.
  • production methods for N-succinyl dipalmitoylphosphatidylethanolamine are described in International Patent Application Publication WO93/01828 (JPAH7-501316) and U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,804,552 and 5,554,728, the contents of which are hereby incorporated in their entirety.
  • These production methods include the purification of phospholipid derivative from the reaction mixture by silica-gel 60 column chromatography of the reaction mixture.
  • Dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (DPPE) is reacted with succinic acid anhydride with triethylamine catalyst at room temperature under nitrogen gas for 16 hours.
  • N-( ⁇ -carboxy) acylamido-phosphatidyl ethanolamine phospholipid derivatives are described in Japanese published patent application JPA2001-261688, which includes purification by separating a liquid layer after addition of pH3.5-7.5 buffer solution to the reaction mixture, and is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • the PE was reacted with dicarboxylic acid anhydride with triethylamine alkali catalyst at 4° C. for 1 hr. This method may not work well for all phosphatidyl ethanolamine derivatives.
  • DOPE dioleoyl-phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • lecithin API Starting Material
  • DOPC dioleoyl-phosphatidyl choline
  • DOPE can be prepared from DOPC by reacting with ethanolamine using phospholipase D.
  • N-( ⁇ -carboxy) acylamido-phosphatidylethanolamine phospholipid derivatives can also be prepared in such a manner as described in, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 4,534,899, which is hereby incorporated in its entirety. Briefly, a dicarboxylic anhydride is reacted with a phospholipid such as phosphatidylethanolamine to obtain a dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidylethanolamine.
  • Succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines as described herein are represented by the following Formula 2:
  • R 3 and R 4 are, independently, an acyl group, and n is and integer from 1 to 10.
  • succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine refers to the succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 2 as provided herein.
  • SuccN ⁇ PE can be used to refer to the succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 2 (e.g., SuccN ⁇ -DOPE, SuccN ⁇ -DSPE, SuccNG-DOPE, etc.), and, for example NHS-NG-PE refers to a the succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) of Formula 2 formed by reaction with NHS, unless otherwise noted.
  • Formula 2 e.g., SuccN ⁇ -DOPE, SuccN ⁇ -DSPE, SuccNG-DOPE, etc.
  • NHS-NG-PE refers to a the succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) of Formula 2 formed by reaction with NHS, unless otherwise noted.
  • acyl groups that are represented by R 3 and R 4 may be used, as is well understood by those of ordinary skill in the field and as described above for R 1 and R 2 . Unless otherwise noted herein, it is expressly intended that the description provided herein of the acyl groups with respect to Formula 1 (e.g., R 1 and R 2 ) is equally applicable to the acyl groups with respect to Formula 2 (e.g., R 3 and R 4 ). Including, in particular, the description above in the section entitled “N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines.”
  • R 3 and R 4 are the same acyl group. In other embodiments, R 3 and R 4 are different acyl groups. In certain embodiments, R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl. In other embodiments, R 3 and R 4 are stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R 3 and R 4 are palmitoyl. In other embodiments, R 3 and R 4 are myristoyl.
  • n is 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10. In other embodiments, n is an integer from 1-8, 1-6, 1-5, 1-7, 1-3, 1-2, 2-8, 2-6, 2-5, 2-4, 2-3, 3-4, 3-5, or 3-6. In some embodiments, n is an integer from 2-4. In other embodiments, n is 1, 2 or 3.
  • n is an integer from 1 to 4.
  • n is 3 (glutaric acid).
  • the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 2 is a succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DOPE). In other embodiments, it is a succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DSPE).
  • succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 2 is a succinimidyl ester of NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 2 is the succinimidyl ester of the N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNG-DOPE (i.e., where R 3 and R 4 are oleoyl and n is 3)). In other embodiments, it is the succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNG-DSPE (i.e., where R 3 and R 4 are stearoyl and n is 3).
  • succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-dimyristoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine SuccNG-DMPE (i.e., where R 3 and R 4 are myristoyl and n is 3)
  • succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine SuccNG-DPPE (i.e., where R 3 and R 4 are palmitoyl and n is 3)
  • succinimidyl ester of N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNS-DSPE (i.e., where R 3 and R 4 are stearoyl and n is 2)). In other embodiments, it is the succinimidyl ester of N-adipinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNA-DSPE (i.e., where R 3 and R 4 are stearoyl and n is 4)). In certain embodiments the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 2 is SuccNG-DOPE or SuccNG-DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is N ⁇ -DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccN ⁇ -DOPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is N ⁇ -DSPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccN ⁇ -DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is N ⁇ -DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccN ⁇ -DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is N ⁇ -DSPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccN ⁇ -DOPE.
  • the succinimidyl ester may be NHS (e.g., NHS-N ⁇ -DOPE, NHS-N ⁇ -DSPE, etc.).
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNG-DOPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DSPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNG-DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNG-DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DSPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNG-DOPE.
  • the succinimidyl ester may be NHS (e.g., NHS-NG-DOPE, NHS-NG-DSPE, etc.).
  • succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines described herein can be obtained by derivatization of the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines described herein, prepared as known in the art and described herein. Preparation of the succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines is also described in greater detail below, including in the Examples. In view of the teaching provided in the present specification, the skilled artisan will also be able to modify the methods described herein.
  • succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines of the present inventions is as follows:
  • organic solvents that do not have an active hydrogen include, but are not limited to, esters (e.g., ethyl acetate, butyl acetate, etc.), aliphatic hydrocarbons (e.g., hexane, heptanes, etc.), aromatic hydrocarbons (e.g., toluene, xylene, etc.), halogenated hydrocarbone (e.g., chloroform, dichloromethane, dichloroethane, etc.), ethers (e.g., THF, dioxane, diethyl ether, etc.), cyclic hydrocarbons (e.g., cyclohexane, etc.), DMF and DMSO.
  • esters e.g., ethyl acetate, butyl acetate, etc.
  • aliphatic hydrocarbons e.g., hexane, heptanes, etc.
  • aromatic hydrocarbons e.
  • carbodiimide compounds can be used, so long as the compounds posses a carbodiimide group (—N ⁇ C ⁇ N—).
  • carbodiimide compounds that made be used include, but are not limited to, carbodiimide groups such as N,N′-dicyclohexyl-carbodiimide (DCC), N,N′-diisopropyl-carbodiimide, N-ethyl-N′-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-carbodiimide hydrochloride (EDC), etc.
  • DCC N,N′-dicyclohexyl-carbodiimide
  • EDC N,N′-diisopropyl-carbodiimide
  • EDC N-ethyl-N′-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-carbodiimide hydrochloride
  • DCC used.
  • EDC is used.
  • the above-described reaction may also be performed under conditions that minimize or eliminate production of by-products.
  • Unwanted by-products include urea compounds (e.g., N,N′-dicyclohexylurea, N-ethyl-N′-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)urea, etc.), N-acylated urea compounds, carboxyanhydride compounds and 5-oxazolone compounds.
  • Conditions and materials which disfavor or minimize the formation of by-products include, 1) slowly dissolving the carbodiimide compounds in organic solvent, 2) performing the reaction below 0 C.° to prevent heat evolution by the reaction, etc.
  • Other means for optimizing the reaction and minimizing the production of by-products will be understood by those of ordinary skill in the field, particularly in view of the teaching provided herein.
  • the organic solvent that is capable of dissolving the carbodiimide compounds is the same as the organic solvent, which does not have an active hydrogen as described above.
  • the solvent used to dissolve the carbodiimide and the organic solvent without active hydrogens may be the same or different.
  • the progress of the reaction can monitored by a thin-layer chromatography (TLC) systems, high-performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), and/or evaporated light scattering detectors.
  • TLC thin-layer chromatography
  • HPLC high-performance liquid chromatography
  • evaporated light scattering detectors Other methods for monitoring the progress of the reaction will also be known by those of skill in the art.
  • Purification can be performed by silica gel column chromatography using a mixture of chloroform and methanol. Additional purification methods will be known to those of skill in the art.
  • succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines as described herein are usually stable.
  • Targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines include a targeting ligand linked to a second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, where the second N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • R 5 and R 6 are, independently, an acyl group, and p is and integer from 1 to 10.
  • targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine refers to the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 3 and modified with a targeting factor as provided herein.
  • TF-N ⁇ PE can be used to refer to the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (e.g., TF-N ⁇ -DOPE, TF-N ⁇ -DSPE, TF-NG-DOPE, etc.), and, for example TF-NG-PE refers to a targeting ligand linked to N-glutaryl phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) of Formula 3.
  • TF-N ⁇ -DOPE the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • TF-NG-PE refers to a targeting ligand linked to N-glutaryl phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) of Formula 3.
  • acyl groups that are represented by R 5 and R 6 may be used, as is well understood by those of ordinary skill in the field and as described above for R 1 and R 2 . Unless otherwise noted herein, it is expressly intended that the description provided herein of the acyl groups with respect to Formula 1 (e.g., R 1 and R 2 ) is equally applicable to the acyl groups with respect to Formula 3 (e.g., R 5 and R 6 ). Including, in particular, the description above in the section entitled “N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines.”
  • R 5 and R 6 are the same acyl group. In other embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are different acyl groups. In certain embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl. In other embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are palmitoyl. In other embodiments, R 5 and R 6 are myristoyl.
  • p is 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10. In other embodiments, p is an integer from 1-8, 1-6, 1-5, 1-7, 1-3, 1-2, 2-8, 2-6, 2-5, 2-4, 2-3, 3-4, 3-5, or 3-6. In some embodiments, p is an integer from 2-4. In other embodiments, p is 1, 2 or 3.
  • the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 3 is targeting factor-modified N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (TF-NG-DOPE). In other embodiments, the targeting factor-modified N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine is (TF-NG-DSPE). In certain embodiments the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 3 is TF-NG-DOPE or TF-NG-DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 3 is N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DOPE (i.e., where R 5 and R 6 are oleoyl and p is 3)). In other embodiments, it is N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DSPE (i.e., where R 5 and R 6 are stearoyl and p is 3).
  • NG-DOPE N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • NG-DSPE N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • N-glutaryl-dimyristoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine NG-DMPE (i.e., where R 5 and R 6 are myristoyl and p is 3)
  • NG-DPPE N-glutaryl-dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • NS-DSPE N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • N-adipinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (i.e., where R 5 and R 6 are stearoyl and p is 4)).
  • N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 3 is NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), which is described in greater detail below, and the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine incorporated in the transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is of Formula 3, as described herein.
  • Tf transferrin
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is N ⁇ -DOPE and the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Tf-N ⁇ -DOPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is N ⁇ -DSPE and the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Tf-N ⁇ -DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is N ⁇ -DOPE and the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Tf-N ⁇ -DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is N ⁇ -DSPE and the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Tf-N ⁇ -DOPE.
  • m may be 3 and the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is a NG-PE according to Formula 1.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DOPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DSPE and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DSPE.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DSPE and the targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DOPE.
  • the targeting-factor modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines may be prepared from the SuccN ⁇ PE by reaction with the targeting ligand and other reactants as described herein in greater detail.
  • the TF-N ⁇ PE may either be prepared prior to mixture with other lipid components of the lipid-containing compositions described herein (and optionally purified) or may be prepared in situ from the reaction of the pre-prepared SuccN ⁇ PE that has been incorporated in a lipid-containing composition.
  • the lipid-containing compositions as described herein also contain one or more additional lipid components in addition to the N ⁇ PEs, SuccN ⁇ PEs and/or TF-N ⁇ PEs described herein.
  • additional lipid components can be used, however, the term “additional lipid component(s)” is not intended to include non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (PEs) or derivatives of PEs as in Formulae 1, 2 or 3.
  • the one or more additional lipid component(s) may be a phospholipid or one or more phospholipids.
  • the one or more additional lipid components may include at least two neutral lipids.
  • one or more phospholipids may be present and, optionally, an “additional lipid” (which is not a phospholipid).
  • an “additional lipid” (which is not a phospholipid).
  • a variety of neutral lipids can be used, however, the at least two neutral lipids are not intended to include non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (PEs) or derivatives of PEs as in Formulae 1, 2 or 3. It is not intended that the term “phospholipid,” as used herein, should include PEs or derivatives thereof, as in Formulae 1, 2 or 3. Similarly, the term “additional lipid” does not include PEs or derivatives thereof, as in Formulae 1, 2 or 3, nor does it include other phospholipids.
  • PEs non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • phospholipid(s) may be used in the lipid-containing compositions and formulations described herein. For example, one or more, at least two, at least three, at least four phospholipids; or, two, three, or four phospholipids. In particular embodiments there is one phospholipid. In certain embodiments the lipid components of the compositions are limited to one phospholipid, the N ⁇ PE, and the SuccN ⁇ PE (or TF-modified N ⁇ PE, where the reaction with the targeting factor has been performed).
  • two or more neutral lipids may be used in the lipid-containing compositions and formulations described herein.
  • the lipid components of the compositions are limited to two neutral lipids, the N ⁇ PE, and the SuccN ⁇ PE (or TF-modified N ⁇ PE, where the reaction with the targeting factor has been performed).
  • the phospholipid may be a phosphatidylcholine, including naturally occurring, semi-synthetic or synthetic phosphatidylcholines (e.g., DSPC, DMPC, etc.).
  • the phosphatidylcholine is a non-naturally occurring phosphatidylcholine (e.g., not egg phosphatidylcholine).
  • the phosphatidylcholine is an acyl phosphatidylcholine (e.g., DMPC, DPPC, POPC, DSPC, etc.).
  • the phospholipid is cationic.
  • the phospholipid is anionic. In still other embodiments, the phospholipid is neutral. In particular embodiments, the one or more phospholipid(s) is not anionic. In other embodiments, the one or more phospholipid(s) is not cationic. In certain embodiments where more than one phospholipid is present, an anionic and neutral lipid may be included.
  • Exemplary phospholipids include, but are not limited to, phosphatidylcholines (PCs), phosphatidic acid, phosphatidylserine, phosphatidylglycerol, etc. In some embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions do not include phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylglycerol.
  • the phospholipid may be a phosphatidylcholine, including naturally occurring, semi-synthetic or synthetic phosphatidylcholines (e.g., DSPC, DMPC, etc.).
  • the phosphatidyl choline is a non-naturally occurring phosphatidyl choline (e.g., not egg phosphatidyl choline).
  • the phosphatidyl choline is an acyl phosphatidyl choline (e.g., DMPC, DPPC, POPC, DSPC, etc.).
  • At least one of the at least two neutral lipids may be cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative (e.g., cholesterol pullulan, positively-charged cholesterol (e.g., DC-Chol)), incorporating a moiety of a radioisotope (e.g., 3 H, 14 C, 125 I, 131 I, etc.), having a functional moiety (e.g., a fluorescent moiety, etc.).
  • a cholesterol derivative e.g., cholesterol pullulan, positively-charged cholesterol (e.g., DC-Chol)
  • a radioisotope e.g., 3 H, 14 C, 125 I, 131 I, etc.
  • having a functional moiety e.g., a fluorescent moiety, etc.
  • the compositions may additionally comprise an additional neutral, non-phospholipid as the additional lipid.
  • additional lipid for example, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative as described above.
  • Phospholipids for use in the lipid-containing compositions described herein include synthetic, semi-synthetic and naturally occurring phospholipids.
  • Exemplary phospholipids include, but are not limited to, phosphatidylcholine (PC), phosphatidic acid, phosphatidylserine, phosphatidylglycerol, etc.
  • the one or more phospholipids include phosphatidylcholine (PC) or phosphatidic acid and do not include phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylglycerol.
  • the phospholipid is a phosphatidylcholine.
  • the phosphatidylcholine may be, e.g., distearoyl phosphatidyl choline (DSPC), dimyristoyl phosphatidylcholine (DMPC), dipalmitoyl phosphatidylcholine (DPPC), palmitoyl oleoyl phosphatidylcholine (POPC), egg phosphatidylcholine (EPC), hydrogenated soya phosphatidylcholine (HSPC), etc.
  • at least one phospholipid is a phosphatidylcholine.
  • the phosphatidylcholine is DMPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is DSPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is DPPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is POPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is EPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is HSPC. In some embodiments, one phospholipid is included and is DMPC, DSPC, DPPC, POPC, EPC or HSPC. In particular embodiments where there are lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is DMPC.
  • the phospholipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid). In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is DPPC. In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is POPC. In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is EPC. In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is HSPC.
  • the additional lipid components(s) may include at least one phospholipid and, optionally, an additional lipid such as cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative.
  • the additional lipid component(s) are a single phospholipid and cholesterol.
  • the additional lipid component(s) include at least one phosphatidylcholine and cholesterol.
  • the additional lipid component(s) include a single phosphatidylcholine and cholesterol.
  • the phospholipid is DSPC, DMPC, DPPC, POPC, EPC or HSPC.
  • the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and DMPC.
  • the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and DSPC. In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and one of DMPC or DSPC. In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DMPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DSPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and DPPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and POPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and EPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and HSPC.
  • the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and one of DMPC, DSPC, DPPC, POPC, EPC or HSPC. In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DMPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DSPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DPPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and POPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and EPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and HSPC.
  • the one or more phospholipid includes a phosphatidyl choline. In particular embodiments, are included one or more phospholipids and cholesterol (or a cholesterol derivative). In certain embodiments, the phospholipid is a phosphatidyl choline and the composition additionally includes a cholesterol (or a cholesterol derivative). In particular embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is a phosphatidylcholine which includes a moiety of saturated fatty acid (e.g., DMPC, DSPC or DPPC). In certain embodiments the phosphatidylcholine is not egg phosphatidylcholine. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is not HSPC.
  • the two neutral lipids are cholesterol (or a cholesterol derivative) and a phosphatidyl choline.
  • the phosphatidylcholine is a phosphatidylcholine which includes a moiety of saturated fatty acid (e.g., DMPC, DSPC or DPPC).
  • the phosphatidylcholine is not egg phosphatidylcholine.
  • the additional lipid component(s) as described herein, and those known to the skilled artisan, are commercially available from a number of suppliers, including, for example Avanti Polar Lipids, Inc. (Alabaster, Ak.), Northern Lipid Inc. (Canada), Lipoid GmbH (Germany), NOF Corporation (Japan), Nippon Fine Chemical Co., Ltd (Japan).
  • drugs may be included in the lipid-containing compositions of the present invention, for example, a compound or a gene.
  • the drug may be an anticancer agent, for example, an anticancer agent suitable for encapsulation in a liposome.
  • the amount of drug to be included in the lipid-containing compositions, and formulations thereof, as described herein can be readily determined by the skilled artisan in view of the teaching herein provided and depending on the drug selected and the use intended for the composition or formulation, taking into account factors specific to both the drug and the individual to be treated, as described further herein.
  • the drug may be a nucleic acid, for example, nucleic acid encoding for sequences with anticancer properties.
  • nucleic acid for example, nucleic acid encoding for sequences with anticancer properties.
  • antisense oligonucleotides for example, but not limited to, antisense oligonucleotides, ribozymes, etc.
  • the anticancer agent can be a cytotoxic drug, including those known by skill in the art and medical practitioners.
  • exemplary anticancer agents include topoisomerase I inhibitors, vinca alkaloids, alkylating agents (including platinum compounds), taxanes and others known to those of skill in the art.
  • the anticancer drug may be a topoisomerase I inhibitor, for example, but not limited to, topotecan, irinotecan, etc.
  • the anticancer drug may also be a vinca alkaloid, for example, vincristine, vinblastine, vinleurosine, vinrodisine, vinorelbine, vindesine, etc.
  • the anticancer drug may also be a platinum compound.
  • platinum compounds include biplatin, cisplatin, carboplatin, ormaplatin, oxaliplatin, zeniplatin, enloplatin, lobaplatin, spiroplatin, etc.
  • Oxaliplatin (platinum (II) cis-oxalato complex of trans-1-1,2-diaminocyclohexane) is a platinum, more specifically, an oragnoplatinum, complex having a structure represented by the following formula shown below.
  • Oxaliplatin is also known as the following: diaminocyclohexane platinum, DACH-platinum, and cis-[(1R,2R)-1,2-cyclohexanediamine-N,N][oxalato(2)-O,O′]platinum (C 8 H 14 N 2 O 4 Pt; MW 397.4 g/mol).
  • oxaliplatin is the active pharmaceutical ingredient in EloxatinTM.
  • Oxaliplatin is useful as an antitumor agent, since it has a therapeutic activity similar to that of cisplatin and relatively low nephrotoxicity and emetogenicity (vomiting).
  • Production processes for oxaliplatin is well known in the art (e.g., JP-A-9-40685; U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,169,846, 5,338,874; 5,959,133; 5,298,642; and 5,290,961 (the disclosures of which are hereby incorporated in their entirety).
  • Oxaliplatin is further described in Chaney S G et al. “ Recognition and processing of cisplatin - and oxaliplatin - DNA adducts.” Crit Rev Oncol Hematol . (2005) 53: 3-11 (herein incorporated by reference in its entirety).
  • the oxaliplatin concentration encapsulated within the liposome is about 1 mg/ml, for example about 0.8 mg/ml.
  • the liposome composition of the present invention contains from about 1 to about 50 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 1 to about 150 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid.
  • the liposome composition of the present invention contains from about 10 to about 50 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from 10 to about 150 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid.
  • the compositions contain from about 1 to about 45 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 40 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 35 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 30 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 25 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 20 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 15 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 10 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 5 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 50 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 45 ⁇ g oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 35 ⁇ g oxaliplatin
  • the compositions contain from about 1 to about 145 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 120 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 115 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 100 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 90 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 70 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 60 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 50 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 25 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 150 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 140 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 125 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 100 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 80 ⁇ g TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about
  • the oxaliplatin concentration in the liposome formulation is 0.8+/ ⁇ 10% mg/ml.
  • the oxaliplatin may be dissolved in a solution (e.g., an aqueous solution).
  • a solution e.g., an aqueous solution.
  • the solution includes a sugar (e.g., trehalose, maltose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, mannitol, glycerol, dextrose, fructose, etc.)
  • the concentration of the sugar may be of several percent.
  • sugar concentrations of about 0.1-12%; 0.5-12%, 1%-12%, 2%-8%, 2%-6%, 2%-5%, 2%-4%, 2%-5%, 2%-6%, 2%-8%, 2%-9%, 2%-10%, 4%-10%, 4%-9%, 4%-8%, 4%-6%, 3%-4%, about 2%, about 3%, about 4%, about 5%, about 6%, about 7%, about 8%, about 9% or about 10%.
  • the solution includes a sugar and is aqueous. It is intended that the solution in which oxaliplatin is dissolved can also contain additional components, including those known to the skilled artisan.
  • the sugar concentration is about 5%, about 7%, about 8%, about 9% or about 10%. In other embodiments, the sugar concentration is about 5% to about 10%. In some embodiments, the sugar is dextrose and the concentration of dextrose in the oxaliplatin solution is about 5%. In some embodiments, the sugar is dextrose and the concentration of dextrose in the oxaliplatin solution is about 9%. In certain embodiments, the sugar is sucrose and the concentration of sucrose in the oxaliplatin solution is about 9%. In certain embodiments, the sugar is sucrose and the concentration of sucrose in the oxaliplatin solution is about 10%.
  • the concentration of sugar in solution may be, for example about 50 mg/ml to about 150 mg/ml, about 50 mg/ml to about 130 mg/ml, about 50 mg/ml to about 120 mg/ml, about 50 mg/ml to about 100 mg/ml, about 80 mg/ml to about 100 mg/ml, about 90 mg/ml to about 150 mg/ml, about 90 mg/ml to about 130 mg/ml, about 60 mg/ml, about 80 mg/ml, about 90 mg/ml, about 100 mg/ml, about 110 mg/ml, about 105 mg/ml, about 120 mg/ml, or about 140 mg/ml.
  • the solution may also contain other ingredients known to those of skill in the art, such as, but not limited to, salts, buffers, sugar alcohol, etc.
  • the solution in which oxaliplatin is dissolved contains sodium phosphate (e.g., monobasic and/or dibasic sodium phosphate).
  • the concentration of sodium phosphate may be about 5 to about 15 mM.
  • the concentration of sodium phosphate may be about 5 to about 15 mM.
  • the sugar solution may additionally include about 1.0 to about 1.5 mg/ml sodium phosphate.
  • the solution pH will be about 6.5 to about 7.5, be about 6.7 to about 7.5, be about 7 to about 7.5, about 7, about 7.5, about 6.8, or about 6.5.
  • the drug is oxaliplatin, and is contained in a solution of about 9% sucrose. In some embodiments, the drug is oxaliplatin, and is contained in a solution of about 9% sucrose in an oxaliplatin concentration of about 1 mg/ml. In some embodiments, the drug is oxaliplatin, and is contained in a solution of about 105 mg/ml sucrose. In some embodiments, the drug is oxaliplatin, and is contained in a solution of about 105 mg/ml sucrose in an oxaliplatin concentration in liposome solution of about 1 mg/ml. In certain of these embodiments, the solution further contains sodium phosphate. In certain embodiments, oxaliplatin is in a concentration of about 0.8+/ ⁇ 10% mg/ml of liposome solution.
  • labeled compounds may also be included in the lipid-containing compositions of the present invention.
  • the labeled compound may be an agent useful in carrying out in vivo diagnostic procedures.
  • the amount of labeled compound to be included in the lipid-containing compositions, and formulations thereof, as described herein can be readily determined by the skilled artisan in view of the teaching herein provided and depending on the labeled compound selected and the use intended for the composition or formulation, taking into account factors specific to both the labeled compound and the individual to be diagnosed, as described further herein.
  • Exemplary labeled compounds include, for example, materials comprising radioisotopes (e.g., 3 H, 14 C, 67 Ga, 111 In, 125 I, 131 I, 133 Xe, etc.), material comprising fluorescent moieties (e.g., fluorescein, fluorescein isothiocyanate, etc.), material comprising enzyme (e.g., peroxidase, alkaline phosohatase, etc.), as well as additional labeled compounds known to those of skill in the art.
  • radioisotopes e.g., 3 H, 14 C, 67 Ga, 111 In, 125 I, 131 I, 133 Xe, etc.
  • material comprising fluorescent moieties e.g., fluorescein, fluorescein isothiocyanate, etc.
  • material comprising enzyme e.g., peroxidase, alkaline phosohatase, etc.
  • lipid-containing compositions e.g., targeted liposomes, liposome-containing compositions, etc.
  • lipid-containing compositions e.g., targeted liposomes, liposome-containing compositions, etc.
  • 125 I are particularly useful for identifying the presence and determining the severity (e.g., initially, during a course of treatment, after treatment) of various cancers (e.g., breast cancer, gastric cancer, colorectal cancer, colon cancer, etc.) by gamma-counter.
  • targeting factor and “targeting ligand” may be used interchangeably herein.
  • the lipid-containing compositions described herein are characterized by incorporating an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine modified with a targeting factor (i.e., TF-N ⁇ PE) directed to a particular target cell.
  • a targeting factor i.e., TF-N ⁇ PE
  • the term “targeting factor” refers to a moiety that can bind to a receptor or a surface antigen present on the surface of a target cell.
  • the targeting factors are directed to cell surface receptors on a particular target cell.
  • the targeting factor is often a protein or a peptide that can be attached to a lipid component of the lipid-containing composition.
  • targeting factors are selected such that the targeted receptor or antigen is present only on cells that are targeted for the delivery of the drug or labeled compound (e.g., pathogenic cells) and not present on healthy cells.
  • a greater number of receptors or antigens are expressed on the target cells (e.g., pathogenic or diseased cells) compared to non-targeted (e.g., healthy) cells.
  • the receptor or antigen that binds the targeting factor is either not present or present in low numbers on healthy cells such that binding with the targeting factor does not occur with frequency.
  • targeting factors need to selectively deliver the liposomes as described herein (including encapsulated drug) to the targeted cells (e.g., pathogenic, unhealthy, etc.).
  • Selective delivery of the encapsulated drug to the targeted cells thus reduces the occurrence of adverse effects due to the effect of encapsulated drug or labeled compound on non-targeted (e.g., healthy) cells, thereby also reducing the adverse effects experienced by the individual to whom the composition, or formulation thereof, is administered.
  • targeting factors include, but are not limited to, transferrin, folic acid, folate, hyaluronic acid, sugar chains (e.g., galactose, mannose, etc.), fragments of monoclonal antibodies, asialoglycoprotein, etc., as well as other targeting factors known to the skilled artisan.
  • the targeting factor is a protein or peptide directed to a cell surface receptor (e.g., transferrin, folate, folic acid, asialoglycoprotein, etc.).
  • a cell surface receptor e.g., transferrin, folate, folic acid, asialoglycoprotein, etc.
  • the targeting factor is directed to an antigen (e.g., fragments of monoclonal antibodies (e.g., Fab, Fab′, F(ab′) 2 , Fc, etc.)). It is not intended that targeting factors include intact or whole monoclonal antibodies.
  • the term “whole antibody” or “intact antibody,” and cognates thereof, as used herein generally refer to antibody IgG of immune globulin.
  • a fragment of a monoclonal antibody generally refers to a decomposition product of the monoclonal antibody, for example, a fragment obtained by using protease digestion, such as pepsin, etc.
  • the targeting factor is not directed to an antigen (e.g., is not a fragment of a monoclonal antibody, e.g., Fab, Fab′, F(ab′) 2 , Fc, etc).
  • the targeting factor is transferrin.
  • Transferrin is an iron binding protein with a molecular weight of 80,000, which is synthesized in hepatocytes and found in the blood. Transferrin supplies iron (Fe) to the cells through Tf receptors on the surface of each cell.
  • the transferrin receptor is generally expressed in tumor tissues in a larger amount compared with normal tissues regardless of the types of the tumors. Tumor cell membranes are known to over-express transferrin receptors to maintain cell proliferation. See Shindelman J E, Ortmeyer A E, Sussman H H. “ Demonstration of the transferrin receptor in human breast cancer tissue. Potential marker for identifying dividing cells.” Int J Cancer .
  • Transferrin is commercially available, or can be produced recombinantly as described in, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,026,651, which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • transferrin (Tf) transferrin
  • MADE conjugation of transferrin (Tf) to the MADE occurs by the reaction of a primary amine with the N ⁇ PE which results in the formation of a carboxylic acid amide bond between the lipid anchor and the protein.
  • the molar ratio of Tf to total lipid present in the targeted liposome product is approximately 0.00014:1 mol/mol (Tf:total lipid) (0.015, wt/wt). In other embodiments, the molar ratio of Tf:total lipid is from about 0.016 to about 0.029:about 126 about 158 mM/mM.
  • the lipid-containing compositions described herein include targeted liposomes incorporating derivatized lipids, additional lipids and encapsulated drug or labeled compound, as well as the intermediates used to prepare the targeted liposomes, including lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions, as described herein, where the lipid-containing compositions (including targeted liposomes) are free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as, but not limited to, polyethylene glycol.
  • the lipid-containing compositions also include liposomes which incorporate a TF, but do not include a drug or labeled compound (e.g., blank liposomes).
  • hydrophilic polymer refers to polymers such as polyethylene glycol (PEG) and other polyethoxylated polymers that are used in the liposome field to shield liposomes in an attempt to enhance the circulatory half-life of the liposome. It is intended that this term encompasses free hydrophilic polymers associated non-covalently with the liposomes as well as hydrophilic polymers that are in some way conjugated or covalently linked to a particular component of the liposome (e.g. PEG-modified lipids, etc.). Such hydrophilic polymers are also alternatively referred to in the field as “water-soluble” polymers. Additional exemplary hydrophilic polymers include, but are not limited to, polyvinyl alcohol, polylactic acid, polyglycolic acid, polyvinylpyrrolidone, polyacrylamide, polyglycerol, polyaxozlines, etc.
  • lipid mixture refers to mixtures of lipid components as described herein, where the lipid mixture does not incorporate solution, for example, aqueous solution (e.g., water, buffer or a mixture of water and a water-miscible solvent (e.g., sugar (e.g., trehalose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, dextrose, fructose, etc.), sugar alcohol (e.g., sorbitol, maltitol, lactitol, glycerol, mannitol, etc), alcohol (e.g., ethanol, t-butanol, etc.), etc.)) or organic solvent.
  • aqueous solution e.g., water, buffer or a mixture of water and a water-miscible solvent
  • sugar e.g., trehalose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, dextrose, fructose, etc.
  • sugar alcohol e.g., sorbito
  • liposome-containing composition refers to mixtures of lipids and, optionally, drug(s) or labeled compound(s), in which aqueous solution (e.g., water, buffer (e.g., acetate buffer, phosphate buffer, citrate buffer, borate buffer, tartrate buffer, etc.) or mixture of water and a water-miscible solvent) has been incorporated by mixing (e.g., one or more of, stirring, shaking, etc.).
  • aqueous solution e.g., water, buffer (e.g., acetate buffer, phosphate buffer, citrate buffer, borate buffer, tartrate buffer, etc.) or mixture of water and a water-miscible solvent) has been incorporated by mixing (e.g., one or more of, stirring, shaking, etc.).
  • the aqueous solution may also include additional components such as one or more sugars (e.g., trehalose, maltose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, dextrose, fructose, etc.), sugar alcohol (e.g., sorbitol, maltitol, lactitol, mannitol, glycerol, etc.), alcohol (e.g., ethanol, t-butanol, etc.), etc.
  • sugars e.g., trehalose, maltose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, dextrose, fructose, etc.
  • sugar alcohol e.g., sorbitol, maltitol, lactitol, mannitol, glycerol, etc.
  • alcohol e.g., ethanol, t-butanol, etc.
  • the aqueous solution may also include organic solvent ((e.g., esters (e.g., ethyl acetate, butyl acetate, etc.), aliphatic hydrocarbons (e.g., hexane, heptane, etc.), aromatic hydrocarbons (e.g., toluene, xylene, etc.), halogenated hydrocarbons (e.g., chloroform, dichloromethane, dichloroethane, etc.), ethers (e.g., THF, dioxane, diethyl ether, isopropyl ether, etc.), cyclic hydrocarbons (e.g., cyclohexane, etc.), DMF, DMSO, etc.) or mixtures thereof).
  • organic solvent e.g., esters (e.g., ethyl acetate, butyl acetate, etc.), aliphatic hydrocarbons (e.g.,
  • the liposome-containing composition will generally contain a non-homogenous mixture of lipids, aqueous solution, and liposomes having a broad distribution around 100-10,000 nm and a mean diameter of 500-2,000 nm. Characterization of exemplary liposome-containing compositions is further provided in the Examples.
  • the lipid-containing compositions do not incorporate hydrophilic polymers. In particular embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions do not incorporate PEG.
  • the intermediate lipid mixtures include at least two different neutral lipids or one or more phospholipids, and an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the lipid components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the mixture is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • the lipid mixture does not include a drug or labeled compound.
  • the lipid-mixture may be treated to form a liposome-containing composition or a liposome formulation.
  • the intermediate lipid mixtures include at least two different neutral lipids or one or more phospholipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid components and drug/labeled compound are described in greater detail herein and wherein the mixture is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition, for example, as where the drug or labeled compound is added as an aqueous solution of drug/labeled compound.
  • the liposome-containing composition can be treated (e.g., by one or more of extrusion, size exclusion chromatography, etc. or methods known in the art) to form a liposome.
  • the lipid mixtures include one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the lipid components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the mixture is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the mixtures may also be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.).
  • an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • the intermediate lipid mixtures include one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the lipid components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the mixture is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the mixtures may also be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.).
  • an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • the lipid mixture does not include a drug or labeled compound.
  • the lipid mixture may be treated to form a liposome-containing composition or a liposome formulation.
  • the intermediate lipid mixtures include one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid and drug/labeled compound components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the composition is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the mixtures may also be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.).
  • an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • the intermediate lipid-containing compositions include a liposome containing one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug, wherein the lipid and drug components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the liposomes may also be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.).
  • the lipid mixture does not include a drug or labeled compound.
  • the lipid mixture may be treated to form a liposome-containing composition or a liposome formulation.
  • the lipid mixtures include one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting-factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid, targeting factor and drug/labeled compound components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the liposomes are substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct or decomposition products associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.).
  • the lipid mixture is a liposome-containing composition (e.g., where drug or labeled compound is added as an aqueous solution).
  • an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • the targeted liposomes include liposomes containing one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a targeting-factor modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid, targeting factor and drug or labeled compound components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the liposomes are substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct or decomposition products associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.).
  • non-NHS starting material e.g., byproduct or decomposition products associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • carbodiimmides e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.
  • acylated urea compounds e.g., acylated urea compounds, etc.
  • the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine may be present in the initial stages in the preparation of the targeted liposomes (e.g., NHS-NG-PEs (e.g., NHS-NG-DOPE, NHS-NG-DSPE, etc.), for example, prior to hydrolysis of the succinimidyl ester which may yield, for example NHS and NG-DOPE in the final formulation.
  • NHS-NG-PEs e.g., NHS-NG-DOPE, NHS-NG-DSPE, etc.
  • the liposome or liposome-containing composition can also be free or substantially free of NHS, as in when TF-N ⁇ PE is pre-formed and used as starting material.
  • the targeted liposomes are substantially free of DCC and EDC. In certain embodiments, the targeted liposomes are substantially free of DCC.
  • each of the liposome-containing compositions as described herein can be treated to produce liposomes.
  • the production of liposomes is well known in the art and, additionally, can be accomplished according to the methods described herein, for examples as described for production methods A and B, described in greater detail below.
  • Production methods for liposomes from liposome-containing compositions include, but are not limited to, extrusion, sonication, reverse phase vesicle, freeze-thaw, size exclusion chromatography, ultrafiltration, etc. and combinations thereof.
  • the liposomes formed from the liposome-containing compositions herein described may incorporate drug or labeled compound or may be free of drug or labeled compound (e.g., for liposomes also referred to herein also as “blank liposomes”).
  • the liposome-containing compositions, liposomes (including blank liposomes) and targeted liposomes maybe formulated as pharmaceutical formulations and, additionally, may be used in the methods of treatment or diagnosis and/or kits described herein.
  • substantially free refers to levels of materials that are undetectable or minimally detectable by routine analytical methods used in the field. For example, HPLC (see e.g., European Phmaracopoeia 5 th Ed.), TLC, gas chromatography, etc., as well as other analytical methods known to the skilled artisan.
  • the lipid-containing compositions may contain less than about 0.1%, less than about 0.5%, less than about 1%, less than about 2%, less than about 3%, less than about 4%, less than about 5%, or less than about 6% by weight of a particular starting material, byproduct or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine to the total lipid content.
  • compositions will contain less than about 10%, less than about 7%, less than about 5%, less than about 3%, less than about 2%, or less than about 1% total impurities (e.g., % sum of starting material, byproduct and decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine).
  • total impurities e.g., % sum of starting material, byproduct and decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • the targeted liposomes include liposomes containing a phosphatidylcholine (e.g., neutral, anionic or cationic), cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid, targeting factor and drug components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the phosphatidyl choline is a neutral phosphatidyl choline.
  • the targeted liposomes include liposomes containing a phosphatidyl choline (e.g., neutral, anionic or cationic), cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid components and drug or labeled compound are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the phosphatidyl choline is a neutral phosphatidyl choline.
  • the targeted liposomes include liposomes containing a phosphatidyl choline (e.g., neutral, anionic or cationic), cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and encapsulated oxaliplatin, wherein the lipid components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol.
  • the phosphatidyl choline is a neutral phosphatidyl choline.
  • the lipid-containing compositions may further contain lipids obtained by derivatizing phosphatidylglycerol, sphingosine, ceramide, a cholesterol derivative or the like with a dicarboxylic acid.
  • dicarboxylic acid-derivatives may be prepared as described herein for the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines and according to preparation methods known to the skilled artisan.
  • the lipid-containing compositions do not include anionic lipids (e.g., phosphatidylserines, phosphatidylinsitosols, phosphatidylglycerols, etc.) or cationic lipids (e.g., sphingosine, DOTAP, DOTMA, DC-CHOL, etc.).
  • anionic lipids e.g., phosphatidylserines, phosphatidylinsitosols, phosphatidylglycerols, etc.
  • cationic lipids e.g., sphingosine, DOTAP, DOTMA, DC-CHOL, etc.
  • the compositions are free of anionic lipids.
  • the compositions are free of cationic lipids.
  • the compositions are free of cationic and anionic lipids.
  • the composition comprises a drug. In other embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions comprise a labeled compound.
  • the drug is oxaliplatin
  • the targeting factor (TF) is transferrin (Tf)
  • the lipid components include: DMPC or DSPC, and, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, and an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and a transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the transferrin-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a transferrin linked to an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine by a carboxylic acid amide bond.
  • the N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine are NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • the lipid components of the lipid-containing compositions are DMPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE.
  • the lipid components are DSPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE.
  • the lipid components are DMPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE.
  • the lipid components are DSPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE.
  • the targeting factor (TF) is transferrin and the drug is oxaliplatin.
  • the lipid components are DPPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE.
  • the lipid components are POPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE.
  • the lipid components are DPPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE.
  • the lipid components are POPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE.
  • the targeting factor (TF) is transferrin and the drug is oxaliplatin.
  • the lipid components are HSPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE.
  • the lipid components are EPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE.
  • the lipid components are HSPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE.
  • the lipid components are EPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE.
  • the targeting factor (TF) is transferrin and the drug is oxaliplatin.
  • the molar percent of starting materials NG-DOPE will be between about 2.5 mole % to about 4.5 mol %, compared to the total lipid content. Additionally, the molar percent of starting materials NHS-NG-DOPE will be between about 0.5 mole % to about 2.5 mol %, compared to the total lipid content. In some embodiments, the relative mole ratio of NG-DOPE to NHS-NG-DOPE will be about 3.4:1. In certain embodiments, the relative mole % ratio of NG-DOPE to NHS-NG-DOPE may be about 4:1.
  • the molar ratio of (e g., DMPC:Chol:NG-DOPE:NHS-NG-DOPE) may be 43.0:38.5:3.42:1, which can also be expressed as 50:45:4:1 by mol %.
  • the relative mol % of additional lipid(s) to N ⁇ PE to SuccN ⁇ PE may be from about 98 mol % to about 87 mol % additional lipids: from about 1 mol % to about 12 mol % N ⁇ PE: about 0.5 mol % to about 1% SuccN ⁇ PE; where the total mol % of all components is 100 mol %.
  • additional lipids:N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE may be approximately 95:4:1, 90:9:1, 92:7:1, 93:6:1, etc.
  • the additional lipids include a phospholipid and another lipid such as cholesterol, cholesterol derivatives, etc.
  • the range of mol % for each lipid component is from about 30 mol % to about 64%, where the total of additional lipids is from about 98 mol % to about 87 mol %.
  • the range of mol % for each neutral lipid is from about 30 mol % to about 64%, where the total of neutral lipids is from about 98 mol % to about 87 mol %.
  • the mol % of the phosphatidyl choline is from about 30 to about 70 mol %, (e.g., from about 50 to about 64 mol %, from about 40 to about 65 mol %, from about 40 to about 60 mol %, from about 50 to about 62 mol %, from about 55 to about 60 mol %, from about 35 to about 55 mol %, about 30 mol %, about 40 mol %, about 45 mol %, about 50 mol %, about 55 mol %, about 60 mol %, about 65 mol %, about 70 mol %) and the mol % of the cholesterol or cholesterol derivative is from about 30 to about 60 mol % (e.g., from about 32 to about 45 mol %, from about 32 to about 42 mol %, from about 32 to about 40 mol %
  • the phosphatidyl choline is about 50 mol %, about 52 mol %, about 55 mol %, about 58 mol %, about 60 mol %, about 62 mol % and the cholesterol or cholesterol derivatives is from about 30 mol %, about 32 mol %, about 34 mol %, about 35 mol %, about 37 mol %, about 38 mol %, about 40 mol %, about 42 mol %, about 43 mol %, about 45 mol %.
  • the mol % of N ⁇ PE is about 1 to about 11 mol %, about 1 to about 10 mol %, about 1 to about 8 mol %, about 1 to about 6 mol %, about 1 to about 5 mol %, about 1 to about 4 mol %, about 1 to about 3 mol %, about 1 to about 2 mol %, about 2 to about 10 mol %, about 2 to about 5 mol %, about 1 mol %, about 2 mol %, about 3 mol %, about 4 mol %, about 5 mol %, about 7 mol %, about 8 mol %, about 9 mol % about 10 mol %, about 11 mol %, or about 12 mol %.
  • the relative mol % of the first additional lipid:second additional lipid:N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE is, for example 50:45:4:1.
  • the first additional lipid is a phosphatidylcholine (e.g., DMPC, DOPC, DPPC, DSPC, etc.) and the second additional lipid is cholesterol.
  • the PE of the N ⁇ PE is DOPE or DSPE.
  • the N ⁇ PE is NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • the lipids are DMPC:Chol:NG-DOPE:NHS-NG-DOPE and their relative mol % is 50:45:4:1.
  • the lipids are DSPC:Chol:NG-DSPE:NHS-NG-DSPE and their relative mol % is 50:45:4:1. In other embodiments, the lipids are DSPC:Chol:NG-DSPE:NHS-NG-DSPE and their relative mol % is 62:33:4:1.
  • the total mol % of N ⁇ PE and TF-N ⁇ PE is about 2 to about 13 mol % of total lipid content.
  • the total mol % of TF-N ⁇ PE is about 0.002 to about 0.2 mol % relative to total lipid content.
  • the total mol % of TF-N ⁇ PE is about 0.002 to about 0.15 mol %
  • total mol % of TF-N ⁇ PE is about 0.002 to about 0.1 mol %, 0.002 to about 0.05 mol %, about 0.01 to about 0.03 mol %, about 0.005 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.007 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.007 to about 0.05 mol %, about 0.01 to about 0.025 mol %, about 0.015 to about 0.025 mol %, about 0.01 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.02 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.04 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.06 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.08 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.002 mol %
  • the liposome-containing compositions as described herein may also be characterized (e.g., physicochemical properties, etc.) using standard analytical methods, as will be appreciated by the skilled artisan.
  • analytical methods include, but are not limited to and where appropriate, determination of mean diameter, encapsulated volume, net charge (zeta potential), amount of entrapped (i.e., encapsulated) drug, particle size, stability under various conditions (e.g., in storage, as prepared for administration, in vitro), osmotic properties, amount of conjugated targeting factor, etc.
  • Exemplary analytical methods for such characterization are set forth below, as well as in the Examples, and additional methods known to the skilled artisan may also be used to characterize the compositions.
  • the drug content of liposomes can be determined using established methods for HPLC analysis, with appropriate controls, as routinely practiced in the art and, additionally, as described in the Examples. Using appropriate controls, the identity of the encapsulated drug can also be determined by HPLC or, for certain drugs (e.g., platinum containing drugs) by analytical methods such as ICP-MS (Inductively Coupled Plasma-Mass Spectrometry) as is practiced by those of skill in the field.
  • ICP-MS Inductively Coupled Plasma-Mass Spectrometry
  • the amount of drug (e.g., oxaliplatin, etc.) or labeled compound encapsulated within the liposome or liposome-containing composition may be from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 15 mg/ml within the liposome.
  • the drug concentration may be from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 15 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml to about 10 mg/ml, about 0.1 mg/ml to about 10 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml to about 5 mg/ml; about 0.5 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml to about 2 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml to about 1.5 mg/ml, about 0.8 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml, about 0.8 mg/ml to about 2 mg/ml, about 0.8 mg/ml to about 1.5 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 2 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 1.7 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 1.5 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 1.4 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 1.3 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/
  • the electric potential at the shear plane is called the zeta potential of a liposome.
  • the zeta potential of liposomes can be experimentally determined using appropriate instrumentation, for example as measured by an ELS-6000 (Otsuka Electronics, Japan) with the laser-Doppler microelectrophoresis method or other instrumentation and protocols available to the skilled artisan.
  • ELS-6000 Oletsuka Electronics, Japan
  • J. Colloid and Interface Sci. 39, 670-675(1972), nition.com/en/products/zeecom_s.htm, etc.
  • the liposomes (including the targeted liposomes and the liposomes of the liposome-containing composition) as described herein will exhibit an overall net negative zeta potential.
  • the zeta potential is from about ⁇ 10 mV to about ⁇ 200 mV.
  • Liposomes of intermediate size are thought to be retained within the blood compartment and can circulate for a considerable length of time. However, large liposomes pass more slowly through the liver sinusoids, and are rapidly taken up by Kupffer cells. Thus the size of the liposome is very important to determine the behavior in vivo. See, for example, Liu et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta (1992) 1104(1):95-101; Harashima et al., J. Drug Target . (1995) 3(4):253-261; (which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety) etc.
  • Liposome particle size can be obtained from the correlation function by using various algorithms using Photon Correlation Spectroscopy (PCS; Dynamic Light Scattering or Quasi-Elastic Light Scattering (QELS)).
  • PCS Photon Correlation Spectroscopy
  • QELS Quasi-Elastic Light Scattering
  • the particle size obtained by these techniques is comparable to the mean diameter determined by PCS.
  • PCS uses standard deviation and ⁇ 2 to describe the size distribution. In PCS systems, ⁇ 2 determines whether the system is unimodal (Gaussian distribution) or multimodal (Nicomp distribution).
  • the mean particle size can be determined using intensity weighted measurements and is reported from the Gaussian distribution if ⁇ 2 ⁇ 5. If ⁇ 2>5, then the mean of the principal peak in a Nicomp distribution.
  • Such analysis will be familiar to the skilled artisan, as will suitable hardware, for example Nicomp QELS Particle Sizer, PSS Model 380ZLS, S/N 0103301; pss
  • the liposome mean diameter will be from about 50 to about 275 nm.
  • the liposome mean diameter may be from about 50 to about 200 nm, from about 50 to about 265 nm, from about 50 to about 250 nm, from about 50 to about 225 nm, from about 50 to about 175 nm, from about 50 to about 150 nm, from about 50 to about 120 nm, from about 50 to about 100 nm, from about 75 to about 250 nm, from about 75 to about 200 nm, from about 75 to about 175 nm, from about 75 to about 150 nm, from about 75 to about 120 nm, from about 75 to about 100 nm, from about 90 to about 100 nm, from about 90 to about 120 nm, from about 90 to about 150 nm, from about 90 to about 200 nm, from about 95 to about 100 nm, from about 95 to about 120 nm.
  • the liposomes (e.g., targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposomes in liposome-containing compositions) described herein can also be characterized by the concentration of targeting ligand that is incorporated into the liposome.
  • concentration of targeting ligand that is incorporated into the liposome.
  • various means of quantifying the amount of targeting ligand will be apparent to the skilled artisan.
  • the transferrin (Tf) content of liposomes can be determined by use of electrophoretic migration (e.g., as measured by SDS-PAGE) the liposome compared to appropriate controls.
  • confirmation of transferrin content in liposomes can be evaluated using two assays for the content and/or identity of transferrin conjugated to liposomes.
  • the electrophoretic migration of transferrin the liposome as analyzed by SDS-PAGE can be compared to the migration pattern of purified conjugated transferrin, e.g., TF-N ⁇ PE.
  • the electrophoretic migration of conjugated transferrin in can also be compared to free transferrin reference standard. Additional support for the identity of transferrin in liposomes can be obtained using ELISA, a research-grade formulation that demonstrates specific binding of anti-transferrin antibody to the targeted liposomes.
  • the concentration of transferrin-targeted liposomes can be measured using colorimetric protein quantification assays, such as a BCA, an assay well known to the skilled artisan.
  • colorimetric protein quantification assays such as a BCA, an assay well known to the skilled artisan.
  • BCA colorimetric protein quantification assay
  • the amount of transferrin in a liposome can be analyzed using the bicinchoninic acid (BCA) assay reagent.
  • Copper (II) is reduced to copper (I) by protein under alkaline conditions.
  • the copper (I) ion generated forms a soluble, intensely colored complex with BCA.
  • the total microparticle-bound protein is measured by the reaction of a known amount of microparticle suspension with the BCA reagents. Once color formation occurs, the microparticles are removed by filtration and the color is measured spectrophotometrically.
  • the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome will be from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 5.0 mg/ml, from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 2.0 mg/ml, from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.0 mg/ml, from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 3.0 mg/ml, from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.5 mg/ml, from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.0 mg/ml, or from about 1.3 mg/ml to about 2.5 mg/ml.
  • ferric ion The role of ferric ion is very important in binding transferrin to the surface of tumor cells. Therefore, the ferric ion content of targeted liposomes incorporating Tf is another meaningful way of characterizing the liposomes. While a number of methods for determining ferric ion content will be known to those of skill in the art, one method is ICP-MS.
  • the ferric ion content of the liposome may be, for example, from about 0.25 ⁇ g/mL to about 3 ⁇ g/mL, 0.4 ⁇ g/mL to about 3 ⁇ g/mL, 0.25 ⁇ g/mL to about 2 ⁇ g/mL, 0.25 ⁇ g/mL to about 1.5 ⁇ g/mL, 0.25 ⁇ g/mL to about 1 ⁇ g/mL, 0.4 ⁇ g/mL to about 2 ⁇ g/mL, 0.4 ⁇ g/mL to about 1.5 ⁇ g/mL, 0.5 ⁇ g/mL to about 2 ⁇ g/mL, about 0.5 ⁇ g/mL to about 1.4 ⁇ g/mL, or about 0.5 ⁇ g/mL to about 1.5 ⁇ g/mL.
  • the liposomes may also be characterized by their osmotic pressure at a given temperature.
  • the osmotic pressure at a given temperature depends upon the molar concentration of sugar (sucrose) solution. And it also depends on the total ion density and the size of the molecules within the solution. Normally osmotic pressure can be measured using an instrument known as an osmometer, which measures osmotic pressure in suitable pressure units, as will be appreciated by the skilled artisan.
  • the osmotic pressure of the liposomes, particularly the targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, at room temperature will be from about 310 to about 410 mOsm/kg.
  • the osmotic pressure may be from about from about 310 to about 400 mOsm/kg, from about 310 to about 380 mOsm/kg, from about 320 to about 360 mOsm/kg, from about 315 to about 375 mOsm/Kg, from about 320 to about 375 mOsm/Kg, from about 315 to about 370 mOsm/Kg, from about 320 to about 370 mOsm/Kg, about 360 mOsm/Kg, about 350 mOsm/Kg, about 340 mOsm/Kg, about 370 mOsm/Kg or about 380 mOsm/Kg at room temperature.
  • the osmotic pressure may vary less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% when monitored over a particular time period associated with the various conditions as described herein. For example, 360+/ ⁇ 50 mOsm/kg.
  • a labeled compound refers to its ability to be useful in the diagnosis of a particular disease or conditions in conjunction with the particular diagnostic methods (e.g., the activity of the labeled compound (for example, ability to be visualized by gamma counter, etc.) is not impaired by an unacceptable level batch to batch or during storage.
  • compositions described herein that can be used to consistently produce high quality (e.g., of high purity, homogeneity, etc.) targeted liposomes (and intermediates thereof) and blank liposomes. These methods are also represented schematically in FIGS. 4 (production method A) and 5 (production method B).
  • succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines and N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines as described herein are useful as components of phospholipid complexes such as liposomes, polymer micelles, micro- and nano-spheres, emulsions and water-soluble polymers.
  • the preparation of these PE derivatives is described herein and methods for their production are also known in the art, as mentioned previously.
  • succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines and N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines are also useful as components of the lipid-containing compositions as described herein.
  • the lipid-containing compositions can be prepared according to the methods described herein, though modifications of these methods will also be apparent to the skilled artisan.
  • various methods known to the skilled artisan may be used in liposome formation from lipid components (e.g., sonication, stirring, extrusion, dehydration, etc.) As, for example, as described in U.S. Pat. App. Pub. No. 2004/0142025, the contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • lipid-containing compositions e.g., lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions, blank liposomes, and intermediate liposomes
  • methods for the production of the other lipid-containing compositions e.g., lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions, blank liposomes, and intermediate liposomes
  • Production method A is depicted schematically in FIG. 4 .
  • succinimidyl esters of N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (SuccN ⁇ PE) and N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (N ⁇ PE) as described herein are mixed with additional lipid(s) ((e.g., at least one phospholipid(s) (e.g.
  • PC e.g., DMPC, DSPC, etc.
  • PI sphingomyelin
  • phosphatidic acid e.g., phosphatidic acid
  • a suitable solvent e.g., ethanol, t-BuOH, chloroform, isopropylether, etc.
  • the amount of the solvent is generally 1 to 100 v/w (vs. total lipid weight). In certain embodiments, this is 2 to 20 v/w.
  • the SuccN ⁇ PE and N ⁇ PE used as described in the preceding paragraph can be prepared and purified by methods described herein or by methods known to the skilled artisan.
  • the SuccN ⁇ PE and N ⁇ PE, as well as other components described herein for the production of the targeted liposomes and intermediates thereof, should be of sufficient purity and homogeneity to ultimately yield targeted liposomes of sufficient purity and homogeneity to fall within regulatory guidelines for the administration of the targeted liposomes to individuals and in accordance with good laboratory practice (GLP) and good manufacturing practice (GMP) guidelines.
  • GLP laboratory practice
  • GMP good manufacturing practice
  • the ratio of phospholipid(s) to other additional lipid(s) is about 2:1.
  • a mixing ratio of the SuccN ⁇ PE derivatives to the phospholipids is from about 1 to about 12% (1:99 to 12:88), or about 3-6% (3:97 to 6:94) of the total concentration/ratio of (NHS-NGPE+NGPE) to (CHOL+Phospholipid).
  • exemplary ratio include 50:45:4:1 (e.g., PC:Chol:NG-PE:NHS-NG-PE), where, for example 17.5 mg of NHS-NG-DOPE, 63.1 mg of NG-DOPE, 312 mg of Chol and 607 mg of phospholipids in 1 g of mixture.
  • the N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE:additional lipid mixture prepared in step A is then mixed with aqueous solution (e.g., buffer, etc.) containing the drug or labeled compound to be encapsulated (e.g., anticancer agent (e.g., oxaliplatin, topoisomerase I inhibitor, vinca alkaloid, etc.)) to obtain the drug:N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE:neutral lipid mixture (Intermediate 2).
  • aqueous solution e.g., buffer, etc.
  • anticancer agent e.g., oxaliplatin, topoisomerase I inhibitor, vinca alkaloid, etc.
  • the concentration of the oxaliplatin solution is about 8 mg/ml in an approximately 9% sucrose solution.
  • concentration of oxaliplatin in the targeted liposome is about 0.8 mg/mL+/ ⁇ 10%.
  • the drug:N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE:additional lipid mixture (Intermediate 2) obtained in step B is then sonicated or stirred followed by evaporation of the solvent to form the drug:N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE:additional lipid liposome (Intermediate 3).
  • Methods and conditions for performing sonication, stirring and evaporation and means for accomplishing these steps are well understood by the skilled artisan and are also further described in the Examples. See for example, methods of production by reverse phase vesicle (REV) methods, U.S. Pat. No. 4,235,871 (incorporated by reference in its entirety).
  • General liposome production methods such as simple hydration methods and ethanol injection methods, known to the skilled artisan, can be also used.
  • the drug:N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE:additional lipid liposome formed as described above is then extruded by size and the drug:N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE:additional lipid liposome is isolated.
  • ultrafiltration can then be used to concentrate the liposome solution.
  • the liposome contains l-OHP (drug), DMPC (additional lipid/phospholipid (neutral)), cholesterol (CHOL, additional lipid/neutral lipid), N-glutaryl-DOPE (NG-DOPE) and NHS-NG-DOPE
  • a liposome with a mean diameter of about 0.2 micrometer (200 nm) can be isolated.
  • sized liposomes can also be obtained for liposomes containing l-OHP (drug), DSPC (additional lipid/phospholipid (neutral), cholesterol, N-glutaryl-DSPE (NG-DSPE) and NHS-NG-DSPE.
  • Exemplary target amounts of the lipid components are, for example, about 40 mg/mL DMPC (an additional lipid/phosphatidyl choline/phospholipid/neutral lipid), about 20 mg/mL CHOL (additional lipid/neutral lipid) and about 5 mg/mL NG-DOPE (combined amount of NG-PE and NHS-NG-PE).
  • An exemplary ratio for the lipid components is 50:45:5 (additional lipid 1 (e.g. a phosphatidyl choline)):additional lipid 2 (e.g., CHOL):NG-PE (e.g., NG-DOPE+NHS-NG-DOPE).
  • the drug:N ⁇ PE:SuccN ⁇ PE:additional lipid liposome formed as described in step C can then be functionalized with the targeting factor of choice to produce the drug:N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE:additional lipid liposome (also referred to as the “targeted liposome”).
  • Attachment of the targeting factor (TF) (e.g., functionalization of the intermediate liposome (Intermediate 3) with targeting factor) is accomplished by covalently binding the targeting factor to SuccN ⁇ PE by reaction of the succinimidyl moiety with the targeting factor.
  • succinimidyl groups on the exposed surface of the liposome on the exterior of the lipid bilayer, where the drug or labeled compound is encapsulated in the interior of the liposome
  • TF-N ⁇ PE targeting factor-modified N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • the succinyl carboxyl moiety of the SuccN ⁇ PE as described herein is functionalized. If the targeting factor has an amino group(s), the amino group(s) on the targeting factor is reacted with the succinyl carboxyl moiety and forms carboxylic acid amide bond. Conditions appropriate for this reaction are further described herein, including in the Examples, and will also be well understood by the skilled artisan. The skilled artisan will also be able to modify the reaction conditions to optimize conditions for particular combinations of targeting factor and liposomes without undue experimentation given the teaching herein.
  • transferrin is selected as the targeting factor
  • transferrin is can be commercially obtained as purified protein, for example, from Celliance Corp., GA, USA. Transferrin can also be obtained using recombinant methods well understood in the art (e.g., by using prokaryotic cell ( E. coli , etc.), by using eukaryotic cell (CHO, BHK, etc.), etc.). As is well understood, transferrin can be obtained and used in the targeted liposomes in either its apo or holo forms.
  • targeted liposomes incorporating apo-transferrin can be treated with ferric compounds, such as ferric citrate, iron (III) chloride, etc., to produce targeted liposomes incorporating holo-transferrin derivatized liposome.
  • ferric compounds such as ferric citrate, iron (III) chloride, etc.
  • transferrin as targeting factor is, for example, about 2 mg/mL transferrin. Such an amount would be appropriate for an exemplary targeted liposome containing about 40 mg/mL DMPC, about 20 mg/mL CHOL and about 5 mg/mL NG-DOPE (combined amount of NG-PE and NHS-NG-PE).
  • the resulting liposomes can optionally be further purified using methods known to those of skill in the art, including those purification methods described herein, particularly those described in connection with step C, above.
  • a liposome with a mean diameter of about 0.05 micrometer to about 0.2 micrometer (about 50 nm to about 200 nm) can be isolated.
  • sized liposomes can also be obtained for liposomes containing l-OHP (drug), DSPC, cholesterol, N-glutaryl-DSPE (NG-DSPE) and NHS-NG-DSPE.
  • the targeted liposomes are substantially free of the non-NHS starting materials (described herein) and by-products (e.g., acylated urea compounds, etc.) associated with the generation of SuccN ⁇ PEs.
  • preparation and purification of Succ N ⁇ PEs prior to liposome formation yields liposomes (intermediate 3) and targeted liposomes substantially free of carbodiimide starting materials (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.) used to functionalize N ⁇ PEs to form SuccN ⁇ PEs.
  • drugs and labeled compounds including targeted liposomes incorporating drugs or labeled compounds, which are intended for administration to individuals in the course of therapy or diagnosis, must necessarily be of high quality.
  • the lipid mixtures described in A can be treated with targeting factor to form a lipid mixture containing TF-N ⁇ PE. Further, this lipid mixture may be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition. Finally, the liposome-containing composition may be treated to produce a liposome formulation.
  • the aqueous solution may include a drug or labeled compound.
  • Production method B is depicted schematically in FIG. 5 .
  • the targeted liposomes as described herein can also be produced by dissolving the additional lipids and N ⁇ PE in a suitable solvent (e.g., ethanol, t-BuOH, chloroform, isopropylether, etc.), dispersing the resultant solution in an aqueous solution optionally containing a drug or labeled compound, and then performing ultrasonication or reverse phase vesicle of the resultant dispersion to form a liposome (drug:N ⁇ PE:neutral lipids).
  • a suitable solvent e.g., ethanol, t-BuOH, chloroform, isopropylether, etc.
  • the liposome solution may be concentrated by ultrafiltration.
  • the liposomes can be produced by reverse phase vesicle (REV) method (U.S. Pat. No. 4,235,871, incorporated by reference).
  • REV reverse phase vesicle
  • general liposome composition methods such as simple hydration methods and ethanol injection methods can be also used.
  • the N ⁇ PE(s) can be prepared and purified, and then N ⁇ PE(s), together with the additional lipids (e.g., phospholipid(s), cholesterol, etc.) are used to prepare the liposome according to methods known to the skilled artisan.
  • additional lipids e.g., phospholipid(s), cholesterol, etc.
  • additional lipids e.g., one or more phospholipid (e.g., DSPC, DMPC, etc.), and, optionally, another additional lipid (e.g., cholesterol, etc.) and at least one N ⁇ PE are mixed together and dissolved in a suitable organic solvent.
  • phospholipid e.g., DSPC, DMPC, etc.
  • another additional lipid e.g., cholesterol, etc.
  • the mixing ratio of the phospholipid and the cholesterol may be, for example, about 1:1, for example, about 1.1:1, about 1.2:1, about 0.9:1 (e.g., DMPC and cholesterol, 50:45 (mol %).
  • the content of the N ⁇ PE(s) as a proportion of total lipid content is, for example, 6% relative to the phospholipid.
  • the resultant solution is mixed with a solution of oxaliplatin in an aqueous buffer.
  • the N ⁇ PE can be about 0.8 mol % to about 12 mol % to total lipid content.
  • the concentration of drug or labeled compound in solution can be as described herein, and, in particular as above for production method A.
  • the solution containing the drug or labeled compound includes the solution components as described herein.
  • Liposomes incorporating l-OHP (drug), DSPC, cholesterol and N-glutaryl-DSPE (NG-DOPE) prepared by this method can be isolated to provide an oxaliplatin-containing liposome (e.g., by gel-filtration, by size exclusion chromatography, by ultrafiltration, by ultracentrifugation, etc.) having a mean diameter of about 0.2 ⁇ m.
  • a portion of the N ⁇ PE present in the liposome prepared in step A is functionalized to yield a liposome incorporating SuccN ⁇ PE (i.e., drug: SuccN ⁇ PE:N ⁇ PE:additional lipids liposome), which can later be modified to form TF-N ⁇ PE.
  • the carboxyl group at a terminus of the N ⁇ PE is modified to form a succinimidyl group.
  • Such functionalization can be accomplished using the methods described for the production of SuccN ⁇ PE(s).
  • a carbodiimmide e.g., EDC, DCC, etc.
  • NHS N-hydroxysulfosuccinimide
  • step B the drug: SuccN ⁇ PE:N ⁇ PE:additional lipids liposome prepared in step B is reacted with targeting factor to form drug: TF-N ⁇ PE:N ⁇ PE:additional lipids liposome.
  • the methods and conditions for the reaction are as described for production method A, step D.
  • the drug: TF-N ⁇ PE:N ⁇ PE:additional lipids liposomes obtained by production method B can be purified and concentrated using methods as described herein and known to the skilled artisan.
  • Production method A has several advantages over production method B, though both can be used to obtain drug:TF-N ⁇ PE:N ⁇ PE:additional lipids liposomes (targeted liposomes, optionally containing either drug or labeled compound).
  • the liposomes obtained by method A will be free or substantially free of impurities (e.g., non-NHS starting materials and/or by-products) related to the production of the SuccN ⁇ PEs.
  • impurities e.g., non-NHS starting materials and/or by-products
  • targeted liposomes prepared by production method A will be free, or substantially free, of e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., EDC, DCC, etc.), and acylated ureas.
  • the liposome or liposome-containing composition can also be free or substantially free of NHS. Additionally, the larger a scale of reaction, the more a preparation time. The time for production method A is substantially shorter than production method B.
  • SuccN ⁇ PE is likely oriented to the interior of the liposomes (e.g., the succinimidyl ester functionality is on the interior of the lipid bilayer and inaccessible to reaction with targeting factor), it is likely that targeted liposomes prepared by production method A might have some residual SuccN ⁇ PE incorporated therein.
  • An additional advantage of production method A is that the relative content of TF-N ⁇ PE vs. N ⁇ PE in the final drug: TF-N ⁇ PE:N ⁇ PE:additional lipids liposomes can be controlled more accurately when production method A is used.
  • the relative amounts of these lipids are directly related to the relative amounts of the SuccN ⁇ PE and N ⁇ PE used as starting materials in step A of production method A.
  • the amount of TF-modified SuccN ⁇ PE can also be controlled more accurately.
  • the relative amounts of N ⁇ PE vs. SuccN ⁇ PE are dependent upon the reaction efficiency of method B step B. This reaction is believed to go to completion for about approximately 10% of the N ⁇ PE present in the liposome, but experimental variation would be expected from batch to batch. The low reaction efficiency is likely due, in part, to the steric hindrance of the pre-formed liposome.
  • SuccN ⁇ PE is formed from isolated N ⁇ PE (lipid only), there is far less steric hindrance and the reaction goes farther to completion.
  • the resultant product can be purified from the reaction mixture, thus removing unreacted N ⁇ PE, carbodiimmide and NHS, as well as other by-products that may form during the reaction.
  • the liposomes formed by either method appear to be more homogeneous (and therefore can be used to produce a more reproducible drug/diagnostic product) than liposomes that incorporate PEG or other hydrophilic polymers, such as those described in the Background section of the present specification.
  • PEG or other hydrophilic polymers when PEG or other hydrophilic polymers are used to increase the circulation time of liposomes (e.g., to shield the liposomes from uptake by the RES), their use results in liposomes with a distribution of molecular size-due to the broad distribution of the PEG or hydrophilic polymers themselves. This distribution increases the difficulties associated with manufacture (e.g., reproducibility and/or purification) and may also increase the variability in clinical efficacy. Targeted liposomes prepared by either method A or B should be superior in these respects.
  • Lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions may also be prepared by modification of production methods A and B.
  • lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions incorporating additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE or additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE:drug/labeled compound (where “additional lipid component(s)” refers to one or more phospholipids (e.g., one or more neutral, one or more anionic, one or more cationic phospholipids or combinations of two or more of the foregoing), optionally additionally comprising one or more additional lipids as described herein (e.g., cholesterol or a derivative thereof); or at least two different neutral lipids as described herein, (e.g., at least one phospholipid(s) (e.g.
  • PCs e.g., DMPC, DSPC, etc.
  • PI sphingomyelin
  • phosphatidic acid e.g., phosphatidic acid
  • at least one other neutral lipid e.g., cholesterol
  • the additional lipids, N ⁇ PE, TF-N ⁇ PE and, where present, drug or labeled compound components may be as described throughout the present specification. Similarly, the relative amounts of the components are also as described through the present specification.
  • the lipid mixture produced in the first step of production method B may be modified to incorporate NHS and then modified with a TF to produce a additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE lipid mixture.
  • This lipid mixture can then be mixed with aqueous solution (optionally containing drug or labeled compound) to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • a drug or labeled compound can be incorporated after the liposome-containing composition has been prepared.
  • drug or labeled compound free of aqueous solution can be incorporated in the lipid mixture, formed after modification with NHS and TF, to form a additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE:drug/labeled compound lipid mixture.
  • This lipid mixture can subsequently be mixed with an aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • the lipid mixture produced in the first step of production method B may be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition (additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE).
  • This liposome-containing composition may then either be treated with NHS and TF and subsequently mixed with drug or labeled compound to form a additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE:drug/labeled compound liposome-containing composition.
  • the additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE liposome-containing composition may be treated with drug or labeled compound and then modified with NHS followed by TF.
  • the lipid mixture produced in the first step of production method B may then be mixed with drug or labeled compound (optionally including aqueous solution) to form a lipid mixture (where the drug or labeled compound does not include aqueous solution) or liposome-containing composition.
  • drug or labeled compound optionally including aqueous solution
  • the lipid mixture can then be treated with NHS and TF to form a additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE:drug/labeled compound lipid mixture, which can then be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • this liposome-containing composition can subsequently be treated with NHS and TF to also yield a additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE:drug/labeled compound liposome-containing composition.
  • lipid mixture C-1
  • lipid mixture C-1 e.g., components: additional lipid component(s); N ⁇ PE; TF-N ⁇ PE or components: additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE:drug or labeled compound
  • Lipid mixture C-1 can then be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition C-2 (additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE (optionally containing drug or labeled compound).
  • the drug or labeled compound may be added after formation of the liposome-containing composition (C2-A).
  • the liposome-containing composition can be formed simultaneously upon the mixing of all the starting components.
  • C-2 (optionally containing drug or labeled compound) or C2-A, may then be treated to form a liposome (C-3).
  • C-3 does not include a drug or labeled compound, the liposome will be an blank liposome, as previously described (e.g., additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE liposome).
  • C-3 includes a drug or labeled compound, the liposome will be a targeted liposome as described herein.
  • C-3 is an blank liposome
  • a drug or labeled compound may, as previously described, be added to the blank liposome in a subsequent step to form a targeted liposome, which may be performed immediately after preparation of C-3 or after a delay, which may include storage of the C-3 blank liposome for a period of time.
  • lipid mixture D ⁇ 1 e.g., components: additional lipid component(s); N ⁇ PE; or components: additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:drug or labeled compound.
  • Lipid mixture D-1 can then be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition D-2 (additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:(optionally containing drug or labeled compound).
  • Liposome-containing composition D-2 can then be mixed with TF-N ⁇ PE to form a liposome-containing composition D-3 (additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE (optionally containing drug or labeled compound)), where the TF-N ⁇ PE is prepared and optionally purified prior to admixture.
  • the drug or labeled compound may be added after formation of the liposome-containing composition (D3-A).
  • the liposome-containing composition can be formed simultaneously upon the mixing of all the components.
  • D-3 (optionally containing drug or labeled compound) or D3-A, may then be treated to form a liposome (D-4).
  • D-4 does not include a drug or labeled compound, the liposome will be an blank liposome, as previously described (e.g., additional lipid component(s):N ⁇ PE:TF-N ⁇ PE liposome).
  • D-4 includes a drug or labeled compound, the liposome will be a targeted liposome as described herein.
  • D-4 is an blank liposome
  • a drug or labeled compound may, as previously described, be added to the blank liposome in a subsequent step to form a targeted liposome, which may be performed immediately after preparation of D-4 or after a delay, which may include storage of the D-4 blank liposome for a period of time.
  • the lipid-containing compositions prepared by production method C or method D will be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-( ⁇ )-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.), so long as the starting material (e.g., TF-NG-PE) is substantially free of these substances prior to the initial step of production method C or method D.
  • the starting material e.g., TF-NG-PE
  • the liposome or liposome-containing composition can also be free or substantially free of NHS, as in when TF-N ⁇ PE is pre-formed and used as starting material.
  • the lipid-containing compositions prepared by production method C or method D are substantially free of DCC and EDC.
  • the lipid-containing compositions prepared by production method C or method D are substantially free of DCC.
  • the additional lipid component(s) includes one or more phospholipid (e.g., a phosphatidyl choline, etc.) and a cholesterol or cholesterol derivative.
  • the phosphatidyl choline is DMPC, POPC, DSPC, etc. as herein described.
  • the phosphatidyl choline is DMPC or DSPC.
  • the additional lipid(s) are a phospholipid and cholesterol.
  • the phospholipid is a neutral phospholipid.
  • the additional lipid component(s) include at least two different neutral lipids, which include a phospholipid (e.g., a phosphatidyl choline, etc.) and a cholesterol or cholesterol derivative.
  • a phospholipid e.g., a phosphatidyl choline, etc.
  • the phosphatidyl choline is DMPC, POPC, DSPC, etc. as herein described.
  • the phosphatidyl choline is DMPC or DSPC.
  • the at least two different neutral lipids are a phospholipid and cholesterol.
  • the N ⁇ PE is an NG-PE.
  • the N ⁇ PE is N ⁇ -DOPE or N ⁇ -DSPE.
  • the N ⁇ PE is NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • the TF is for example, asialoglycoprotein, folate, transferrin, etc.
  • the TF is transferrin (Tf).
  • the TF-N ⁇ PE is a Tf-N ⁇ PE (e.g., Tf-NG-DOPE or Tf-NG-DSPE).
  • the drug is, for example, an anticancer agent (e.g., oxaliplatin, topoisomerase I inhibitor, vinca alkaloid, etc.).
  • the lipid mixture or liposome-containing composition includes a labeled compound. In some embodiments, the lipid mixture or liposome-containing composition does not include a labeled compound or drug.
  • each of the lipid mixtures may be mixed with an aqueous solution to form liposome-containing compositions and each of the liposome-containing compositions may be treated to form the corresponding liposomes (e.g., targeted liposomes (e.g., incorporating drug or labeled compound), intermediate liposomes, blank liposomes, etc.), as described in detail herein.
  • targeted liposomes e.g., incorporating drug or labeled compound
  • intermediate liposomes e.g., blank liposomes, etc.
  • the present invention provides pharmaceutical formulations for treatment or diagnosis of individuals in need thereof, comprising lipid-containing compositions as described herein and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, preservatives, or other inactive ingredients, including combinations of the foregoing, known to skilled artisans and described further herein.
  • the lipid-containing composition is a targeted liposome as described herein. In other embodiments, the lipid-containing composition is a liposome-containing composition. In some embodiments, the lipid-containing composition is an blank liposome. In certain embodiments, the composition comprises a drug. In other embodiments, the composition comprises a labeled compound.
  • the carrier may include one or more of sterile water, a buffer solution or saline, diluent, and combinations thereof.
  • the pharmaceutical formulations may further comprise one or more of different salts, sugars, proteins, starch, gelatin, plant oils, polyethylene glycol and the like, including combinations of two or more of the foregoing.
  • An additional aspect of the invention includes use of the compositions and formulations thereof as described herein in the manufacture of a medicament. Particularly, the manufacture of a medicament for use in the treatment or diagnosis of conditions as described herein. Further, the active compositions and formulations thereof, variously described herein, are also intended for use in the manufacture of a medicament for use in treatment or diagnosis of the conditions and, in accordance with the methods, described herein, unless otherwise noted.
  • lipid-containing compositions e.g., targeted liposomes, drug-/labeled compound-containing liposome-containing compositions
  • pharmaceutical formulations as described herein.
  • the methods may be practiced as a therapeutic approach towards the treatment of the conditions described herein.
  • the drug-containing lipid-containing compositions or pharmaceutical formulations may be used to treat the conditions described herein in individuals in need thereof, including humans.
  • the methods generally comprise administering to the individual an amount of a composition, or formulation described herein, effective to treat the condition.
  • the methods may practiced as a diagnostic approach towards the diagnosis of the conditions described herein.
  • the labeled compound-containing lipid-containing compositions or pharmaceutical formulations may be used to diagnosis the conditions described herein in individuals in need thereof, including humans.
  • the methods generally comprise administering to the individual an amount of a composition, or formulation described herein, effective to diagnosis the condition. Such administration is generally undertaken in conjunction with methods to detect the condition.
  • the individual is a mammal, including, but not limited to, human, bovine, horse, feline, canine, rodent, or primate. In other embodiments, the individual is a human.
  • pharmaceutically effective amount refers to an amount of a composition sufficient to treat a specified disorder, condition or disease or one or more of its symptoms and/or to prevent the occurrence of the disease or disorder.
  • a pharmaceutically or therapeutically effective amount comprises an amount sufficient to, among other things, cause a tumor to shrink or to decrease the growth rate of the tumor.
  • an amount effective to diagnose or “diagnostically effective amount” or “amounts effective for diagnosis” cognates thereof, refer to an amount of a composition sufficient to diagnose a specified disorder, condition or disease, and/or one or more of its manifestations, where diagnosis includes identification of the existence of the disease and/or detection of the extent or severity of the disease.
  • a “diagnostically effective amount” comprises an amount sufficient to detect, for example, the presence and/or concentration of one or more of malignant cells, tumor(s) or other manifestation of the cancer.
  • diagnosis will be carried out with reference to a baseline or background detection level observed for individuals without the condition. Levels of detection above background or baseline levels (elevated levels of detection) are indicative of the presence and, in some cases, the severity of the condition.
  • an individual “in need thereof” may be an individual who has been diagnosed with or previously treated for the condition to be treated.
  • an individual “in need thereof” may be an individual who is suspected to have a condition, is at risk for a condition (e.g., a family history of the condition, life-style factors indicative of risk for the condition (e.g., smoking as a risk factor for lung cancer, etc.)) or has previously been diagnosed with the condition (e.g., diagnosis can include monitoring of the severity (e.g., progression/regression) of the disease over time and/or in conjunction with therapy).
  • a condition e.g., a family history of the condition, life-style factors indicative of risk for the condition (e.g., smoking as a risk factor for lung cancer, etc.)
  • diagnosis can include monitoring of the severity (e.g., progression/regression) of the disease over time and/or in conjunction with therapy).
  • the condition to be treated or diagnosed is cancer.
  • the cancer may be a gastric, colon, colorectal or breast cancer.
  • the cancer is a colon cancer.
  • the cancer is a breast cancer.
  • the cancer is a gastric cancer.
  • the cancer is cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovarian cancer, or hematological malignancies (e.g., leukemia, lymphoma, multiple myeloma, etc.).
  • compositions including formulations described herein, may be used alone or in conjunction with (e.g., prior to, concurrently with, or after) other modes of treatments (e.g., adjunctive cancer therapy, combined modality treatments).
  • other therapeutic agents e.g., cancer chemotherapeutic agents as described herein and known to those of skill in the art (e.g., alkylating agents, taxanes, metabolic antagonist, antitumour antibiotic, plant alkaloids, hormone therapy drug, molecular target drug, etc.)
  • surgery and/or radiation therapy.
  • compositions described herein can be administered in conjunction with one or more of other anticancer agents or cytotoxic compounds as described herein and as know in the art, one or more additional agents to reduce the occurrence and/or severity of adverse reactions and/or clinical manifestations thereof, surgery (e.g., to remove a tumor or lymph nodes, etc.) or radiation.
  • surgery e.g., to remove a tumor or lymph nodes, etc.
  • radiation e.g., to remove a tumor or lymph nodes, etc.
  • the compositions may be administered before, concurrently, or after the radiation therapy or surgery.
  • the compositions, and formulations thereof, as described herein may be administered before, concurrently, or after the administration of one or more anticancer agents.
  • the targeted liposomes and formulations thereof described herein may also be administered in conjunction with (e.g., prior to, concurrently with, or after) drugs to alleviate the symptoms associated with the condition or the treatment regimen (e.g., drugs to reduce vomiting, hair loss, immunosuppression, diarrhea, rash, sensory disturbance, anemia, fatigue, stomatitis, hand foot syndrome, etc.).
  • drugs to alleviate the symptoms associated with the condition or the treatment regimen e.g., drugs to reduce vomiting, hair loss, immunosuppression, diarrhea, rash, sensory disturbance, anemia, fatigue, stomatitis, hand foot syndrome, etc.
  • the targeted liposomes may also be administered at more than one stage of (including throughout) the treatment regimen (e.g., after surgery and concurrently with and after radiation therapy, etc.).
  • the labeled compound-containing compositions may be used alone or in conjunction with (e.g., prior to, concurrently with, or after) modes of treatments (e.g., adjunctive cancer therapy, combined modality treatments).
  • the compositions may be used to monitor the progress of treatment. For example, to determined if the condition being treated is detectable before, after or concurrently with a treatment regimen (as described above with respect to methods of treatment).
  • the compositions are administered prior to or after surgery (e.g., removal of a tumor or lymph nodes, etc.). In other embodiments, the compositions are administered after surgery and prior to, concurrently with or after radiation therapy.
  • surgery and/or radiation therapy in conjunction with administration of the compositions described herein, and, optionally, additional one or more chemotherapeutic agents, can be determined by an attending physician based on the individual and taking into consideration the various factors effecting the particular individual, including those described herein.
  • the drug-containing compositions or pharmaceutical formulations may be administered in combination with one or both of 5-fluorouracil and/or leucovorin.
  • the drug-containing composition or pharmaceutical formulations may be administered in combination with one or more other anti cancer drugs such as capecitabine, UFT/LV (tegafur-uracil and leucovorin), irinotecan, anti EGFR antibody (e.g., cetuximab, etc.), anti VEGF antibody (e.g., avastin, etc.), tyrosine kinase inhibitor (e.g., erlotinib), etc.
  • anti cancer drugs such as capecitabine, UFT/LV (tegafur-uracil and leucovorin), irinotecan, anti EGFR antibody (e.g., cetuximab, etc.), anti VEGF antibody (e.g., avastin, etc.), tyrosine kinase inhibitor (e.g.,
  • the lipid-containing compositions or pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention may be administered parenterally.
  • Parenteral administration may be accomplished via bolus injection (IV), infusion (IV), intraperitoneal injection, or via local injection (such as intracranial injection).
  • the administration is via a bolus injection or continuous infusion.
  • Continuous intravenous infusion may be administered over a period of minutes or hours. For example, but not limited to, from about 10 minutes to about 5 hours, from about 15 minutes to about 4 hours; from about 30 minutes to about 4 hours; from about 45 minutes to about 4 hours, from about 60 minutes to about 4 hours, from about 45 minutes to about 3 hours, from about 60 minutes to about 2 hours, from about 90 minutes to about 3 hours, from about 90 minutes to about 2 hours, about 10 minutes, about 15 minutes, about 20 minutes, about 30 minutes, about 45 minutes, about 50 minutes, about 60 minutes, 80 minutes, about 1.5 hours, about 2 hours, about 2.5 hours, about 3 hours, about 3.5 hours, about 4 hours, about 5 hours, about 12 hours, about 24 hours, about 36 hours, or about 48 hours.
  • lipid-containing compositions and pharmaceutical formulations as described herein may be administered to individuals in need thereof for the treatment or diagnosis of conditions as described herein in conjunction with the methods of use described herein.
  • compositions described herein, and, in particular the targeted liposomes described herein will generally be used in an amount effective to achieve the intended result, for example in an amount effective to treat or prevent the particular condition being treated.
  • the composition(s) may be administered therapeutically to achieve therapeutic benefit.
  • therapeutic benefit is meant eradication or amelioration of the underlying disorder being treated and/or eradication or amelioration of one or more of the symptoms associated with the underlying disorder such that the patient reports an improvement in feeling or condition, notwithstanding that the patient may still be afflicted with the underlying disorder.
  • Therapeutic benefit also includes halting or slowing the progression of the disease, regardless of whether improvement is realized.
  • an effective amount is an amount sufficient to reduce tumor growth (e.g., as measured by rate of increase of mean tumor volume prior to and/or after treatment). In certain embodiments, an effective amount is an amount sufficient to decrease mean tumor volume (e.g., where mean tumor volume after treatment is reduced compared to mean tumor volume prior to treatment).
  • compositions administered in order to administer an effective amount of encapsulated drug will depend upon a variety of factors, including, for example, the particular condition being treated, the mode of administration, the severity of the condition being treated and the age and weight of the patient, the bioavailability of the composition, the adverse effects experienced by the individual being treated, etc. Determination of an effective dosage is well within the capabilities of those skilled in the art in view of the teachings provided herein.
  • the dose of encapsulated oxaliplatin administered at a particular time point will be in the range from about 1 to about 400 mg/m 2 /day.
  • the dose of encapsulated oxaliplatin administered at a particular time point will be in the range from about 1 to about 400 mg/m 2 /day.
  • the range from about 1 to about 350 mg/m 2 /day, 1 to about 300 mg/m 2 /day, 1 to about 250 mg/m 2 /day, 1 to about 200 mg/m 2 /day, 1 to about 150 mg/m 2 /day, 1 to about 100 mg/m 2 /day, from about 5 to about 80 mg/m 2 /day, from about 5 to about 70 mg/m 2 /day, from about 5 to about 60 mg/m 2 /day, from about 5 to about 50 mg/m 2 /day, from about 5 to about 40 mg/m 2 /day, from about 5 to about 20 mg/m 2 /day, from about 10 to about 80 mg/m 2 /
  • the does administered at a particular time point may also be about 130 mg/m 2 /day, about 120 mg/m 2 /day, about 100 mg/m 2 /day, about 90 mg/m 2 /day, about 85 mg/m 2 /day, about 80 mg/m 2 /day, about 70 mg/m 2 /day, about 60 mg/m 2 /day, about 50 mg/m 2 /day, about 40 mg/m 2 /day, about 30 mg/m 2 /day, about 20 mg/m 2 /day, about 15 mg/m 2 /day, or about 10 mg/m 2 /day.
  • the dose administered may be higher or lower than the dose ranges described herein, depending upon, among other factors, the bioavailability of the composition, the tolerance of the individual to adverse side effects, the mode of administration and various factors discussed above. Dosage amount and interval may be adjusted individually to provide plasma levels of the composition that are sufficient to maintain therapeutic effect, according to the judgment of the prescribing physician. Skilled artisans will be able to optimize effective local dosages without undue experimentation in view of the teaching provided herein.
  • Dosages may also be estimated using in vivo animal models, as will be appreciated by those skill in the art.
  • compositions as described herein may also be administered to individuals in need thereof of the course of hours, days, weeks, or months. For example, but not limited to, daily, every other day, every 10 days, weekly, monthly, twice weekly, three times a week, twice monthly, three times a month, four times a month, five times a month, every other month, every third month, every fourth month, etc.
  • kits for administration of the compositions described herein including pharmaceutical formulations comprising the compositions.
  • kits may include a dosage amount (e.g., as used for therapy or diagnosis) of at least one lipid-containing composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, as disclosed herein. Kits may further comprise suitable packaging and/or instructions for use of the composition. Kits may also comprise a means for the delivery for the composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, such as a syringe for injection or other device as described herein and known to those of skill in the art.
  • a dosage amount e.g., as used for therapy or diagnosis
  • Kits may further comprise suitable packaging and/or instructions for use of the composition.
  • Kits may also comprise a means for the delivery for the composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, such as a syringe for injection or other device as described herein and known to those of skill in the art.
  • kits may include a dosage amount (e.g., as used for therapy or diagnosis) of a blank liposome, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, as disclosed herein. Kits may further comprise suitable packaging and/or instructions for use of the composition. Kits may also comprise a means for the delivery for the composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, such as a syringe for injection or other device as described herein and known to those of skill in the art. Additionally, in certain embodiments, the kit may contain a separate dosage amount of the drug or labeled compound to be incorporated into the blank liposome.
  • the lipid-containing composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof may be assembled in the form of kits.
  • the kit provides the lipid-containing composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof and reagents to prepare a composition for administration.
  • the composition may be in a dry or lyophilized form, or in a solution, particularly a sterile solution.
  • the reagent may comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable diluent for preparing a liquid formulation.
  • diluents include those known to those of skill in the art, for example, sugar solutions, e.g., dextrose, sucrose, etc.
  • kits may includes sugar solutions of about 1% to about 20%, about 1% to about 18%, about 1% to about 15%, about 1% to about 10%, about 3% to about 10%, about 3% to about 6%, about 1%, about 2%, about 3%, about 4%, about 5%, about 6%, about 7%, about 8%, about 9%, about 10%, about 12%, about 15%, about 18%, or about 20% sugar.
  • the solution may be a dextrose solution (e.g., about 1%, about 2%, about 5% dextrose, etc.).
  • the lipid-containing composition may be, for example, a targeted liposome, blank liposome, lipid mixture, or liposome-containing composition (optionally containing drug or labeled compound).
  • the kit may also contain a device for administration or for dispensing the compositions, including, but not limited to syringe, pipette, or other device known to those of skill.
  • a device for administration or for dispensing the compositions including, but not limited to syringe, pipette, or other device known to those of skill.
  • the composition When in a wet form, the composition may be stored in an ampoule or other sterile sealed container, including those known to persons of skill in the art.
  • kits may include other therapeutic compounds for use in conjunction with the compounds described herein.
  • the therapeutic agents are other anticancer agents. These agents may be provided in a separate form, or mixed with the compounds of the present invention, provided such mixing does not reduce the effectiveness of either the additional therapeutic agent of the compositions and formulations described herein.
  • the kits may include additional agents for adjunctive therapy. For example, agents to reduce the adverse effects of the drug (e.g., anti-nausea agents, anti-alopecia agents, immuno-enhancing agents, etc.).
  • kits will include appropriate instructions for preparation and administration of the composition, side effects of the compositions, and any other relevant information.
  • the instructions may be in any suitable format, including, but not limited to, printed matter, videotape, computer readable disk, or optical disc.
  • kits for treating an individual who suffers from or is susceptible to the conditions described herein comprising a first container comprising a dosage amount of a lipid-containing composition or formulations thereof as disclosed herein, and instructions for use.
  • the container may be any of those known in the art and appropriate for storage and delivery of intravenous formulations.
  • the kit further comprises a second container comprising a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, diluent, adjuvant, etc. for preparation of the composition to be administered to the individual.
  • Kits may also be provided that contain sufficient dosages of the compositions or formulations thereof as disclosed herein to provide effective treatment for an individual for an extended period, such as a week, 2 weeks, 3, weeks, 4 weeks, 6 weeks, 8 weeks, 3 months, 4 months, 5 months, 6 months, 7 months, 8 months, 9 months or more.
  • Kits may also include multiple doses of the lipid-containing composition or formulations thereof and instructions for use and packaged in quantities sufficient for storage and use in pharmacies, for example, hospital pharmacies and compounding pharmacies.
  • oxaliplatin (l-OHP) solution was prepared by dissolving oxaliplatin in a 9% sucrose solution (sucrose/distilled water) at a concentration of 8 mg/ml.
  • the cell viability was determined using a commercially available cytotoxicity assay kit (WST-1 kit, Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan).
  • AsPC-1 cells (provided by Dr. Hironobu Yanagie of Research Center for Advanced Science and Technology, the University of Tokyo, Japan) cultured in RPMI 1640 medium supplemented with 10% FCS (fetal calf serum; SIGMA, USA) were treated with concentrations of l-OHP solutions [200 ⁇ (1 ⁇ 2) (0-10) nM] at 37° C. in 5% CO 2 for 48 hours. Then, the medium was removed and a substrate (WST-1, Cell Counting Kit, Dojindo Laboratories, Japan) was added to the cells which were incubated at 37° C. in 5% CO 2 for 2 hours to develop the colored product. The developed color was measured at an absorbance of 450 nm (reference wavelength: 620 nm) on an Immuno Mini NJ-2300 (Cosmo Bio Co., Ltd., Japan).
  • the results are shown in FIG. 6 .
  • the cytotoxicity of l-OHP was found to be LD 50 >8 ⁇ g/ml.
  • K562:TKG0210 Cell Resource Center for Biomedical Research, Institute of Department, Aging and Cancer, Tohoku University, Japan
  • MKN45P Dr. Hisae Iinuma, Teikyo University School of Medicine, Japan
  • HL60:TKG0345 Cell Resource Center for Biomedical Research, Institute of Department, Aging and Cancer, Tohoku University, Japan
  • Tf (transferrin) receptors on the cell surface of each was determined by Scatchard analysis (Comp. Biochem. Physiol., 116B, 137-160 (1949), using Microsoft Excel).
  • a solution of 125 I-labeled Tf (Na— 125 I (PerkinElmer Japan Co., Ltd., Japan) and h-Tf (T-4132, SIGMA, USA) were combined by iodogen method (Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 122, 319-325 (1984)) was added to each cell culture at different concentrations ranging from [300 ⁇ (1 ⁇ 2) (0-9) nM] at 4° C. and incubated for 1 hour.
  • the concentration of 125 I-labeled Tf was determined by protein quantification assay by the Lowry method ( J. Biol. Chem., 193, 265-270 (1951)) and the radioactivity was measured using a gamma counter (Auto Well Gamma System ARC-300, Aloka Co., Ltd., Japan]. Briefly, the solution was centrifuged to precipitate the cells, and the cell fraction was washed with an ice-cooled PBS (180 ⁇ g (gravity), for 3 min, which was repeated 3 times, followed by the measurement of radioactivity with a gamma counter to determine the concentration of Tf bound to the cell surface. The number of cells was determined by protein quantification assay, using the Lowry method ( J. Biol. Chem., 193, 265-270 (1951)).
  • the concentration of unbound Tf was determined by subtracting the concentration of bound Tf from the known concentration of Tf added.
  • the Scatchard plot was drawn by plotting the concentration of bound Tf on the horizontal axis and the ratio of the concentration of bound Tf to the concentration of unbound Tf on the vertical axis.
  • the number of the bound Tf was determined from the x intercept of the graph, as described in Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 80 2263-2266 (1983); J. Cell Physiol., 132, 492-500 (1987); Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 92 3318-3322 (1995); J. Pharm. Sci., 84, 216-220 (1995); Eur. J. Biochem., 186, 367-373 (1989); J. Biol., Chem., 258, 4715-4724 (1983), which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety.
  • the number of 125 I-Tf bound to the cell surface in the different cell types are shown in FIG. 7 . It was determined that the number of transferrin (Tf) receptors on the cell surface of the cell lines derived from human malignant tumors was significantly higher than that in normal leukocytes.
  • a solution of DCC (99%, Aldrich, USA, MW: 206.33 g/mol) was prepared by dissolving 70 mg of DCC in 5 mL ethyl acetate. The DCC dissolved quickly in the solvent to yield a clear solution. The DCC solution so prepared (approximately 5 mL) was then added dropwise to the lipid/NHS reaction mixture over 10-15 minute period. The reaction mixture became more cloudy upon addition of DCC.
  • TLC was performed on the control (lipid/NHS) and on an aliquot of lipid/NHS/DCC at time 0 for reference, as follows.
  • Sample was spotted 50 ⁇ g (2.5 ⁇ L of 20 mg/mL) on TLC plate (aluminum sheet-silica gel 60F 254 from EM Science (Gibbstown, N.J., USA) Cat No. SP05554M), dried and then placed in the developing chamber where solvent (70% chloroform, 28% methanol, 2% water) was allowed to migrate.
  • the solvent front was marked and then the TLC plate was dipped in ammonium molybdate (5% ammonium molybdate in 10% H 2 SO 4 ) and dehydrated with dryer.
  • the lipid/NHS/DCC reaction mixture was stirred under nitrogen flow and the formation of product was monitored (Rf 0.3-0.4) over time.
  • reaction mixtures was chilled reaction on ice for ⁇ 30 minutes.
  • the chilled reaction mixture was then filtered through a Buckner funnel and then washed 3 times with 2 ⁇ 5 mL chloroform. All of the liquid obtained was collected and dried by rotary evaporation. A semi-solid paste was obtained after evaporation. The paste was then resuspended in 2-3 mL chloroform.
  • Silica gel for purification of the suspended paste was prepared using silica (400 mesh) 4 g—hydrated in chloroform.
  • the silica gel was packed onto a 1 cm ⁇ 28 cm column with stopcock. The approximate size of the bed was 1 cm ⁇ 14 cm.
  • the column was equilibrated with chloroform (gravity packed).
  • fractions 6-10 After collection of fractions 6-10, a volume of 100 mL chloroform/methanol (5/1 (v/v)) was added to the column (10 ⁇ 10 mL). And additional 10 ⁇ 10 mL fractions were collected and designated fractions 11-15.
  • fractions 7-11 were pooled and dried to a thin film using rotary evaporation.
  • the final product obtained after evaporation was 130 mg (65% yield), as determined by TLC against the unpurified reaction product and comparison with a standard product (NHS-NG-DOPE) obtained from NOF (Japan).
  • NG-DOPE 200 mg
  • NHS N-hydroxysulfosuccinimide
  • the flask was then placed under vacuum and filled with nitrogen gas flowing gently (repeat at three times). The flask was then kept under nitrogen using a nitrogen balloon.
  • a TLC (70% chloroform, 30% methanol, 5% water) on lipid/NHS and lipid/NHS/DCC was performed to monitor the reaction by spotting 50 mg of chloroform on the TLC plate, allowing to dry, which was then placed in the reaction chamber (70% chloroform, 30% methanol, 5% water) to migrate.
  • reaction mixture continued with stirring under nitrogen flow and the formation of product (Rf 0.3-0.4) was monitored over time.
  • the reaction was allowed to proceed over a time period of 2-3 days at ambient temperature with nitrogen flow and stirring.
  • reaction mixture was then filtered through a Bruchner funnel and washed twice with 2 ⁇ 5 mL chloroform. The entire solution was collected and dried by rotary-evaporation. A semi-solid paste was obtained.
  • the semi-solid paste was resuspended in 2 ⁇ 3 mL chloroform, and then filtered and dried. This process was repeated three times. Finally, after three times the product was resuspended in 2 ⁇ 3 mL chloroform.
  • Fraction 1 Added 100 mL chloroform/methanol (90/10, vol/vol) to column. Collected 100 mL fractions. (Fraction 2)
  • the resulting solution was poured into a vial and frozen for about 8 hours on a shelf at ⁇ 40° C. It was depressurized to about 0.1 mmHg and kept at reduced pressure for 2 days with rising the temperature from ⁇ 40° C. to 25° C. stepwise, from which process a lyophilized lipid mixture was obtained.
  • a powder of the lyophilized lipid mixture as obtained above was mixed with 20 mg of powdery Tf-NG-DOPE (as prepared in Example 29) and crashed. A homogeneous powder of lipid mixture was thus obtained, with a lipid ratio of 50:45:5 (DMPC:Chol:NG-DOPE+Tf-NG-DOPE).
  • Entries 1, 3 and 5 were each hydrated and stirred with 300 mM of aqueous sucrose solution (20 v/w vs. lipids (5 mL) (5 mL of sucrose solution (20 v/w) was added to the dry lipid mixture and stirred) for 30 min. at 40-45° C.
  • Entries 2, 4 and 6 were each hydrated and stirred with an aqueous solution of l-OHP (8 mg l-OHP/mL, 20 v/w vs. lipids (5 mL) in a 300 mM sucrose solution) for 30 min. at 40-45° C. A liposome-containing mixture was thus obtained.
  • Liposome diameter was determined by QELS and the results are shown in FIG. 8 .
  • the liposomes present in the liposome-containing mixture have a mean diameter of 500-2,000 nm and have a broad distribution of sizes around 100-10,000 nm.
  • composition of the liposome was as follows:
  • Dimyristoyl phosphatidylcholine (1,2-dimyristoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphocholine: DMPC) (NOF Corporation, Japan)
  • N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine N-glutaryl-1,2-dioleoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphoethanolamine, sodium salt: DOPE-CO—(CH 2 ) 3 —COOH; hereinafter represented by NG-DOPE) (NOF Corporation, Japan)
  • Succ-N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine N-(succinimidyl-glutaryl)-1,2-dioleoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphoethanolamine, sodium salt: DOPE-CO—(CH 2 ) 3 —CO—OSu; hereinafter represented by NHS-NG-DOPE) (NOF Corporation, Japan)
  • DMPC:CH:NG-DOPE:NHS-NG-DOPE 50:45:4:1 (m/m).
  • aqueous phase an aqueous solution of l-OHP (8 mg/ml, in a 300 mM sucrose solution) was used.
  • a mixture of DMPC, CH, NG-DOPE and NHS-NG-DOPE (at the mole ratio of 50:45:4:1) was dissolved in 4 v/w (vs. total lipid weight) of warm ethanol/t-butanol/water solvent.
  • the lipid solution was injected into 300 mM sucrose solution containing about 8 mg/ml l-OHP at about 45° C., so that the concentration of the solvent became about 14% v/v.
  • the suspension was passed through an Extruder that was lapped over five pieces of 100 nm filters (Cat. No. 112105, Whatman plc, UK) under pressure of about 200-800 psi at about 45° C.
  • the liposome was thus obtained, having an average diameter in the vicinity of 100 nm. Liposome diameter was determined using QELS.
  • composition of the liposome was as follows:
  • aqueous phase an aqueous solution of l-OHP (8 mg/ml, in a 9% sucrose solution) was used, as described in Example 1.
  • the resultant product was sized at 60° C. using EXTRUDER filters (twice at 400 nm and then five times at 100 nm), (LipexTM Extruder, Model No. T-001, Northern Lipids Inc., Canada) and ultracentrifuged (200,000 ⁇ g, 60 min, about 4° C.). The precipitate was resuspended in a 9% sucrose solution or MES buffer (pH 5.5) (MES buffer. Cat. No. 345-01625, Dojindo Laboratories, Japan) to obtain l-OHP-encapsulated NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposome.
  • transferrin (Tf) in an amount of 20% relative to the weight of the lipid; (Cat. No. T4132, SIGMA, USA) was added and stirred at room temperature for 3 hours.
  • PBS Phosphate buffered saline
  • transferrin was performed by the bicinchoninic acid (BCA) assays, performed in accordance with the vendor's instruction (Cat. No. 23227, BCATM Protein Assay Kit, Pierce Biotechnology, Inc., USA).
  • BCA bicinchoninic acid
  • DSPC:cholesterol:DSPE-PEG(2K)-OMe:DSPE-PEG(3.4K)-COOH liposomes Tf-PEG-liposomes
  • This liposome contained 6% by mole of PEG-lipid and 1% by mole of PEG-COOH-lipid, and Tf is bound to the liposome through PEG-COOH.
  • Tf/PEG-DSPE liposomes Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes.
  • This liposome is derivatized with PEG, and the Tf was bound to the liposome through NG-DSPE.
  • PEG-derivatized liposomes can also be produced by the methods described in U.S. Pat. App. Pub. Nos. 2003/0224037 and 2004/0022842, the disclosures of which are hereby incorporated in their entirety.
  • a mixture of DMPC, Chol (Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan), NG-DOPE (NOF Corporation, Japan) and NHS-NG-DOPE (NOF Corporation, Japan) (at the mole ratio of 50:45:4:1; 410 g of DMPC, 211 g of Chol, 43 g of NG-DOPE and 12 g of NHS-NG-DOPE, respectively) was dissolved in 4 v/w (vs. total lipid weight) of warm ethanol/t-butanol/water solvent. The resulting suspension with a volume of 20 L was incubated at 45° C.
  • the liposome suspension, PBS buffer (pH 7.9) and PBS solution of transferrin (Cat. No. 4455, Selorogicals, GA, USA) (pH 7.0) were mixed at the ratio of 3:1:1 (v/v), then stirred for 15-60 min. at 30° C. Approximately 6 L blank liposome was thus obtained.
  • aqueous solution of l-OHP (8 mg/mL, in a 300 mM sucrose solution) was added to about 3.5 g of lyophilized blank liposome and rehydrated by stirring for 2 hours at 40° C. After stirring, liposomal l-OHP was separated from free l-OHP by fractionation using Sephadex G-25 ( ⁇ 1 ⁇ 45 cm). The liposome l-OHP and free l-OHP were monitored by VIS 600 nm and UV 210 nm respectively.
  • the amount of l-OHP and cholesterol was measured.
  • the l-OHP concentration was calculated for the case of condensing the liposome fraction to the original cholesterol concentration finally, the yield of l-OHP was measured by comparison of the l-OHP concentration of liposome and a feeding concentration of l-OHP.
  • Total l-OHP concentration for the case of condensing the liposome fraction to the original cholesterol concentration was 210 m/mL. And the yield of l-OHP was 2.6%.
  • the cells were obtained from Laboratory of Biopharmaceutics, Teikyo University School of Pharmaceutical Sciences, Japan.
  • Colon 26 cells (2 ⁇ 10 6 cells) subcultured in vitro were subcutaneously implanted into the dorsal region of the mice.
  • a mouse bearing a tumor with a diameter of about 8 to 10 mm (after 8 to 10 days growth on average) was used as the colon cancer-bearing mouse.
  • a solution of each of the liposomes prepared in Examples 8 and 9 or l-OHP (8 mg/ml in a 9% sucrose solution) was injected into the tail vein.
  • the concentration of oxaliplatin was adjusted at 5 mg l-OHP/kg body weight in each case.
  • Tf-NG-DSPE liposome (( ⁇ ); Example 8), Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposome (( ); Example 9) and Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome (( ⁇ ); Example 9) were used.
  • Blood, plasma, liver, spleen, kidney, heart, lung and tumor tissues were collected from 3 mice at each time point for each group at 1, 3, 6, 24, 48 and 72 hours after the administration.
  • the Pt concentration in the blood, each organ and tumor tissues were determined using atomic absorption (AA), and the l-OHP concentration was calculated and reported as the ratio (%) to the dose.
  • the concentrations in the blood are shown in FIG. 9 .
  • Tf-NG-DSPE liposome showed substantially the same blood retention until 3 hours after the administration compared with Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome and Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposome. However, after 6 hours, Tf-NG-DSPE liposome showed some blood retention, but it disappeared more quickly from the blood compared with the PEG liposomes. The concentrations in the tumor tissues are shown in FIG. 10 . Tf-NG-DSPE liposome showed substantially the same accumulation to tumor tissues as Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome and Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposome, despite being retained at a lower concentration in the blood over time.
  • Liposomes were prepared in the same manner as in Example 7 with the exception that [ 125 I]-Tyraminyl inulin (in PBS solution) replaced l-OHP and DMPC/CH/NG-DOPE/Tf-NG-DOPE/[ 125 I]-Tyraminyl inulin liposomes were obtained. Lipid components were obtained also as described in Example 7. Two liposome formulations were prepared, with the components as shown below. The liposome lacking Tf-NG-DOPE served as a control for non-targeted distribution of the liposome.
  • DMPC/CH/NG-DOPE/Tf-NG-DOPE (63.3/31.7/4/1 (m/m))
  • 125 I was bound to tyraminyl inulin by combining Na— 125 I (PerkinElmer Japan Co., Ltd., Japan) and tyraminyl inulin (Dr. Kazuo Maruyama, Teikyo University, Faculty of Pharmaceutical Sciences, Japan) using the iodogen method (Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 122, 319-325 (1984), incorporated by reference in its entirety).
  • 125 I-Tyraminyl inulin was thus obtained.
  • 125 I-Tyraminyl inulin/PBS( ⁇ ) solution at a concentration of about 1 mg/mL was then encapsulated into the liposome as described in Example 7.
  • the radioactivity of 100 ⁇ l of the administered solution was defined as 100% and the count value of an empty test tube was defined as the value of the background (b.g.).
  • the results are shown in FIG. 11 .
  • Tf-modified liposome shows high accumulation to a tumor tissue, while non-targeted liposomes do not show a high accumulation.
  • Tf-PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9 Tf-NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8, Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9; 9 mice in each group
  • Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9 9 mice in each group
  • each of the liposome compositions to which transferrin is not bound (( ⁇ )TF; 6 mice in each group).
  • the tumor-bearing mice were prepared in the same manner as in Example 12.
  • a solution of l-OHP 8 mg/ml in a 9% sucrose solution
  • the date when 1-OHP was administered at doses of 5 mg/kg was defined as the start date, and on day 4, l-OHP was administered at doses of 5 mg/kg again.
  • the size of the tumor on day 0 was defined as 1, and the size was shown as the ratio based on this starting size.
  • the size of the tumor was measured on day 0, 2, 5, 7, 10, 13, 15, 18 and 21, and the survival days were surveyed.
  • the liposome compositions to which transferrin is bound exhibited an inhibitory effect on tumor growth.
  • the liposome compositions to which transferrin is not bound had a weaker inhibitory effect on tumor growth compared with that of the liposome compositions to which transferrin was bound. From the results depicted in FIGS. 9 and 10 , it was found that about 6 hours of retention time in the blood after administration is necessary and sufficient for a liposome to which transferrin is bound to have an inhibitory effect on tumor growth and to make the concentration of a drug accumulating to a tumor tissue be significant and substantially the same level. It is considered that a retention time in the blood longer than this may increase the possibility of causing an adverse effect on a normal tissue.
  • the total molar amount of the total lipid components constituting a liposome is defined as 100% and the contents of NG-DSPE are shown as the ratio (% by mole) of NG-DSPE to the total lipid components.
  • a liposome containing 6% by mole of MPB lipid (MPB-DSPE) or PDP lipid (PDP-DSPE) as the constituent lipid was also prepared.
  • MPB liposome is obtained by forming a liposome by binding maleimide-phenylbutyrate (MPB) to the amino group of the ethanolamine of the lipid, and binding Tf to the liposome through MPB (870013(16:0), Avanti Polar Lipids, Inc, USA).
  • PDP 870205(16:0, Avanti Polar Lipids, Inc, USA
  • liposome is obtained by forming a liposome by binding 2-pyridylthio propionate (PDP) to the amino group of ethanolamine of the lipid, and binding Tf to the liposome through PDP.
  • PDP 2-pyridylthio propionate
  • mice ICR male, 6 weeks of age
  • 125 I was bound to tyraminyl-inulin, (prepared as described in Example 13) and this inulin solution at a concentration of about 1 mg/ml was encapsulated into the liposome.
  • the weight of the collected blood and organs for each case was measured, and the radioactivity (unit: cpm) of the liposome marker was measured using a gamma counter (Aloka Auto Gamma System ARC-300, Japan).
  • the radioactivity of each administered solution (100 ⁇ l) to the tail vein was measured.
  • the radioactivity of 100 ⁇ l of the administered solution was defined as 100%, and the value (% of dose) for each organ was expressed as a percentage.
  • the total blood amount was estimated to be 7.3% of the body weight, and the liposome amount in the blood was expressed as the amount in the total blood.
  • the count value of an empty test tube was defined as the value of the background (b.g.), which was subtracted from the count value for each sample.
  • Distribution amount in the blood (%) [(count value of the blood) ⁇ (value of b.g.)] ⁇ (body weight of mouse (g)) ⁇ 0.073 ⁇ 100/[(count value of Std.) ⁇ (count value of tail) ⁇ (weight of blood (g))].
  • NG-DSPE liposome shows high blood retention when the lipid content is 3% by mole or higher.
  • maleimide-liposome MPB 6%
  • the blood retention was low.
  • a liposome containing a phospholipid to which succinic acid was bound instead of glutaric acid was prepared.
  • NG-DSPE (glutaric) was prepared as follows. In the dark under a nitrogen gas stream, DSPE (ME-8080, NOF Corporation, Japan) was suspended in dehydrated chloroform of 10 times the volume of DSPE. Then, 1.3 equivalent amounts of triethylamine (208-02643, Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) were added, and a dehydrated chloroform solution of glutaric acid anhydrous (G0071, Tokyo Chemical Industry, Japan) (dissolved in dehydrated chloroform of the same volume as DSPE) was added dropwise at room temperature. After completion, the solution was reacted at 30° C. for 2 hours while stirring.
  • the results are shown in FIG. 14 .
  • the liposome to which transferrin is bound through dicarboxylic acid (NG-DSPE: N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine, NS-DSPE: N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine) shows high blood retention.
  • NG-DSPE N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • NS-DSPE N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine
  • Liposome was dissolved and denatured at 95° C. for 5 min in sample buffer containing 2.5% of SDS and 5% of 2-mercaptoethanol.
  • sample buffer containing 2.5% of SDS and 5% of 2-mercaptoethanol.
  • polyacrylamide gel Frazier, Easy gel (II), precast gel, Japan
  • electrophoresis was carried out under a constant current of 20 mA for 1 to 2 hours.
  • lane 6 transferrin-N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine-liposome (Tf-NG-DSPE liposome)); lane 5 (transferrin-polyethyleneglycol-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine-liposome (Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome)) are shown.
  • Lanes 1-4 contain h-apo-Tf (240 ng), h-apo-Tf (120 ng), h-apo-Tf (60 ng), and h-apo-Tf (30 ng), respectively.
  • Tf-NG-DSPE liposome prepared from DSPC (64 parts), CH (32 parts) and NG-DSPE (4 parts), and Tf-NG-DSPE+DSPE liposome was prepared from DSPC (64 parts), CH (32 parts), NG-DSPE (4 parts) and DSPE (10 parts) in the same manner as in Example 8.
  • Tf was bound to NG-DSPE by using 10 equivalent amounts of NHS and ECD/HCl and 0.05 equivalent amounts of Tf. Then, the liposome samples in an amount corresponding to 1 mg of lipid were separated by SDS-PAGE, and the bands were visualized by silver staining as described in Example 17.
  • Example 12 the levels of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH (Tf-NG-DOPE:NG-DOPE) liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) and Tf-PEG-DSPE liposomes (prepared as in Example 9) in blood and tumor were compared.
  • the results for the amount of liposome retained in blood are depicted in FIG. 17 and the amount of liposome detected in tumors is shown in FIG. 18 .
  • FIGS. 17 and 18 show that while the Tf-NG-DOPE:NG-DOPE liposomes show a lower accumulation in the blood ( FIG. 17 ) than the Tf-PEG-DSPE liposomes, they were able to deliver a greater amount of oxaliplatin to the tumor ( FIG. 18 ). Lower accumulation of liposomes in the blood is likely to reduce the adverse systemic effects of the oxaliplatin.
  • Example 14 Using the protocols described in Example 14, the effect of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) and Tf-PEG-DSPE liposomes (prepared as in Example 9) on colon 26 tumors in mice were compared. The results are depicted in FIG. 19 .
  • both liposomes show an inhibition of tumor growth compared to oxaliplatin solution, however, as noted in Example 19, the accumulation of less of the NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH in blood (plasma) will likely mean that these liposomes are better tolerated by the individuals to whom they are administered.
  • the antitumor efficacy of the NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) when administered against subcutaneously implanted HCT-116 human colon tumor xenografts.
  • the test was performed at Southern Research Institute, AL, USA] in male athymic NCr-nu mice (02/A/08F17T9, Frederick Cancer Research and Development Center, MD, USA; 50 mice) was studied, with oxaliplatin in solution used as a reference compound.
  • the antitumor activity of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes is summarized in FIG. 20 .
  • NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes were administered intravenously (i.v.) every four days for four injections (q4d ⁇ 4) as doses of 15 and 10 mg/kg/injection.
  • Oxaliplatin was administered on the same schedule at a dose of 15 mg/kg/injection.
  • Vehicle about 10.3% sucrose
  • blank liposome control groups were injected on the same schedule.
  • Mean tumor volume for the HCT-116 colon tumor model, following treatment with NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes every 4 days was 28.9% of the control tumor volume for the 15 mg/kg group and 35.9% of the control tumor volume for the 10 mg/kg group.
  • the antitumor activity of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes was also compared to non-liposomal oxaliplatin in the HCT-116 model, where NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes showed greater efficacy in terms of relative tumor volume, when administered at 15 mg/kg (28.9% of the control tumor volume) every four days (4 ⁇ ).
  • Non-liposomal oxaliplatin delivered at 15 mg/kg every four days (4 ⁇ ) yielded 39.3% of the control tumor volume.
  • NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes prepared as in Example 7 when administered against subcutaneously implanted HT-29 human colon tumor xenografts.
  • the test was performed at Panapharm Laboratories Co., Ltd., Japan in female athymic BALB/cA Jcl-nu mice (CLEA Japan, Inc., Japan; 50 mice) and the results are summarized in FIG. 21 .
  • Groups of 4 mice were administered NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at doses of 6.7, 10 or 15 mg/kg, or vehicle control.
  • the vehicle and 6.7 and 10 mg/kg treated groups were injected on days 10, 14 and 19 and the 15 mg/kg treated group was injected on days 10 and 14.
  • the mean tumor volume for the HT-29 colon tumor model, following treatment with NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes was 66.3% of the control tumor volume for the 6.7 mg/kg group and 39.5% of the control tumor volume for the 10 mg/kg group (p value 0.01).
  • NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes prepared as in Example 7 when administered against subcutaneously implanted MKN45 human gastric tumor xenografts.
  • the test was performed at Panapharm Laboratories Co., Ltd., Japan in male athymic BALB/cA Jcl-nu mice (CLEA Japan, Inc., Japan; 50 mice) was studied and is summarized FIG. 22 .
  • mice Groups of 4 mice were administered NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at doses of 6.7, 10 or 15 mg/kg, or vehicle control.
  • the vehicle and 6.7 and 10 mg/kg treated groups were injected on days 7, 12 and 24 and the 15 mg/kg treated group was injected on days 7 and 24.
  • the mean tumor volume for the MKN45 gastric tumor model following treatment with NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes was 65.4% of the control tumor volume for the 6.7 mg/kg group (p value ⁇ 0.05), 49.6% of the control tumor volume for the 10 mg/kg group (p value ⁇ 0.01), and 48.5% of the control tumor volume for the 15 mg/kg group (p value ⁇ 0.01; delivered every 17 days).
  • NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes prepared as in Example 7
  • the test was performed at Southern Research Institute, AL, USA in male athymic NCr-nu mice (01/A/09F3T8, Federic Cancer Research and Development Center, MD, USA) was studied, with oxaliplatin in solution used as a reference compound and is summarized in FIG. 23 .
  • mice NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes were administered by i.v. injection every four days for three injections (q4d ⁇ 3) at doses of 10 and 5 mg/kg/injection.
  • Oxaliplatin was administered at a dose of 5 mg/kg/injection on the same schedule.
  • the control group was injected on the same schedule.
  • Advanced-stage tumors were retreated beginning on day 47 for all groups.
  • NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes were administered every other day for two injections at doses of 15 and 10 mg/kg/injection followed by treatment every other day for six injections at doses of 4 and 2 mg/kg/injection, respectively.
  • Oxaliplatin was administered on the same schedule at doses of 10 and 2 mg/kg/injection.
  • the control group was treated on the same schedule.
  • the extent of encapsulation was determined by passing an aliquot of the sample down a 3,000 MWCO (molecular weight cut-off) spin column (30K MWCO cellulose ultrafilter membrane column, Cat. No. 42410, Millipore Corp., USA) and measuring oxaliplatin concentration in the eluent using HPLC with isocratic elution of 1% acetonitrile in diluted phosphoric acid water solution (pH 3.0).
  • the level of oxaliplatin was determined following membrane filtration using HPLC analysis to quantify the levels of unencapsulated (free) drug.
  • the pH of targeted liposomes can be determined by place the liposomes of the invention in distilled water and measuring with a standard pH meter as described below.
  • the pH of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes was determined by pH meter (VWR Model 8000), with an Ag/AgCl gel-filled electrode.
  • the pH values for 4 lots of liposome ranged from pH 7.17-7.23, as shown in Table 2 below.
  • Liposome was dissolved and denatured at 95° C. for 5 min in sample buffer containing 2.5% of SDS and 5% of 2-mercaptoethanol. The samples were then applied to 5-10% gradient polyacrylamide gel and then they were electrophoresed in the presence of SDS. Migrated protein bands were visualized by using a brilliant blue G-colloidal (B2025, SIGMA, USA).
  • the transferrin in the liposome was detected as transferrin conjugated to NG-DOPE, which showed a higher molecular weight than that of intact transferrin (see FIG. 24 ). A minor band with a lower molecular weight was detected as free transferrin.
  • the ratio of free transferrin to transferrin conjugated to NG-DOPE on the SDS-PAGE was calculated as the area of the peak using Scion Image soft ware (freely available at www.microsoft.com.DirectX).
  • the ratio of free Tf in total Tf of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposome was approximately 4.7%.
  • the osmotic pressure at a given temperature depends on sucrose and salts such as sodium chloride and phosphate buffer. It does not depend on the solute, but on the total ion density and the size of the molecules within the solution. Normally osmotic pressure can be measured using an instrument known as an osmometer, which measures osmotic pressure in suitable pressure units.
  • the osmotic pressure NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes prepared as in Example 7 at room temperature was measured using an osmometer (Vapro Vapor Pressure Osmometer Model 5520, Wescor, Inc., USA).
  • the osmolarity values for 3 preparations of liposomes ranged from 360-370 mOsm/kg, as reported in Table 4.
  • the obtained pellet above was dried with N 2 gas for 30 min.
  • the dried material was then dissolved in 10 mL of distilled water and passed through a sterile filter (0.22 ⁇ m) (Millipore Corp., USA).
  • the filtrate was poured into a vial and frozen for about 8 hours on a shelf at ⁇ 40° C.
  • the sample was depressurized to about 0.1 mmHg and kept under reduced pressure for 2 days with rising temperature from ⁇ 40° C. to 25° C. stepwise. Approximately 444 mg of Tf-NG-DOPE (about 45% of transferrin content of the blank liposome was thus obtained.
  • reaction product was then fractioned to about 1.7 mL/tube by TOYOPEARL HW-55S column (1.5 cm ⁇ 45 cm, 0.9% NaCl, Tosoh Bioscience LLC, USA).
  • Tf-NG-DSPE was estimated by mass spectrometry (MALDI-TOF/MS) and SDS-PAGE with CBB (Coomasie Brilliant Blue, Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) staining.

Landscapes

  • Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Life Sciences & Earth Sciences (AREA)
  • General Health & Medical Sciences (AREA)
  • Medicinal Chemistry (AREA)
  • Veterinary Medicine (AREA)
  • Public Health (AREA)
  • Pharmacology & Pharmacy (AREA)
  • Animal Behavior & Ethology (AREA)
  • Epidemiology (AREA)
  • Dispersion Chemistry (AREA)
  • Organic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Nuclear Medicine, Radiotherapy & Molecular Imaging (AREA)
  • General Chemical & Material Sciences (AREA)
  • Chemical Kinetics & Catalysis (AREA)
  • Proteomics, Peptides & Aminoacids (AREA)
  • Inorganic Chemistry (AREA)
  • Engineering & Computer Science (AREA)
  • Bioinformatics & Cheminformatics (AREA)
  • Medicinal Preparation (AREA)
  • Pharmaceuticals Containing Other Organic And Inorganic Compounds (AREA)
  • Medicines Containing Antibodies Or Antigens For Use As Internal Diagnostic Agents (AREA)
  • Acyclic And Carbocyclic Compounds In Medicinal Compositions (AREA)

Abstract

The present disclosure provides lipid-containing compositions, including targeted liposomes encapsulating drug, and pharmaceutical formulations thereof, as well as methods for the making and using the lipid-containing compositions, including the use of the targeted liposomes in the treatment of cancer and other diseases.

Description

    CROSS-REFERENCE TO RELATED APPLICATIONS
  • This application is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 12/891,568, filed Sep. 27, 2010, which is a continuation of U.S. patent application Ser. No. 11/371,586 (now U.S. Pat. No. 7,829,113 B2), filed Mar. 8, 2006, which claims the benefit of Japanese Patent Application No. 2005-67469, filed Mar. 10, 2005, the disclosures of which are incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
  • BACKGROUND OF THE INVENTION
  • The efficacy of treatments for many diseases, including cancer, has improved dramatically in the past few decades, however, many treatment regimens require the use of drugs with deleterious side effects, including, for example, alopecia, nausea, vomiting, tiredness, etc. Some treatment regimens may also entail the use of drugs that are not stable under physiological conditions, for example, bio-therapeutics (e.g., genes or gene products) and/or other drugs that are easily degraded or otherwise altered upon administration and thereby loose their effectiveness before achieving the desired therapeutic result. Such instability also makes the drugs more difficult and costly to store and prepare for administration.
  • There are a number of classes of anticancer agents, encompassing nearly 100 individual drugs, as well as numerous drug combination therapies, methods of delivery and treatment regimens. Anticancer agents may be classified according to several criteria, such as class of compound and disease state treated. Certain agents have been developed to take advantage of the rapid division of cancer cells and target specific phases in the cell cycle, providing another method of classification. Agents can also be grouped according to the type and severity of their side effects or method of delivery. However, the most common classification of non-biotherapeutic based anticancer agents is by class of chemical compound, which broadly encompasses the mechanism of action of these compounds.
  • Depending on the reference source consulted, there are slight differences in the classification of anticancer agents. The classes of compounds are described in the Physician's Desk Reference as follows: alkaloids; alkylating agents; anti-tumor antibiotics; antimetabolites; hormones and hormone analogs; immunomodulators; photosensitizing agents; and miscellaneous other agents.
  • The alkaloid class of compounds may also be referred to as mitotic inhibitors, as they are cell cycle phase specific and serve to inhibit mitosis or inhibit the enzymes required for mitosis. They are derived generally from plant alkaloids and other natural products and work during the M-phase of the cell cycle. This class of compounds is often used to treat neoplasias such as acute lymphoblastic leukemia, Hodgkin's and non-Hodgkin's lymphoma; neuroblastomas and cancers of the lung, breast and testes.
  • Alkylating agents make up a large class of chemotherapeutic agents, including of the following sub-classes, which each represent a number of individual drugs: alkyl sulfonates; aziridines; ethylenimines and methylmelamines; nitrogen mustards; nitrosoureas; and others, including platinum compounds. Alkylating agents attack neoplastic cells by directly alkylating the DNA of cells and therefore causing the DNA to be replication incompetent. This class of compounds is commonly used to treat a variety of diseases, including chronic leukemias, non-Hodgkin's lymphoma, Hodgkin's lymphoma, multiple myeloma and certain lung, breast and ovarian cancers.
  • Nitrosoureas are often categorized as alkylating agents, and have a similar mechanism of action, but instead of directly alkylating DNA, they inhibit DNA repair enzymes causing replication failure. These compounds have the advantage of being able to cross the blood-brain barrier and therefore can be used to treat brain tumors.
  • Antitumor antibiotics have antimicrobial and cytotoxic activity and also interfere with DNA by chemically inhibiting enzymes and mitosis or by altering cell membranes. They are not cell cycle phase specific and are widely used to treat a variety of cancers.
  • The antimetabolite class of anticancer agents interfere with the growth of DNA and RNA and are specific to the S-phase of the cell-cycle. They can be broken down further by type of compound, which include folic acid analogs, purine analogs, and pyrimidine analogs. They are often employed in the treatment of chronic leukemia, breast, ovary, and gastrointestinal tumors.
  • There are two classes of hormones or hormone analogs used as anticancer agents, the corticosteroid hormones and sex hormones. While some corticosteroid hormones can both kill cancer cells and slow the growth of tumors, and are used in the treatment of lymphoma, leukemias, etc., sex hormones function primarily to slow the growth of breast, prostate and endometrial cancers. There are numerous subclasses of hormones and hormone analogs, including, androgens, antiadrenals, antiandrogens, antiestrogens, aromatase inhibitors, estrogens, leutenizing hormone releasing hormone (LHRH) analogs and progestins.
  • An additional smaller class of anticancer agents is classified as immunotherapy. These are agents that are intended to stimulate the immune system to more effectively attack the neoplastic (cancerous) cells. This therapy is often used in combination with other therapies.
  • There are also a number of compounds, such as campothectins, which are generally listed as ‘other’ anticancer agents and can be used to treat a variety of neoplasias.
  • Combinations of anticancer agents are also utilized in the treatment of a number of cancers. For example, Sanofi Syntholabo markets ELOXATIN™ (oxaliplatin for injection) for the treatment of colorectal cancer for use in combination with 5-fluorouracil and leuvocorin. This combination of drugs is often used adjunctively with surgery in the treatment of colorectal cancer. Oxaliplatin is an alkylating agent that is believed to act by inhibiting both DNA replication and transcription. Unlike other platinum agents, oxaliplatin has demonstrated a decreased likelihood of resistance development. Oxaliplatin is further described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,169,846; 5,338,874; 5,298,642; 5,959,133; 5,420,319; 5,716,988; 5,290,961; and in Wilkes G M. “New therapeutic options in colon cancer: focus on oxaliplatin” Clin J Oncol Nurs. (2002) 6:131-137.
  • While there are a plethora of anticancer agents, the benefit of these compounds is often outweighed by the severity of the side effects produced by the agent. This comparison is often referred to as the therapeutic index, which describes the balance between the required dose to accomplish the destruction of the cancer cells compared to the dose at which the substance is unacceptably toxic to the individual. The drawback to most anticancer agents is the relatively small range of the therapeutic index, (i.e., the narrow dosage range in which cancer cells are destroyed without unacceptable toxicity to the individual). This characteristic limits the frequency and dosage where an agent is useful, and often the side effects become intolerable before the cancer can be fully eradicated.
  • The severe side effects experienced with the majority of cancer chemotherapeutics are a result of the non-specific nature of these drugs, which do not distinguish between healthy and cancerous cells, and instead destroy both. Certain cell cycle specific drugs attempt to lessen these effects, targeting phases of the cell cycle involved in cell replication and division. These drugs do not, however, distinguish between cancerous cells and healthy cells that are undergoing normal cell division. The cells most at risk from these types of chemotherapy are those which undergo cell division often, including blood cells, hair follicle cells, and cells of the reproductive and digestive tracts.
  • The most common side effects of anticancer agents are nausea and vomiting. A large proportion of individuals also suffer from myelosuppression, or suppression of the bone marrow, which produces red blood cells, white blood cells and platelets. These and other side effects are also exacerbated by the suppression of the immune system concomitant with the destruction and lack of production of white blood cells, and associated risk of opportunistic infection.
  • Other side effects common to a wide range of anticancer agents include: hair loss (alopecia); appetite loss; weight loss; taste changes; stomatitis and esophagitis (inflammation and sores); constipation; diarrhea; fatigue; heart damage; nervous system changes; lung damage; reproductive tissue damage; liver damage; kidney and urinary system damage.
  • The wide range of the side effects associated with most anticancer agents and their severity in individuals who are already debilitated with disease and possibly immune compromised has led researchers to search for mechanisms by which they can alleviate some of the side effects while maintaining the efficacy of the treatment. Several approaches to this problem have been taken. They include combination chemotherapy, where multiple anticancer agents are administered together; adjuvant therapies, where additional agents are prescribed along with the anticancer agent to fight the side effects of the anticancer agent; combined modality treatments, where chemotherapy is combined with radiation and/or surgery; and alternative delivery vehicles for the administration of anticancer agents, such as the encapsulation of anticancer agents in liposomes.
  • Liposomes are formed when phospholipids and their derivatives are dispersed in water. Upon dispersion in water the phospholipids form closed vesicles called “liposomes”, which are characterized by lipid bilayers encapsulating an aqueous core. Various liposomes have been used as carriers for entrapped therapeutic agents, such as drugs, enzymes and genetic sequences for use in medical science, in pharmaceutical science and in biochemistry.
  • Examples of liposome compositions include U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,983,397; 6,476,068; 5,834,012; 5,756,069; 6,387,397; 5,534,241; 4,789,633; 4,925,661; 6,153,596; 6,057,299; 5,648,478; 6,723,338; 6,627218; U.S. Pat. App. Publication Nos: 2003/0224037; 2004/0022842; 2001/0033860; 2003/0072794; 2003/0082228; 2003/0212031; 2003/0203865; 2004/0142025; 2004/0071768; International Patent Applications WO 00/74646; WO 96/13250; WO 98/33481; Papahadjopolulos D, Allen T M, Gbizon A, et al. “Sterically stabilized liposomes: Improvements in pharmacokinetics and antitumor therapeutic efficacy” Proc Natl Acad Sci U.S.A. (1991) 88: 11460-11464; Allen T M, Martin F J. “Advantages of liposomal delivery systems for anthracyclines” Semin Oncol (2004) 31: 5-15 (suppl 13). Weissig et al. Pharm. Res. (1998) 15: 1552-1556.
  • In earlier stages of developing liposomes, naturally occurring phospholipids of the cell membrane such as egg-yolk phospholipids and soybean phospholipids were used. In the case of being intravenously administered, however, liposomes utilizing these phospholipids are likely to be incorporated into the reticuloendothelial system of liver or spleen, causing a problem of low blood retention time and thereby reducing the efficacy of the drug. Thereafter, as a means for solving this problem, synthetic phospholipids whose lipid portion contains only saturated bonds were used as a constituent of the liposome membrane in order to harden the liposome membrane.
  • In an effort to prolong the circulatory half-life of liposomes and avoid uptake by the reticuloendothelial system, researchers developed liposomes that were modified by the incorporation of polyethylene glycol or other hydrophilic polymers (e.g., a PEG liposome where one or more of the constituent lipids was modified by attachment of PEG). PEG-modified liposomes were also often referred to as “shielded” liposomes. Doxil™ (doxorubicin HCl liposome injection) is a liposome-enclosed doxorubicin, with adjunct polyethylene glycol (PEG) utilized to avoid the reticuloendothelial system (RES) and prolong drug circulation time. See Vail D M, Amantea M A, Colbern G T, et al., “Pegylated Liposomal Doxorubicin: Proof of Principle Using Preclinical Animal Models and Pharmacokinetic Studies.” Semin Oncol. (2004) 31 (Suppl 13): 16-35. However, adverse effects were also caused by prolonged blood retention (e.g., hand-foot syndrome, an adverse effect of Doxil® on the peripheral system, etc.) became recognized as a problem.
  • Examples of liposomes include U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,983,397; 5,013,556; 6,316,024; 6,056,973; 5,945,122; 5,891,468; 6,126,966; 5,593,622, 5,676,971; 6,586,559; and 5,846,458 U.S. Pat. App. Publication. Nos. 2003/0224037; 2004/0022842; 2003/0113262; 2002/0136707; International Patent Applications WO 99/30686; WO 02/41870 Alimiñana et al., Prep. Biochem. Biotech. (2004) 34(1): 77-96. Liposomes are also described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,228,391; 6,197,333; 6,046,225; 5,292,524; and U.S. Pat. App. Pub. Nos. 20050271588; 20040213833; 20040029210; 20030175205; 20030162748; 20030130190; 20030059461; and 20020034537.
  • In addition to PEG-modified liposomes, researchers developed a variety of other derivatized lipids. These derivatized lipids could also be incorporated into liposomes. See, for example: International Patent Application WO 93/01828; Park Y S, Maruyama K, Huang L. “Some negatively charged phospholipids derivatives prolong the liposome circulation in vivo.” Biochimica et Biophysica Acta (1992) 1108: 257-260; Ahl et al., Biochimica Biophys. Acta (1997) 1329: 370-382.
  • Additional lipid compositions are described in U.S. Pat. Nos. 6,936,272; 6,897,196; 6,077,834; and U.S. Pat. App. Pub. Nos. 20050136064; 20040234588; 20030215490; 20030166601; and 20010038851.
  • In addition to modification of liposomes with PEG and other hydrophilic polymers, researchers also developed liposomes that aimed to specifically target particular cell types by incorporating targeting factors (also referred to as targeting ligands) for particular cell types. Examples of targeting factors/ligands include asialoglycoprotein, folate, transferrin, antibodies, etc. In some cases one or more of the constituent lipids could be modified by the attachment of a targeting factor.
  • Examples of lipid compositions including targeting factors include U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,049,390; 5,780,052; 5,786,214; 6,316,024; 6,056,973; 6,245,427; 6,524,613; 6,749,863; 6,177,059; 6,530,944; U.S. Pat. App. Publication. Nos. 2004/0022842; 2003/0224037; 2003/143742; 2003/0228285; 2002/0198164; 2003/0220284; 2003/0165934; 2003/0027779; International Patent Application Nos. WO 95/33841; WO 95/19434; WO 2001037807; WO 96/33698; WO 2001/49266; WO 9940789; WO 9925320; WO 9104014; WO 92/07959; EP 1369132; JP 2001002592; Iinuma H, Maruyama K, et al., “Intracellular targeting therapy of cisplatin-encapsulated transferrin polyethylene glycol liposome on peritoneal dissemination of gastric cancer” Int J Cancer (2002) 99 130-137; Ishida 0, Maruyama K, Tanahashi H, Iwatsuru M, Sasaki K, et al., “Liposomes bearing polyethylene glycol-coupled transferrin with intracellular targeting property to the solid tumors in vivo.” Pharmaceutical Research (2001) 18: 1042-1048; Holmberg et al., Biochem. Biophys. Res. Comm. (1989) 165(3):1272-1278; Nam et al., J. Biochem. Mol. Biol. (1998) 31(1): 95-100; Nag et al., J. Drug Target. (1999) 6(6): 427-438.
  • In particular, Iinuma et al. developed a Tf-PEG-liposome, with transferrin (Tf) attached at the surface of the liposome. Iinuma et al., showed that a greater number of liposomes were bound to the surface of the tumor cells, and there was a greater uptake of liposomes by the tumor cells for Tf-PEG-liposome as compared to PEG-liposome (Inuma et al., ibid; Ishida et al., ibid).
  • However, despite recent advances made in the drug and labeled compound delivery field, including the use of liposome compositions, there is still a need for improved liposome compositions for the delivery of drugs and labeled compounds to specific cells and/or tissues that achieve a therapeutic or diagnostic effect. In particular in the cancer field, drug formulations with improved specificity and reduced toxicity are need to ensure therapeutic benefit without adversely effecting healthy cells and which also do not result in deleterious side effects for the individual being treated. Similarly, labeled compounds that can be used to detect conditions, particularly life-threatening conditions at an early stage (e.g., with high specificity and/or high sensitivity) and also accurately monitor the severity/extent of the condition (e.g., progression and/or regression with or without treatment) would also significantly improve the quality and success of therapy.
  • BRIEF SUMMARY OF THE INVENTION
  • The present invention relates to novel lipid-containing compositions (including liposomes (e.g., targeted liposomes, blank liposomes), lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions) that may optionally incorporate a drug or labeled compound, or may be used in the preparation of formulations that incorporate a drug or labeled compound, where the lipid-containing composition confers the benefit of reducing side effects from the drug or labeled compound and/or also prevents degradation and/or loss of efficacy of the drug or labeled compound. The invention also includes methods of making and using the lipid-containing compositions described herein. In certain aspects of the invention, the lipid-containing compositions may be used to treat or diagnose cancer (e.g., breast cancer, gastric cancer, colorectal cancer, colon cancer, cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovarian cancer, or hematological malignancies (e.g., leukemia, lymphoma, multiple myeloma, etc.).
  • In certain embodiments are provided targeted liposomes comprising one or more phospholipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, an encapsulated drug or labeled compound and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00001
  • and
  • the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00002
      • wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, an acyl group, and m and p are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the liposome does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol, and wherein the targeting ligand is not an intact antibody.
  • In other embodiments are provided blank liposomes comprising one or more phospholipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00003
  • and
  • the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, where present, is represented by Formula 3,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00004
      • wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, an acyl group, and m and p are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the liposome does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, polyethylene glycol, drug or labeled compound, and wherein the targeting ligand is not an intact antibody.
  • In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, and m and p are 3. In certain embodiments, the targeting ligand is transferrin. In particular embodiments, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC, and the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol. In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl, m and p are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC and the additional lipid is cholesterol.
  • In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, m and p are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and p are equal and are 3. In certain embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R1 and are R2 are the same, and R5 and R6 are the same. In other embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are the same. In particular embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl.
  • In further embodiments are provided lipid mixtures comprising a mixture of one or more phospholipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00005
  • and
  • the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00006
      • wherein R1, R2, R3 and R4 are each, independently, an acyl group, m and n are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the mixture does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol.
  • In certain embodiments of the lipid mixtures, m and n are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and n are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and n are equal and are 3.
  • In certain embodiments of the lipid mixtures, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R1 and are R2 are the same, and R3 and R4 are the same. In particular embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are the same. In some embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In certain embodiments, m and n are 3, where the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC and the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol. In certain embodiments of the lipid mixtures, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are oleoyl, m and n are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC and the additional lipid is cholesterol.
  • In further embodiments are provided lipid mixtures comprising a mixture of one or more phospholipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00007
  • and
  • the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00008
      • wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, an acyl group, m and p are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the mixture does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol, and wherein the targeting ligand is not an intact antibody.
  • In particular embodiments of the lipid mixtures, where a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present, m and p are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In certain embodiments, m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and p are equal and are 3.
  • In particular embodiments of the lipid mixtures, where a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, wherein R1 and are R2 are the same, and R5 and R6 are the same. In further embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are the same. In some embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, m and p are 3, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC, the at least one additional lipid is cholesterol, and the targeting ligand is transferrin. In certain embodiments of the lipid mixtures, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl, m and p are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC, the additional lipid is cholesterol and the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • In certain embodiments are provided liposome-containing compositions comprising liposomes comprising one or more phospholipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00009
  • and
  • the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00010
      • wherein R1, R2, R3 and R4 are each, independently, an acyl group, m and n are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the composition does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol.
  • In some embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions m and n are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In certain embodiments, m and n are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and n are equal are 3.
  • In some embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In particular embodiments, R1 and are R2 are the same, and R3 and R4 are the same. In some embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are the same. In certain embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In some embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are oleoyl or stearoyl, and m and n are 3 and the one or more phospholipids is DMPC, DSPC, POPC or DPPC. In certain embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R46 are oleoyl, m and n are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC and the additional lipid is cholesterol.
  • In further embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions are provided liposome-containing compositions comprising liposomes comprising one or more phospholipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00011
  • and
  • the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00012
      • wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, an acyl group, m and p are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the composition does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol, and wherein the targeting ligand is not an intact antibody.
  • In certain of the liposome-containing compositions, where a targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present, m and p are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and p are equal are 3.
  • In certain of the liposome-containing compositions, where a targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In particular embodiments, R1 and are R2 are the same, and R5 and R6 are the same. In certain embodiments, wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are the same. In some embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In particular embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC, the at least one additional lipid cholesterol, and the targeting ligand is transferrin. In certain embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl, m and p are 3, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC, the additional lipid is cholesterol and the targeting ligand is transferrin.
  • In further embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions a drug is included. In certain embodiments, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC or DSPC, R1, R2 and, where present, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, m and, where present, p are 3, the at least one additional lipid, where present, is cholesterol, the drug is oxaliplatin, and the targeting ligand, where present, is transferrin. In certain embodiments, the composition further includes a sugar at a concentration of from about 1 to about 20% percent sugar (v/v). In certain embodiments, the one or more phospholipid is DMPC or DSPC, R1, R2 and, where present, R5 and R6 are oleoyl, m and, where present, p are 3, the at least one additional lipid, where present, is cholesterol, the drug is oxaliplatin, and the targeting ligand, where present, is transferrin.
  • In further embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions a labeled compound is included. In certain embodiments, the labeled compound comprises a radioisotopic moiety.
  • In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions, the at least one additional lipid is present. In particular embodiments, the at least one additional lipid is cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions, the one or more phospholipids is a phosphatidylcholine, phosphatidic acid, phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylglycerol. In particular embodiments, the one or more phospholipids is a neutral phospholipid. In some embodiments, the one or more phospholipids is a phosphatidylcholine. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline includes a moiety of a saturated fatty acid. In certain embodiments, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC, DSPC, POPC or DPPC. In particular of these embodiments, the at least one additional lipid is present. And in certain of these, the at least one additional lipid is cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative. In particular embodiments, DMPC and cholesterol, DSPC and cholesterol, POPC and cholesterol, or DPPC and cholesterol are incorporated. In certain embodiments, DMPC and cholesterol.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions, where present, targeting ligand is directed to a target cell. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is directed to a cell surface receptor of a target cell. In particular embodiments, the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid, a sugar chain or a fragment of a monoclonal antibody. In certain embodiments, the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid or a sugar chain. In other embodiments, the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid or a sugar chain. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is transferrin. In particular embodiments, the transferrin is in a holo-form but not in an apo-form. In some embodiments, the transferrin is in a holo-form.
  • In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 50 nm to about 250 nm. In others, the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 90 nm to about 200 nm.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, the zeta potential of the liposome is negative. In certain embodiments, the zeta potential is from about −75 mV to about −90 mV. In others, the zeta potential is from about −80 mV to about −85 mV.
  • In certain embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, the formulations further include a solution.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes and liposome-containing compositions, the drug is present.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes and liposome-containing compositions, the drug is oxaliplatin. In certain embodiments where the drug is oxaliplatin, the targeting ligand is transferrin. In certain embodiments, the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol.
  • In certain embodiments, the drug is an anticancer agent. In particular embodiments, the drug is a cytotoxic drug. In some embodiments, the drug is a topoisomerase I inhibitor. In particular embodiments, the topoisomerase I inhibitor is topotecan or irinotecan. In other embodiments, the drug is a vinca alkaloid. In particular embodiments, the vinca alkaloid is vincristine, vinblastine, vinleurosine, vinrodisine, vinorelbine or vindesine. In some embodiments, wherein the drug is a nucleic acid. In certain embodiments, the nucleic acid is an antisense oligonucleotide or a ribozyme. In some embodiments, the drug is an alkylating agent. In particular embodiments, the drug is a taxanes. In other embodiments, the drug is a metabolic antagonist. In certain embodiments, the drug is an antitumour antibiotic. In some embodiments, the drug is a hormone therapy drug. In some embodiments, the drug is a molecular target drug.
  • In some embodiments of the targeted liposomes and liposome-containing compositions, the drug is a platinum compound. In particular embodiments, the platinum compound is biplatin, cisplatin, carboplatin, ormaplatin, oxaliplatin, zeniplatin, enloplatin, lobaplatin or spiroplatin. In some embodiments, the platinum compound is oxaliplatin.
  • In some embodiments where the drug is oxaliplatin, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, m and p are 3, the targeting ligand is transferrin, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC or DSPC, and the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol. In certain embodiments where the drug is oxaliplatin, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl, m and p are 3, the targeting ligand is transferrin, the one or more phospholipids is DMPC, and the at least one additional lipid is present and is cholesterol. In particular embodiments, the targeted liposomes and liposome-containing compositions are free of other lipid components.
  • In some embodiments where the drug is oxaliplatin, the oxaliplatin is dissolved in an aqueous solution of a sugar selected from the group consisting of trehalose, maltose, sucrose, mannose, lactose, mannitol, glycerol and dextrose. In certain embodiments, the sugar is at a concentration of from about 1 to about 20% percent sugar (v/v). In particular embodiments, the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 25 mg/ml within the liposome. In other embodiments, the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 10 mg/ml within the liposome. In still other embodiments, the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml.
  • In particular embodiments of the of the targeted liposomes and liposome-containing compositions, the labeled compound is present. In certain embodiments, the labeled compound includes a radioisotopic moiety. In particular embodiments, the radioisotopic moiety incorporates 125I.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes and the liposome-containing compositions, the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome is from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 3.0 mg/ml. In others, the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome is from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.5 mg/ml.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes and the liposome-containing compositions where drug is present and is oxaliplatin, the targeting ligand is transferrin. In particular embodiments, the transferrin is in a holo-form. In some embodiments, ferric iron is in a concentration of from about 0.4 to about 3.0 μg/ml. In other embodiments, ferric iron is in a concentration of from about 0.4 to about 1.5 μg/ml.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions, the liposomes, lipid mixtures or liposome-containing composition does not comprise a cationic lipid. In particular embodiments, the liposomes, lipid mixtures or liposome-containing composition do not comprise an anionic lipid. In some embodiments, the liposomes, lipid liposome, lipid mixtures or liposome-containing composition do not comprise either an anionic lipid or a cationic lipid.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions, the formulations further include a solution. In certain embodiments, the lipid mixtures are free of solution. In particular embodiments, the solution is an aqueous solution or a mixture of an aqueous solution and a water-miscible solvent.
  • In particular embodiments of the targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions, the formulations further include sucrose.
  • In a further aspect of the invention are provided pharmaceutical formulations of the lipid-containing compositions described herein. Particular embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes and blank liposomes include the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes or blank liposomes as described herein and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives.
  • In yet another aspect of the invention are provided kits including the lipid-containing compositions described herein. Certain embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes and blank liposomes include the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes or blank liposomes as described herein, packaging and instructions for use.
  • In certain embodiments of the kits, the liposome-containing compositions, targeted liposomes or blank liposomes as described herein is contained in a first container and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives are contained in a second container.
  • In particular embodiments are provided kits incorporating the pharmaceutical formulations described herein, packaging and instructions for use.
  • In another aspect of the invention are provided methods of making the lipid-containing compositions described herein.
  • In particular embodiments are provided methods of making targeted liposomes as described herein, comprising the steps of:
  • a) mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, the at least one additional lipid, to form a lipid mixture;
  • b) adding a drug or labeled compound to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • c) forming a liposome.
  • In a further embodiments of the method is provided a step (d), purifying the liposome of step (c). In particular embodiments, the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing. In certain embodiments, step (c) comprises sonication or stirring. In some embodiments, step (c) comprises extrusion.
  • In other embodiments are provided methods of making targeted liposomes as described herein, comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, the at least one additional lipid, to form a lipid mixture
  • wherein the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00013
      • wherein R3 and R4 are each, independently, an acyl group, n is, independently, an integer from 1 to 10;
  • b) adding drug or labeled compound to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • c) forming a liposome; and,
  • d) linking a targeting ligand to the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In certain embodiments of the above-described method, the method also includes a step (e), purifying the liposome of step (d).
  • In particular embodiments, the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing. In some embodiments, step (c) comprises sonication or stirring. In certain embodiments, step (c) comprises extrusion. In particular embodiments, step (c) comprises stirring.
  • In certain embodiments are provided methods of making blank liposomes as described herein, comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, the at least one additional lipid, to form a lipid mixture; and
  • b) forming a liposome.
  • In certain embodiments of the methods of preparing the blank liposomes, the method further comprises a step (c), purifying the liposome of step (b).
  • In particular embodiments, step (b) comprises sonication or stirring. In some embodiments, step (b) comprises extrusion.
  • In other embodiments are provided methods of making blank liposomes as described herein, comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, the at least one additional lipid, to form a lipid mixture,
  • wherein the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00014
      • wherein R3 and R4 are each, independently, an acyl group, n is, independently, an integer from 1 to 10;
  • b) forming a liposome; and,
  • c) linking a targeting ligand to the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine to form a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In certain of the methods of preparing the blank liposomes, the methods further include a step (d), purifying the liposome of step (c).
  • In particular embodiments, step (b) comprises sonication or stirring. In some embodiments, step (b) comprises extrusion.
  • In other embodiments are provided methods of making the lipid-containing compositions as described herein, comprising the step of mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In further embodiments are provided methods of making the lipid-containing compositions where the at least one additional lipid is present, as described herein, comprising the step of mixing the one or more phospholipids, the at least one additional lipid, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In another embodiments are provided methods of making the lipid-containing compositions as described herein, comprising the step of mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In further embodiments are provided methods of making the lipid-containing compositions, where the at least one additional lipid is present, as described herein, comprising the step of mixing the one or more phospholipids, the at least one additional lipid, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • Also provided are methods of making the liposome-containing compositions described herein, comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the one or more phospholipid lipids, and the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and, where present, the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, or targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, where present, at least one additional lipid, to form a lipid mixture; and
  • b) adding a drug to the lipid mixture formed in step (a); and,
  • c) forming a liposome.
  • In certain embodiments of the methods of making the various lipid-containing compositions (targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposome-containing compositions), where a drug is present, the drug is in an aqueous solution. In certain embodiments, step a) is performed in the presence of organic solvent. In some embodiments, aqueous solution further comprises a sugar. In certain embodiments the aqueous solution may also include a water-miscible organic solvent.
  • In other embodiments are provided methods of making the liposome-containing compositions, comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the one or more phospholipid lipids, and the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and,
  • where present, the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, or the targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and, optionally, where present, the at least one additional lipid, to form a lipid mixture; and
  • b) adding a labeled compound to the lipid mixture formed in step (a).
  • c) forming a liposome
  • In certain embodiments of the methods of making the various lipid-containing compositions (targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposome-containing compositions), where a labeled compound is present, the labeled compound is in an aqueous solution. In certain embodiments, step a) is performed in the presence of organic solvent. In certain embodiments the aqueous solution may also include a water-miscible organic solvent.
  • In certain embodiments are also provided methods of making the liposome-containing compositions as described herein, wherein the liposome-containing composition includes a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the one or more phospholipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and, optionally, at least one additional lipid, to form a lipid mixture; and
  • b) adding solvent to the mixture formed in step (a) to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • In particular embodiments, the mixing step (a) is performed in the presence of an organic solvent. In particular embodiments, the solvent in step (b) is an aqueous solution or a mixture of aqueous solution and a water-miscible solvent.
  • In certain embodiments, step (b) comprises sonication or stirring. In some embodiments, step (b) comprises extrusion.
  • In particular embodiments of the methods of making the lipid-containing compositions, in step (a) the at least one additional lipid is present.
  • In some embodiments of the methods of making the lipid-containing compositions, in step (a) the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present.
  • In certain embodiments of the methods of making the lipid-containing compositions in step (a) the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present.
  • In an additional aspect of the invention are provided methods of treatment or diagnosis using the lipid-containing compositions described herein.
  • In particular embodiments are provided methods for treating cancer comprising, a) administering a targeted liposome as described herein to an individual in need thereof in an amount effective to treat cancer, wherein the targeted liposome comprises a drug, and the drug is an anticancer agent.
  • In certain embodiments of the method of treatment or diagnosis, the individual is a mammal. In particular embodiments, the individual is a human.
  • In certain embodiments of the methods of treatment, the cancer is breast, gastric, colon, colorectal cancer, cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovary cancer, or a hematological malignancies.
  • In some embodiments of the methods of treatment, step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after combined modality cancer therapy. In particular embodiments, the combined modality cancer therapy comprises chemotherapy, radiation therapy, or surgery.
  • In particular embodiments of the methods of treatment, step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after adjunctive cancer therapy. In particular embodiments, the adjunctive cancer therapy comprises administration of one or more agents to reduce hair loss, vomiting, immune suppression, nausea, diarrhea, rash, sensory disturbance, anemia, fatigue, stomatitis, or hand foot syndrome. In some embodiments, step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after administration of one or more additional anticancer agents. In certain embodiments, the one or more additional anticancer agents comprise 5-fluorouracil, leucovorin, capecitabine, UFT/LV (tegafur-uracil and leucovorin), irinotecan, an-anti EGFR antibody, an anti-VEGF antibody, a tyrosine kinase inhibitor, or combinations thereof.
  • In some embodiments of the methods of treatment, the targeted liposome is administered via parenteral administration. In particular embodiments, the parenteral administration is via injection or intravenous infusion.
  • Also provided are methods of diagnosis comprising the steps of
  • a) administering a targeted liposome as described herein to an individual in need thereof in an amount effective for detection, wherein the targeted liposome comprises a labeled compound; and,
  • b) detecting the labeled compound.
  • In additional embodiments of the methods of diagnosis, the methods further comprise a step (c), comparing a level of labeled compound detected with the amount of labeled compound detected at a previous point in time.
  • In further embodiments of the methods of diagnosis, step (b) comprises detection via a gamma counter.
  • In a further aspect of the invention are provided transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines, where the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00015
      • wherein R5 and R6 are each, independently, an acyl group and p is an integer from 1 to 10, and transferrin is liked linked to the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In certain embodiments of the transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, p is an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, p is 3.
  • In some embodiments of the transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, R5 and R6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In particular embodiments, R5 and R6 are the same. In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R5 and R6 are oleoyl and p is 3.
  • Also provided in an additional aspect are a pharmaceutical formulations comprising the transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines as described herein and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives.
  • In certain embodiments are provided lipid mixtures comprising a mixture of at least two different neutral lipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00016
  • and
    the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00017
  • wherein R1, R2, R3 and R4 are each, independently, an acyl group, m and n are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the mixture does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol.
  • In certain embodiments are provided liposome-containing compositions comprising at least two different neutral lipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00018
  • and
    the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00019
  • wherein R1, R2, R3 and R4 are each, independently, an acyl group; m and n are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the mixture does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol.
  • In particular embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions and the lipid mixtures, m and n are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In certain embodiments, m and n are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In other embodiments, m and n are equal and are 3.
  • In some embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions and the lipid mixtures, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R1 and are R2 are the same, and R3 and R4 are the same. In particular embodiments R1, R2, R3 and R4 are the same. In some embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are oleoyl
  • In particular embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions and the lipid mixtures, the molar ratio of neutral lipids:N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine:succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is about 95:4:1.
  • In some embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions and the lipid mixtures, where the neutral lipids are DMPC and cholesterol, the molar ratio of DMPC:cholesterol:(N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine+succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine) is 50:45:5. In certain of these embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NHS-NG-DOPE.
  • In certain embodiments are provided targeted liposomes comprising at least two different neutral lipids, a N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a targeting ligand linked to a second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and, wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00020
  • and
    the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00021
  • wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, an acyl group, and m and p are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the liposome does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol, and wherein the targeting ligand is not an intact antibody.
  • In particular embodiments are provided targeted liposome comprising a neutral phosphatidyl choline, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and encapsulated oxaliplatin, wherein the transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises transferrin linked by a carboxylic acid amide bond to a second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and wherein the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00022
  • and
  • the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 2, and the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00023
  • wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, an acyl group, and m and p are, independently, an integer from 1 to 10; and, wherein the liposome does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine or polyethylene glycol. In certain embodiments, the targeted liposome is substantially free of EDC and/or DCC.
  • In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes, m and p are each independently, an integer from 2 to 4. In some embodiments, m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4. In particular embodiments, m and p are equal are 3.
  • In some embodiments of the targeted liposomes, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each, independently, oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In certain embodiments, R1 and are R2 are the same, and R5 and R6 are the same. In particular embodiments, R1, R2, R5 and R6 are the same. In some embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are oleoyl or stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R1, R2, R3 and R4 are oleoyl.
  • In certain embodiment of the targeted liposomes, the targeting ligand is directed to a target cell. In particular embodiments, the targeting ligand is directed to a cell surface receptor of a target cell. In some embodiments, the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid, a sugar chain or a fragment of a monoclonal antibody. In certain embodiments, the targeting ligand is transferrin, folic acid, hyaluronic acid or a sugar chain. In particular embodiments, the targeting ligand is transferrin. In some of these embodiments, the transferrin is in a holo-form but not in an apo-form. In other embodiments, the transferring is in an apo-form.
  • In certain embodiments of the lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, the formulations do not comprise an anionic lipid. In some embodiments, the formulations do not comprise a cationic lipid. In some embodiments, the formulations do not comprise a cationic lipid or an anionic lipid. In certain embodiments, the formulation do not comprise a phosphatidyl glycerol or derivative thereof. In particular embodiments, the formulations do not comprise egg phosphatidylcholine.
  • In some embodiments of the lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, the at least two different neutral lipids are one or more phospholipids and cholesterol or a cholesterol derivatives. In some embodiments, at least one of the at least two different neutral lipids is a phospholipid. In certain embodiments of the lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, the at least two different neutral lipids are a phosphatidyl choline and cholesterol. In particular embodiments, one of the at least two different neutral lipids is DMPC, DSPC or DPPC. In some of the embodiments, one of the at least two different neutral lipids is cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative. In particular embodiments, the at least two different neutral lipids are DMPC and cholesterol, DSPC and cholesterol, or DPPC and cholesterol. In particular embodiments, the at least two different neutral lipids are DMPC and cholesterol.
  • In some embodiments of the targeted liposomes the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 50 nm to about 250 nm. In certain embodiments, the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 90 nm to about 200 nm. In particular embodiments, the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 100 nm to about 140 nm.
  • In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes the zeta potential of the liposome is negative. In particular embodiments, the zeta potential is from about −75 mV to about −90 mV. In some embodiments, the zeta potential is from about −80 mV to about −85 mV.
  • In some embodiments of the lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE (where NG-DOPE is equivalent to R1 and R2 being oleoyl and m being 3) and, where present, the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NHS-NG-DOPE (where NHS-NG-DOPE is equivalent to R3 and R4 being oleoyl and n being 3) or, where present the targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DOPE (where TF-NG-DOPE is equivalent to R5 and R6 being oleoyl and p being 3).
  • In some embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, the formulations further include a solution.
  • In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes, the molar ratio of neutral lipids:N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine:targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is about 95:4:1.
  • In certain embodiments of the targeted liposomes, the molar ratio of DMPC:cholesterol:(N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine+targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine) is 50:45:5.
  • In particular embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, a labeled compound is present. In certain embodiments, the labeled compound includes a radioisotopic moiety. In particular embodiments, the labeled compound includes 125I.
  • In some embodiments of the liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, a drug is present. In particular embodiments, the drug is an anticancer agent. In some embodiments, the drug is a cytotoxic drug. In certain embodiments, the drug is a topoisomerase I inhibitor. In particular embodiments, the topoisomerase I inhibitor is topotecan or irinotecan. In other embodiments, the drug is a vinca alkaloid. In some embodiments, the vinca alkaloid is vincristine, vinblastine, vinleurosine, vinrodisine, vinorelbine or vindesine. In other embodiments, drug is a nucleic acid. In some of these embodiments, the nucleic acid is an antisense oligonucleotide or a ribozyme. In particular embodiments, the drug is a platinum compound. In certain embodiments, the platinum compound is biplatin, cisplatin, carboplatin, ormaplatin, oxaliplatin, zeniplatin, enloplatin, lobaplatin or spiroplatin. In particular embodiments, the platinum compound is oxaliplatin. In some embodiments drug is an alkylating agent. In particular embodiments, the drug is a taxanes. In other embodiments, the drug is a metabolic antagonist. In certain embodiments, the drug is an antitumour antibiotic. In some embodiments, the drug is a hormone therapy drug. In particular embodiments, the drug is a molecular target drug.
  • In particular embodiments, where oxaliplatin is present, the oxaliplatin is dissolved in an aqueous solution of a sugar selected from the group consisting of trehalose, maltose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, mannitol, glycerol and dextrose. In certain embodiments, the sugar is at a concentration of from about 1 to about 20% percent sugar (v/v). In some embodiments, the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 25 mg/ml within the liposome. In other embodiments, the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 10 mg/ml within the liposome. In still other embodiments, the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml.
  • In particular embodiments where targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present, the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome is from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 3.0 mg/ml. In certain embodiments, the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome is from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.5 mg/ml.
  • In certain embodiments, where a targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is present, the targeting ligand is transferrin. In some embodiments, the transferrin is in a holo-form but not in an apo-form. In certain embodiments, the transferrin is in a holo-form. In some embodiments, the ferric iron is in a concentration of from about 0.4 to about 3.0 μg/ml. In other embodiments, the ferric iron is in a concentration of from about 0.4 to about 1.5 μg/ml.
  • In some embodiments of the lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions and the targeted liposomes, formulations are free of lipid components other than two different neutral lipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine. In particular embodiments, the formulations are free of lipid components other than phosphatidyl choline, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In another aspect are provided pharmaceutical formulations comprising a targeted liposome or liposome-containing composition as described herein and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives.
  • In yet another aspect are provided kits containing one or more of the lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions or targeted liposomes described herein, packaging and instructions for use.
  • In certain embodiments, the kit includes targeted liposomes. In particular embodiments, the targeted liposome is contained in a first container and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, or preservatives are contained in a second container.
  • Unless otherwise noted, the lipid-containing compositions as described herein are intended for use in the methods of treatment and diagnosis as described herein and may be incorporated in the pharmaceutical formulations and kits described herein. The lipid-containing compositions described herein (including lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions), liposomes (including targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, etc.)) may, unless otherwise noted, be made by the methods of production as described herein.
  • In another aspect are provided methods for making the lipid-containing compositions described herein, comprising the step of mixing the at least two different neutral lipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In certain embodiments are provided methods for making the liposome-containing compositions described herein, comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the at least two different neutral lipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine to form a lipid mixture;
  • b) adding a drug to the lipid mixture formed in step (a); and,
  • c) forming a liposome.
  • In certain embodiments, the mixing step (a) is performed in the presence of an organic solvent.
  • In some embodiments, the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing.
  • In certain embodiments, step (c) comprises sonication or stirring. In particular embodiments, step (c) comprises extrusion.
  • In further embodiments are provided methods of making a targeted liposome as described herein, comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the at least two different neutral lipids, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine to form a lipid mixture;
  • b) adding drug or labeled compound to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • c) forming a liposome; and,
  • d) linking a targeting ligand to the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In certain embodiments of the above method, the method further comprising a step (e), purifying the liposome of step (d). In particular embodiments, the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing. In certain embodiments step (c) comprises sonication or stirring. In some embodiments, step (c) comprises extrusion.
  • Also provided are additional methods of making a targeted liposome comprising the steps of
  • a) mixing the phosphatidyl choline, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, and N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine to form a lipid mixture;
  • b) adding oxaliplatin to the lipid mixture formed in step (a);
  • c) forming a liposome; and,
  • d) functionalizing a portion of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine to form a succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and
  • e) linking transferrin to the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • In certain embodiments, the method further comprises a step (f) of purifying the liposome of step (e).
  • In particular embodiments of the method the drug in step (b) is in aqueous solution prior to mixing.
  • In some embodiments of the method step (c) comprises sonication or stirring.
  • In a further aspect of the invention is provided use of the lipid-containing compositions (including targeted liposomes) and formulations thereof as described herein in the manufacture of a medicament. Particularly, the manufacture of a medicament for use in the treatment or diagnosis of conditions as described herein. Further, the pharmaceutical formulations thereof, variously described herein, are also intended for use in the manufacture of a medicament for use in treatment and diagnosis of the conditions and, in accordance with the methods, described herein, unless otherwise noted.
  • In a further aspect of the invention is provide methods for treating cancer comprising the step of a) administering a targeted liposome as described herein to an individual in need thereof in an amount effective to treat cancer, wherein the drug is an anticancer agent.
  • In some embodiments, the individual is a mammal. In particular embodiments, the individual is a human.
  • In certain embodiments, the cancer is breast, gastric, colon, colorectal cancer, cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovary cancer, or a hematological malignancies.
  • In some embodiments of the methods of treatment, step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after combined modality cancer therapy. In particular embodiments, the combined modality cancer therapy comprises chemotherapy, radiation therapy, or surgery.
  • In some embodiments of the methods of treatment, step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after adjunctive cancer therapy. In particular embodiments, the adjunctive cancer therapy comprises administration of one or more agents to reduce hair loss, vomiting, immune suppression, nausea, diarrhea, rash, sensory disturbance, anemia, fatigue, stomatitis, or hand foot syndrome. In certain embodiments, step (a) is performed prior to, concurrently with or after administration of one or more additional anticancer agents. In particular embodiments, the one or more additional anticancer agents include 5-fluorouracil, leucovorin, capecitabine, UFT/LV (tegafur-uracil and leucovorin), irinotecan, an-anti EGFR antibody, an anti-VEGF antibody, a tyrosine kinase inhibitor, or combinations thereof.
  • In certain embodiments of the methods of treatment, the targeted liposome is administered via parenteral administration. In particular embodiments, the parenteral administration is via injection or intravenous infusion.
  • BRIEF DESCRIPTION OF THE DRAWINGS
  • FIG. 1 shows a schematic representation of a targeted liposome.
  • FIG. 2 shows a schematic representation of the active drug targeting of tumor cells using targeted liposomes.
  • FIG. 3 shows a schematic representation of the proposed mode of action of targeted liposomes containing oxaliplatin.
  • FIG. 4 shows a schematic depiction of production process A for targeted liposomes.
  • FIG. 5 shows a schematic of production process B for targeted liposomes.
  • FIG. 6 shows the cytotoxicity of oxaliplatin on AsPC-1 cells at various oxaliplatin concentrations.
  • FIG. 7 shows the number of transferrin receptors present on the cell surface of normal leukocytes and tumor-derived cell lines.
  • FIG. 8 shows the results of size distribution for the liposome-containing mixtures prepared in Example 6 and obtained by QELS; A) Entry 1, B) Entry 2, C) Entry 3, D) Entry 4, E) Entry 5, F) Entry 6.
  • FIG. 9 shows the concentrations of liposomes in the blood, where (♦) indicates the Tf-PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9, (▪) indicates the Tf-NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8, and (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) indicates the Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9.
  • FIG. 10 shows the concentrations of liposomes in cancer tissues; where (♦) indicates the Tf-PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9, (▪) indicates the Tf-NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8, and (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) indicates the Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9.
  • FIG. 11 shows the accumulation in tumor tissue of NG-PE liposomes, prepared as described in Example 13, after intravenous injection, where NGPE liposomes encapsulated tyraminyl inulin labeled with 125I were injected into Colon 26 tumor-bearing mice. Data shown as mean. Data shown as mean±SD (n=5). (□) 0 mol % (−); (▪) 1 mol % (+) Tf-NG-DOPE. * Significant difference from 0 mol % (−).
  • FIG. 12 shows the inhibitory effects of liposomes on tumor growth by plotting the tumor growth ratio vs. days after initial treatment, where (♦) indicates the Tf-PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9; (▪) indicates the PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9 without Tf; (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) indicates the Tf-NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8; (◯) indicates the NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8, without Tf; (*) indicates the Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9; () indicates the PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9, without Tf; (+) indicates l-OHP solution; and (−) indicates no treatment.
  • FIG. 13 shows the effect of varying concentration of NG-PE (NG-DSPE) on the percentage of drug dose detected in blood, where concentration (% of total lipid content) of NG-DSPE is as follows: (♦) 0%, (▪) 1%; (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) 3%; (x) 6%; (◯) 12%; and with the following lipids: () MPB 6%; (+) PDP 6%.
  • FIG. 14 shows the blood retention of liposomes with various dicarboxylic acid linkers, with and without Tf; where (♦) Tf-NGPE, (▪) Tf-NSPE; (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) TF-MPB; (x) NGPE (no Tf), (*) MPB (no Tf).
  • FIG. 15 shows exemplary analysis of liposomes by electrophoresis: lane 6 (transferrin-N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine-liposome (Tf-NG-DSPE liposome)); lane 5 (transferrin-polyethyleneglycol-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine-liposome (Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome)) are shown. Lanes 1-4, contain h-apo-Tf (240 ng), h-apo-Tf (120 ng), h-apo-Tf (60 ng), and h-apo-Tf (30 ng), respectively.
  • FIG. 16 shows the amount of transferrin binding to Tf-NG-DSPE liposomes with (lane 5) and without (lane 4) non-NG-DSPE incorporated into the liposome. Lanes 1-3, contain h-apo-Tf (400 ng), h-apo-Tf (200 ng), and h-apo-Tf (50 ng), respectively.
  • FIG. 17 shows the accumulation oxaliplatin in blood after administration of (▪) NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 5 mg/kg and () Tf-PEG liposomes at 5 mg/kg.
  • FIG. 18 shows the accumulation oxaliplatin in colon 26 tumors after administration of (ζ) NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 5 mg/kg and () Tf-PEG liposomes at 5 mg/kg in mouse colon 26 tumors.
  • FIG. 19 shows the antitumor effect in colon 26 tumor-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where () indicates vehicle control (9% sucrose); (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) indicates l-OHP solution at 5 mg/kg, (♦) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 5 mg/kg and (▪) indicates Tf-PEG liposomes at 5 mg/kg.
  • FIG. 20 shows the antitumor effect in HCT-116 human colon tumor xenograft-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where () indicates vehicle control (300 mM (10.27%) sucrose); (◯) indicates blank (no drug) liposomes, (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) indicates l-OHP solution at 15 mg/kg, (♦) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 10 mg/kg and (▪) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 15 mg/kg. All liposomes were administered by exact body weight with an injection volume of 0.103 mL/10 g body weight.
  • FIG. 21 shows the antitumor effect in HT-29 human colon tumor xenograft-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where () indicates vehicle control (300 mM (10.27%) sucrose), (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 15 mg/kg, (▪) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 10 mg/kg, and (♦) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 6.7 mg/kg.
  • FIG. 22 shows the antitumor effect in MKN45 gastric human tumor xenograft-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where () indicates vehicle control (300 mM (10.27%) sucrose), (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 15 mg/kg, (▪) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 10 mg/kg, and (♦) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 6.7 mg/kg.
  • FIG. 23 shows the antitumor effect in COLO 205 human tumor xenograft-bearing mice of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, where () indicates vehicle control (9% sucrose); (
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ) indicates l-OHP solution at 5 mg/kg q4d×3 (day 16), 10 mg/kg q2d×2 (day 47), 2 mg/kg q2d×6 (day 51); (♦) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 5 mg/kg q4d×3 (day 16), 10 mg/kg q2d×2 (day 47), 2 mg/kg q2d×6 (day 51); and (▪) indicates NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at 10 mg/kg q4d×3 (day 16), 15 mg/kg q2d×2 (day 47), 4 mg/kg q2d×6 (day 51).
  • FIG. 24 shows the pattern of SDS-PAGE after reduction with 2-mercaptoethanol, where lane 1 is the molecular weight markers, lane 2 is holo-transferrin, lanes 3-5 are NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes, and lane 6 is Tf-NG-DOPE.
  • FIG. 25 shows an exemplary HPLC chromatogram of system suitability.
  • DETAILED DESCRIPTION OF THE INVENTION
  • Provided herein are lipid-containing compositions (including targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposome-containing compositions, lipid mixtures, etc.), and methods of making and using the lipid-containing compositions described herein. The lipid-containing compositions, and the liposomes in particular that are provide herein, are suitable for the preparation of pharmaceutical formulations and for use in the treatment or diagnosis of a variety of conditions, including cancer. The compositions, including the pharmaceutical formulations, provide for more effective treatment and diagnosis regimens with reduced adverse effects associated with the drug or labeled compound being delivered to the individual. The increased efficacy and reduced adverse effects should increase the therapeutic index of the drug formulation and provide an opportunity for successful treatment of a variety of conditions, including cancer and should also increase the efficacy and reduce the adverse effects associated with diagnosis. The increased specificity of the drug formulations with the concomitant reduction in adverse effects should ensure therapeutic benefit to a greater number and range of individuals being treated, thus, saving or prolonging lives and improving the quality of life of individuals in need of treatment. The increased specificity of the labeled compound formulations with the concomitant reduction in adverse effects should increase the number of individuals who can be successfully diagnosed, for example, able to tolerate the diagnosis formulation, and also increase the accuracy (e.g., sensitivity, etc.) of diagnosis, including allowing for earlier diagnosis of conditions and more effective monitoring of the severity of the disease (e.g., progression or regression with or without therapy).
  • Included in the compositions presently described are pharmaceutical formulations of the lipid-containing compositions. The lipid-containing compositions described herein include, but are not limited to, liposomes that encapsulate drugs and labeled compounds and can be used in the treatment or diagnosis of disease or other conditions requiring treatment or diagnosis, including, for example, cancer (e.g., breast, gastric, colorectal or colon cancer).
  • When conventional anticancer (including cytotoxic) agents are administered intravenously, the entire body is exposed and affected by the drug non-selectively. As a result, a number of adverse reactions may occur, the cancer is not targeted, and/or the drug effect may be lost during the circulation process. Encapsulation of a drug in a liposome composition prior to administration may result in a one or more benefits, including reducing the adverse effect(s) of the drug on a normal cell, protecting the drug until it arrives at a target pathological cell in the case where the drug may be unstable, prolonging the presence of the drug in the circulatory system to enable delivery to pathological cells, and/or in facilitating delivery of the drug to a particular target pathological cell. More specific targeting of the drug and the reduction of loss of drug by uptake in the RES also includes the benefit of reducing the amount of drug that needs to be administered and thereby also reduces the cost of therapy, as well as the other benefits described herein.
  • Similarly, many labeled compounds have adverse effects and/or may be degraded in the time between administration and diagnosis (e.g., the time at which the diagnostic technique is performed—for example, radioisotope detection, magnetic resonance imaging, ultrasound, etc.). Incorporation of the labeled compounds in the lipid-containing compositions described herein should increase the efficacy of the labeled compound, such as, for example, the threshold of detection may be achieved at lower doses of labeled compound, reducing the adverse effects of the agent, and/or extending the window of time in which the diagnosis can be performed.
  • The lipid-containing compositions also include lipids modified with targeting ligands (e.g., targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposome-containing compositions, lipid mixtures) or other derivatization. For example, liposomal compositions incorporating targeting factor (e.g., transferrin, folate, etc.) and derivatized lipids (e.g., N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines) were developed to improve the safety and efficacy of anticancer agents (e.g., oxaliplatin, etc.) through the prolongation of drug circulation time in plasma (compared to drug administered in solution alone) and by targeting factor-specific receptors on tumor cells. This improved bioavailability and tumor-targeting, should result in improved safety and increased antitumor activity, and therefore a greater likelihood of effective treatment for individuals in need thereof, while also reducing the adverse effects associated with many drugs, particularly the severe adverse effects associated with most anticancer agents. Similarly, such derivatization and targeting factors may also be employed to efficiently target particular sites (e.g., tumor types, organs, tissues, etc.) for delivery of labeled compounds.
  • The invention also provides transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines, which can be used in the lipid-containing compositions and formulations thereof described herein.
  • The lipid-containing compositions, including the liposomes, described herein, may be made by the methods herein described, as well as methods for liposome manufacture known to the skilled artisan and appropriate in view of the teaching provide in the present specification. Unless otherwise noted, the liposomes and liposome-containing compositions described herein can be incorporated without limitation in pharmaceutical formulations and/or kits, including pharmaceutical formulations and/or kits as described herein and, additionally, those that would be apparent to a skilled artisan in view of the teaching provided in the present specification. Similarly the liposomes and liposome-containing compositions and pharmaceutical formulations incorporating the liposomes and liposome-containing compositions may be used without limitation, unless otherwise noted, in the methods of treatment or diagnosis consistent with the description provided throughout the present specification and in accordance with the practice of skill artisans in view of the teaching provided herein.
  • An exemplary targeted liposome incorporating a drug (oxaliplatin) is represented schematically in FIG. 1. Proposed mechanisms of the uptake and mode of action of targeted liposomes are provided in FIGS. 2 and 3. As used herein, the term “targeted liposome” refers generally to a liposome with components including at least one or more phospholipid(s), NωPE, TF-NωPE and which also incorporates a drug or labeled compound as described herein. Each of these components as described throughout the specification, without limitation, can be incorporated into the targeted liposomes of the present invention in keeping with the teaching provided herein. It is noted that blank liposomes, described in greater detail herein, can also be “targeted,” in that they can incorporate TF-modified NωPEs, but generally do not incorporate a drug or labeled compound.
  • N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • The lipid-containing compositions described herein incorporate at least one N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine according to Formula 1, below:
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00024
  • wherein R1 and R2 are, independently, an acyl group, and m is and integer from 1 to 10.
  • As used herein, the term “N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine,” and its cognates, refer to the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 1 as provided herein. Similarly the abbreviation NωPE is used to refer to the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 1 (e.g., Nω-DOPE, Nω-DSPE, NG-DOPE, etc.), and, for example NG-PE refers to N-glutaryl phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) of Formula 1, unless otherwise noted.
  • It is intended that the only phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) incorporated in the lipid-containing compositions (including targeted liposomes) described herein are N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines of Formula 1 or succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines of Formula 2 or the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines of Formula 3, as described in greater detail below. As used herein, the term “non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine,” and cognates thereof, refer to phosphatidyl ethanolamine, semi-synthetic phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s), synthetic phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) and/or derivatives thereof that are not encompassed by Formula 1, Formula 2 or Formula 3.
  • A wide variety of acyl groups, represented by R1 and R2, may be used in Formula 1, as is well understood by those of ordinary skill in the field.
  • In some embodiments, the acyl group is derived from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having 12-22 carbon atoms. Exemplary acyl groups include, but are not limited to, acyl groups derived from lauric acid, tridecanoic acid, myristic acid, pentadecanoic acid, palmitic acid, margaric acid, stearic acid, nonadecanoic acid, arachic acid, heneicosanic acid, behenic acid, 2-lauroleic acid, 5-lauroleic acid, 11-lauroreic acid, 5-myristoleic acid, myristoleic acid, 2-palmitoleic acid, 7-palmitoleic acid, cis-9-palmitoleic acid, trans-9-palmitoleic acid, petroselinic acid, petroselidinic acid, oleic acid, elaidic acid, vaccenic acid, gondoic acid, trans-gondoic acid, erucic acid, linoleic acid, linoelaidic acid, α-eleostearic acid, β-eleostearic acid, linolenic acid, pseudoeleostearic acid, arachidonic acid, eicosapentaenic acid, or docosahexaenic acid.
  • In certain embodiments, the acyl group is derived from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having 14-18 carbon atoms. Exemplary acyl groups of this type include, but are not limited to those derived from oleic acid (18 carbons), palmitic acid (16 carbons), stearic acid (18 carbons), or myristic acid (14 carbons). As is recognized by those of skill, the corresponding acyl groups are oleoyl, palmitoyl, stearoyl, and myristoyl, respectively.
  • In other embodiments, the acyl groups are derived from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having 14-18, 14-20, 14-22, 16-18, 16-20, 16-22, 18-20, 18-22, 12, 14, 16, 18, 20 or 22 carbons. In certain embodiments, the acyl groups are derived from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having an even number of carbons.
  • In some embodiments, the acyl groups are derived from oleic acid (oleoyl), stearic acid (stearoyl), palmitic acid (palmitoyl), linoleic acid (linoleoyl, 18 carbons), or myristic acid (myristoyl). In other embodiments, the acyl groups are derived from oleic acid (oleoyl). In certain embodiments, the acyl groups are derived from stearic acid (stearoyl). In still other embodiments, the acyl groups are derived from palmitic acid (palmitoyl). In other embodiments, the acyl groups are derived from myristic acid (myristoyl).
  • In some embodiments, the acyl group is derived from a saturated aliphatic carboxylic acid, such as, but not limited to palmitic acid (16 carbons), stearic acid (18 carbons), or myristic acid (14 carbons).
  • In other embodiments, the acyl group is derived from an unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acid, such as, but not limited to oleic acid (oleoyl, 18 carbons), linoleic acid (linoleoyl, 18 carbons) or linolenic acid (linolenoyl, 18 carbons). In some embodiments, the acyl group is derived from linoleic acid.
  • In certain embodiments, m is 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10. In other embodiments, m is an integer from 1-8, 1-6, 1-5, 1-7, 1-3, 1-2, 2-8, 2-6, 2-5, 2-4, 2-3, 3-4, 3-5, or 3-6. In some embodiments, m is an integer from 2-4. In other embodiments, m is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In certain embodiments, m is an integer from 1 to 4. As is recognized by those of ordinary skill, m=1 corresponds to a malonic acid derivative of the phosphatidyl ethanolamine (PE), while m=2, 3, or 4, represent succinic acid, glutaric acid, and adipic acid derivatives of the PE, respectively. In some embodiments, m is 3 (glutaric acid).
  • In certain embodiments, R1 and R2 are the same acyl group. In other embodiments, R1 and R2 are different acyl groups. In certain embodiments, R1 and R2 are oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R1 and R2 are oleoyl. In other embodiments, R1 and R2 are stearoyl. In particular embodiments, R1 and R2 are palmitoyl. In other embodiments, R1 and R2 are myristoyl.
  • In some embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 1 is N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DOPE (i.e., where R1 and R2 are oleoyl and m is 3)). In other embodiments, it is N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DSPE (i.e., where R1 and R2 are stearoyl and m is 3). In other embodiments, it is N-glutaryl-dimyristoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DMPE (i.e., where R1 and R2 are myristoyl and m is 3)). In other embodiments, it is N-glutaryl-dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DPPE (i.e., where R1 and R2 are palmitoyl and m is 3)). In other embodiments, it is N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NS-DSPE (i.e., where R1 and R2 are stearoyl and m is 2)). In other embodiments, it is N-adipinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NA-DSPE (i.e., where R1 and R2 are stearoyl and m is 4)). In certain embodiments the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 1 is NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • Preparation of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • The N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines described herein can be obtained by binding a dicarboxylic acid to the amino group of phosphatidyl ethanolamine.
  • Phospholipids, including phosphatidyl ethanolamines and their derivatives utilized for the purposes described herein, must be of high purity and should ideally be homogeneous. Known methods for the preparation of high purity phospholipids include extraction of the lipid from a buffer solution and purification using column chromatography. For example, production methods for N-succinyl dipalmitoylphosphatidylethanolamine are described in International Patent Application Publication WO93/01828 (JPAH7-501316) and U.S. Pat. Nos. 5,804,552 and 5,554,728, the contents of which are hereby incorporated in their entirety. These production methods include the purification of phospholipid derivative from the reaction mixture by silica-gel 60 column chromatography of the reaction mixture. Dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (DPPE) is reacted with succinic acid anhydride with triethylamine catalyst at room temperature under nitrogen gas for 16 hours.
  • Other production methods of N-(ω-carboxy) acylamido-phosphatidyl ethanolamine phospholipid derivatives are described in Japanese published patent application JPA2001-261688, which includes purification by separating a liquid layer after addition of pH3.5-7.5 buffer solution to the reaction mixture, and is herein incorporated by reference in its entirety. In this case, the PE was reacted with dicarboxylic acid anhydride with triethylamine alkali catalyst at 4° C. for 1 hr. This method may not work well for all phosphatidyl ethanolamine derivatives.
  • DOPE (dioleoyl-phosphatidyl ethanolamine) can also be commercially obtained or prepared by methods known to the skilled artisan. For example, briefly, lecithin (API Starting Material) can be chemically hydrolyzed to generate glycerol-phospho-choline that is isolated by precipitation. The lipid is then acylated using activated oleic acid, and DOPC (dioleoyl-phosphatidyl choline) is isolated by normal phase column chromatography and passed through ion exchange column to purify. DOPE can be prepared from DOPC by reacting with ethanolamine using phospholipase D.
  • The N-(ω-carboxy) acylamido-phosphatidylethanolamine phospholipid derivatives can also be prepared in such a manner as described in, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 4,534,899, which is hereby incorporated in its entirety. Briefly, a dicarboxylic anhydride is reacted with a phospholipid such as phosphatidylethanolamine to obtain a dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidylethanolamine.
  • Succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • Succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines as described herein are represented by the following Formula 2:
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00025
  • wherein R3 and R4 are, independently, an acyl group, and n is and integer from 1 to 10.
  • As used herein, the term “succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine,” and its cognates, refer to the succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 2 as provided herein. Similarly the abbreviation SuccNωPE can be used to refer to the succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 2 (e.g., SuccNω-DOPE, SuccNω-DSPE, SuccNG-DOPE, etc.), and, for example NHS-NG-PE refers to a the succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) of Formula 2 formed by reaction with NHS, unless otherwise noted.
  • A wide variety of acyl groups that are represented by R3 and R4 may be used, as is well understood by those of ordinary skill in the field and as described above for R1 and R2. Unless otherwise noted herein, it is expressly intended that the description provided herein of the acyl groups with respect to Formula 1 (e.g., R1 and R2) is equally applicable to the acyl groups with respect to Formula 2 (e.g., R3 and R4). Including, in particular, the description above in the section entitled “N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines.”
  • In certain embodiments, R3 and R4 are the same acyl group. In other embodiments, R3 and R4 are different acyl groups. In certain embodiments, R3 and R4 are oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R3 and R4 are oleoyl. In other embodiments, R3 and R4 are stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R3 and R4 are palmitoyl. In other embodiments, R3 and R4 are myristoyl.
  • In certain embodiments, n is 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10. In other embodiments, n is an integer from 1-8, 1-6, 1-5, 1-7, 1-3, 1-2, 2-8, 2-6, 2-5, 2-4, 2-3, 3-4, 3-5, or 3-6. In some embodiments, n is an integer from 2-4. In other embodiments, n is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In certain embodiments, n is an integer from 1 to 4. As is recognized by those of ordinary skill, n=1 corresponds to a malonic acid derivative of the phosphatidyl ethanolamine (PE), while n=2, 3, or 4, represent succinic acid, glutaric acid, and adipic acid derivatives of the PE, respectively. In some embodiments, n is 3 (glutaric acid).
  • In some embodiments, the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 2 is a succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DOPE). In other embodiments, it is a succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DSPE). In certain embodiments the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 2 is a succinimidyl ester of NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • In some embodiments, the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 2 is the succinimidyl ester of the N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNG-DOPE (i.e., where R3 and R4 are oleoyl and n is 3)). In other embodiments, it is the succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNG-DSPE (i.e., where R3 and R4 are stearoyl and n is 3). In other embodiments, it is the succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-dimyristoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNG-DMPE (i.e., where R3 and R4 are myristoyl and n is 3)). In other embodiments, it is the succinimidyl ester of N-glutaryl-dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNG-DPPE (i.e., where R3 and R4 are palmitoyl and n is 3)). In other embodiments, it is the succinimidyl ester of N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNS-DSPE (i.e., where R3 and R4 are stearoyl and n is 2)). In other embodiments, it is the succinimidyl ester of N-adipinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (SuccNA-DSPE (i.e., where R3 and R4 are stearoyl and n is 4)). In certain embodiments the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 2 is SuccNG-DOPE or SuccNG-DSPE.
  • In some embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Nω-DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNω-DOPE. In other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Nω-DSPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNω-DSPE. In still other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Nω-DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNω-DSPE. In certain other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Nω-DSPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNω-DOPE. In certain of these embodiments, the succinimidyl ester may be NHS (e.g., NHS-Nω-DOPE, NHS-Nω-DSPE, etc.).
  • In some embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNG-DOPE. In other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DSPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNG-DSPE. In still other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNG-DSPE. In certain other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DSPE and the succinimidyl ester of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is SuccNG-DOPE. In certain of these embodiments, the succinimidyl ester may be NHS (e.g., NHS-NG-DOPE, NHS-NG-DSPE, etc.).
  • Preparation of Succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • The succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines described herein can be obtained by derivatization of the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines described herein, prepared as known in the art and described herein. Preparation of the succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines is also described in greater detail below, including in the Examples. In view of the teaching provided in the present specification, the skilled artisan will also be able to modify the methods described herein.
  • A method for the production of the succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines of the present inventions is as follows:
      • To 1 equivalent of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines represented by Formula 2 as described herein is added about 0.7-1.3 equivalents of NHS, which are dissolved in an organic solvent that does not have an active hydrogen. The mixture is then reacted with about 0.7-1.3 equivalents of a carbodiimide compound at 0-50 C.°, for about 1-7 days.
  • Exemplary, organic solvents that do not have an active hydrogen include, but are not limited to, esters (e.g., ethyl acetate, butyl acetate, etc.), aliphatic hydrocarbons (e.g., hexane, heptanes, etc.), aromatic hydrocarbons (e.g., toluene, xylene, etc.), halogenated hydrocarbone (e.g., chloroform, dichloromethane, dichloroethane, etc.), ethers (e.g., THF, dioxane, diethyl ether, etc.), cyclic hydrocarbons (e.g., cyclohexane, etc.), DMF and DMSO. The organic solvent may also be dehydrated.
  • A wide variety of carbodiimide compounds can be used, so long as the compounds posses a carbodiimide group (—N═C═N—). For example, carbodiimide compounds that made be used include, but are not limited to, carbodiimide groups such as N,N′-dicyclohexyl-carbodiimide (DCC), N,N′-diisopropyl-carbodiimide, N-ethyl-N′-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-carbodiimide hydrochloride (EDC), etc. In certain embodiments, DCC used. In others EDC is used.
  • The above-described reaction may also be performed under conditions that minimize or eliminate production of by-products. Unwanted by-products include urea compounds (e.g., N,N′-dicyclohexylurea, N-ethyl-N′-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)urea, etc.), N-acylated urea compounds, carboxyanhydride compounds and 5-oxazolone compounds. Conditions and materials which disfavor or minimize the formation of by-products include, 1) slowly dissolving the carbodiimide compounds in organic solvent, 2) performing the reaction below 0 C.° to prevent heat evolution by the reaction, etc. Other means for optimizing the reaction and minimizing the production of by-products will be understood by those of ordinary skill in the field, particularly in view of the teaching provided herein.
  • The organic solvent that is capable of dissolving the carbodiimide compounds is the same as the organic solvent, which does not have an active hydrogen as described above. The solvent used to dissolve the carbodiimide and the organic solvent without active hydrogens may be the same or different.
  • The progress of the reaction can monitored by a thin-layer chromatography (TLC) systems, high-performance liquid chromatography (HPLC), and/or evaporated light scattering detectors. Other methods for monitoring the progress of the reaction will also be known by those of skill in the art.
  • Purification can be performed by silica gel column chromatography using a mixture of chloroform and methanol. Additional purification methods will be known to those of skill in the art.
  • In fully dehydrated organic solvents and in the absence of strong acidity or strong alkali, the succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines as described herein are usually stable.
  • Targeting Factor-Modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines
  • Targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines include a targeting ligand linked to a second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, where the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00026
  • wherein R5 and R6 are, independently, an acyl group, and p is and integer from 1 to 10.
  • As used herein, the term “targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine,” and its cognates, refer to the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines encompassed by Formula 3 and modified with a targeting factor as provided herein. Similarly the abbreviation TF-NωPE can be used to refer to the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (e.g., TF-Nω-DOPE, TF-Nω-DSPE, TF-NG-DOPE, etc.), and, for example TF-NG-PE refers to a targeting ligand linked to N-glutaryl phosphatidyl ethanolamine(s) of Formula 3.
  • A wide variety of acyl groups that are represented by R5 and R6 may be used, as is well understood by those of ordinary skill in the field and as described above for R1 and R2. Unless otherwise noted herein, it is expressly intended that the description provided herein of the acyl groups with respect to Formula 1 (e.g., R1 and R2) is equally applicable to the acyl groups with respect to Formula 3 (e.g., R5 and R6). Including, in particular, the description above in the section entitled “N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines.”
  • In certain embodiments, R5 and R6 are the same acyl group. In other embodiments, R5 and R6 are different acyl groups. In certain embodiments, R5 and R6 are oleoyl, stearoyl, palmitoyl or myristoyl. In some embodiments, R5 and R6 are oleoyl. In other embodiments, R5 and R6 are stearoyl. In certain embodiments, R5 and R6 are palmitoyl. In other embodiments, R5 and R6 are myristoyl.
  • In certain embodiments, p is 1, 2, 3, 4, 5, 6, 7, 8, 9, or 10. In other embodiments, p is an integer from 1-8, 1-6, 1-5, 1-7, 1-3, 1-2, 2-8, 2-6, 2-5, 2-4, 2-3, 3-4, 3-5, or 3-6. In some embodiments, p is an integer from 2-4. In other embodiments, p is 1, 2 or 3.
  • In certain embodiments, p is an integer from 1 to 4. As is recognized by those of ordinary skill, p=1 corresponds to a malonic acid derivative of the phosphatidyl ethanolamine (PE), while p=2, 3, or 4, represent succinic acid, glutaric acid, and adipic acid derivatives of the PE, respectively. In some embodiments, p is 3 (glutaric acid).
  • In some embodiments, the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 3 is targeting factor-modified N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (TF-NG-DOPE). In other embodiments, the targeting factor-modified N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine is (TF-NG-DSPE). In certain embodiments the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 3 is TF-NG-DOPE or TF-NG-DSPE.
  • In some embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 3 is N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DOPE (i.e., where R5 and R6 are oleoyl and p is 3)). In other embodiments, it is N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DSPE (i.e., where R5 and R6 are stearoyl and p is 3). In other embodiments, it is N-glutaryl-dimyristoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DMPE (i.e., where R5 and R6 are myristoyl and p is 3)). In other embodiments, it is N-glutaryl-dipalmitoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NG-DPPE (i.e., where R5 and R6 are palmitoyl and p is 3)). In other embodiments, it is N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NS-DSPE (i.e., where R5 and R6 are stearoyl and p is 2)). In other embodiments, it is N-adipinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (NA-DSPE (i.e., where R5 and R6 are stearoyl and p is 4)). In certain embodiments the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine of Formula 3 is NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • In certain embodiments the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), which is described in greater detail below, and the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine incorporated in the transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is of Formula 3, as described herein.
  • In some embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Nω-DOPE and the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Tf-Nω-DOPE. In other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Nω-DSPE and the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Tf-Nω-DSPE. In still other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Nω-DOPE and the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Tf-Nω-DSPE. In certain other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Nω-DSPE and the targeting ligand is transferrin (Tf), and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is Tf-Nω-DOPE. In certain of these embodiments, m may be 3 and the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is a NG-PE according to Formula 1.
  • In some embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DOPE. In other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DSPE and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DSPE. In still other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DOPE and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DSPE. In certain other embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is NG-DSPE and the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is TF-NG-DOPE.
  • The targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines may be prepared from the SuccNωPE by reaction with the targeting ligand and other reactants as described herein in greater detail. The TF-NωPE may either be prepared prior to mixture with other lipid components of the lipid-containing compositions described herein (and optionally purified) or may be prepared in situ from the reaction of the pre-prepared SuccNωPE that has been incorporated in a lipid-containing composition.
  • Additional Lipid Components
  • The lipid-containing compositions as described herein also contain one or more additional lipid components in addition to the NωPEs, SuccNωPEs and/or TF-NωPEs described herein. A variety of additional lipid components can be used, however, the term “additional lipid component(s)” is not intended to include non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (PEs) or derivatives of PEs as in Formulae 1, 2 or 3. In some embodiments, the one or more additional lipid component(s) may be a phospholipid or one or more phospholipids. In certain embodiments, the one or more additional lipid components may include at least two neutral lipids. In other embodiments, one or more phospholipids may be present and, optionally, an “additional lipid” (which is not a phospholipid). A variety of neutral lipids can be used, however, the at least two neutral lipids are not intended to include non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (PEs) or derivatives of PEs as in Formulae 1, 2 or 3. It is not intended that the term “phospholipid,” as used herein, should include PEs or derivatives thereof, as in Formulae 1, 2 or 3. Similarly, the term “additional lipid” does not include PEs or derivatives thereof, as in Formulae 1, 2 or 3, nor does it include other phospholipids.
  • In particular embodiments, phospholipid(s) may be used in the lipid-containing compositions and formulations described herein. For example, one or more, at least two, at least three, at least four phospholipids; or, two, three, or four phospholipids. In particular embodiments there is one phospholipid. In certain embodiments the lipid components of the compositions are limited to one phospholipid, the NωPE, and the SuccNωPE (or TF-modified NωPE, where the reaction with the targeting factor has been performed).
  • In particular embodiments, two or more neutral lipids may be used in the lipid-containing compositions and formulations described herein. For example, at least two, at least three, at least four neutral lipids; or, two, three, or four neutral lipids. In particular embodiments there are two neutral lipids. In certain embodiments the lipid components of the compositions are limited to two neutral lipids, the NωPE, and the SuccNωPE (or TF-modified NωPE, where the reaction with the targeting factor has been performed).
  • In some embodiments, where the additional lipid components(s) includes a phospholipid, the phospholipid may be a phosphatidylcholine, including naturally occurring, semi-synthetic or synthetic phosphatidylcholines (e.g., DSPC, DMPC, etc.). In some embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is a non-naturally occurring phosphatidylcholine (e.g., not egg phosphatidylcholine). In particular embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is an acyl phosphatidylcholine (e.g., DMPC, DPPC, POPC, DSPC, etc.). In some embodiments, the phospholipid is cationic. In other embodiments the phospholipid is anionic. In still other embodiments, the phospholipid is neutral. In particular embodiments, the one or more phospholipid(s) is not anionic. In other embodiments, the one or more phospholipid(s) is not cationic. In certain embodiments where more than one phospholipid is present, an anionic and neutral lipid may be included. Exemplary phospholipids include, but are not limited to, phosphatidylcholines (PCs), phosphatidic acid, phosphatidylserine, phosphatidylglycerol, etc. In some embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions do not include phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylglycerol.
  • In certain embodiments, at least one of the at least two neutral lipids may be a phospholipid. In some embodiments, the phospholipid may be a phosphatidylcholine, including naturally occurring, semi-synthetic or synthetic phosphatidylcholines (e.g., DSPC, DMPC, etc.). In some embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is a non-naturally occurring phosphatidyl choline (e.g., not egg phosphatidyl choline). In particular embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is an acyl phosphatidyl choline (e.g., DMPC, DPPC, POPC, DSPC, etc.).
  • In some embodiments, at least one of the at least two neutral lipids may be cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative (e.g., cholesterol pullulan, positively-charged cholesterol (e.g., DC-Chol)), incorporating a moiety of a radioisotope (e.g., 3H, 14C, 125I, 131I, etc.), having a functional moiety (e.g., a fluorescent moiety, etc.).
  • In certain embodiments, where the lipid-containing compositions include one or more phospholipid, the compositions may additionally comprise an additional neutral, non-phospholipid as the additional lipid. For example, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative as described above.
  • Phospholipids (non-PEs) for use in the lipid-containing compositions described herein include synthetic, semi-synthetic and naturally occurring phospholipids. Exemplary phospholipids include, but are not limited to, phosphatidylcholine (PC), phosphatidic acid, phosphatidylserine, phosphatidylglycerol, etc. In other embodiments, the one or more phospholipids include phosphatidylcholine (PC) or phosphatidic acid and do not include phosphatidylserine or phosphatidylglycerol.
  • In some embodiments, the phospholipid is a phosphatidylcholine. In certain embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine may be, e.g., distearoyl phosphatidyl choline (DSPC), dimyristoyl phosphatidylcholine (DMPC), dipalmitoyl phosphatidylcholine (DPPC), palmitoyl oleoyl phosphatidylcholine (POPC), egg phosphatidylcholine (EPC), hydrogenated soya phosphatidylcholine (HSPC), etc. In particular embodiments, at least one phospholipid is a phosphatidylcholine. In certain of these embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is DMPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is DSPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is DPPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is POPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is EPC. In other embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is HSPC. In some embodiments, one phospholipid is included and is DMPC, DSPC, DPPC, POPC, EPC or HSPC. In particular embodiments where there are lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is DMPC. In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is DSPC. In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is DPPC. In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is POPC. In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is EPC. In other embodiments where the lipid-containing composition includes a single phospholipid (non-PE phospholipid), the phospholipid is HSPC.
  • In certain embodiments, the additional lipid components(s) may include at least one phospholipid and, optionally, an additional lipid such as cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative. In particular embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are a single phospholipid and cholesterol. In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include at least one phosphatidylcholine and cholesterol. In particular embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include a single phosphatidylcholine and cholesterol. In certain embodiments where cholesterol is included, the phospholipid is DSPC, DMPC, DPPC, POPC, EPC or HSPC. In some embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and DMPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and DSPC. In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and one of DMPC or DSPC. In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DMPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DSPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and DPPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and POPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and EPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include cholesterol and HSPC. In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and one of DMPC, DSPC, DPPC, POPC, EPC or HSPC. In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DMPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DSPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and DPPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and POPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and EPC. In other embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) are cholesterol and HSPC.
  • In particular embodiments, there is one phospholipid and the phospholipid is not HSPC or EPC.
  • In particular embodiments, there are one or more phospholipids. In certain embodiments, the one or more phospholipid includes a phosphatidyl choline. In particular embodiments, are included one or more phospholipids and cholesterol (or a cholesterol derivative). In certain embodiments, the phospholipid is a phosphatidyl choline and the composition additionally includes a cholesterol (or a cholesterol derivative). In particular embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is a phosphatidylcholine which includes a moiety of saturated fatty acid (e.g., DMPC, DSPC or DPPC). In certain embodiments the phosphatidylcholine is not egg phosphatidylcholine. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is not HSPC.
  • In particular embodiments, there are two neutral lipids. In some embodiments, the two neutral lipids are cholesterol (or a cholesterol derivative) and a phosphatidyl choline. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidylcholine is a phosphatidylcholine which includes a moiety of saturated fatty acid (e.g., DMPC, DSPC or DPPC). In certain embodiments the phosphatidylcholine is not egg phosphatidylcholine.
  • The additional lipid component(s) as described herein, and those known to the skilled artisan, are commercially available from a number of suppliers, including, for example Avanti Polar Lipids, Inc. (Alabaster, Ak.), Northern Lipid Inc. (Canada), Lipoid GmbH (Germany), NOF Corporation (Japan), Nippon Fine Chemical Co., Ltd (Japan).
  • Drugs
  • A variety of drugs may be included in the lipid-containing compositions of the present invention, for example, a compound or a gene. In certain embodiments, the drug may be an anticancer agent, for example, an anticancer agent suitable for encapsulation in a liposome. The amount of drug to be included in the lipid-containing compositions, and formulations thereof, as described herein can be readily determined by the skilled artisan in view of the teaching herein provided and depending on the drug selected and the use intended for the composition or formulation, taking into account factors specific to both the drug and the individual to be treated, as described further herein.
  • In certain embodiments, the drug may be a nucleic acid, for example, nucleic acid encoding for sequences with anticancer properties. For example, but not limited to, antisense oligonucleotides, ribozymes, etc.
  • In some embodiments, the anticancer agent can be a cytotoxic drug, including those known by skill in the art and medical practitioners. Exemplary anticancer agents include topoisomerase I inhibitors, vinca alkaloids, alkylating agents (including platinum compounds), taxanes and others known to those of skill in the art.
  • In some embodiments, the anticancer drug may be a topoisomerase I inhibitor, for example, but not limited to, topotecan, irinotecan, etc.
  • The anticancer drug may also be a vinca alkaloid, for example, vincristine, vinblastine, vinleurosine, vinrodisine, vinorelbine, vindesine, etc.
  • Further, the anticancer drug may also be a platinum compound. Non-limiting examples of platinum compounds include biplatin, cisplatin, carboplatin, ormaplatin, oxaliplatin, zeniplatin, enloplatin, lobaplatin, spiroplatin, etc.
  • Oxaliplatin (platinum (II) cis-oxalato complex of trans-1-1,2-diaminocyclohexane) is a platinum, more specifically, an oragnoplatinum, complex having a structure represented by the following formula shown below. Oxaliplatin is also known as the following: diaminocyclohexane platinum, DACH-platinum, and cis-[(1R,2R)-1,2-cyclohexanediamine-N,N][oxalato(2)-O,O′]platinum (C8H14N2O4Pt; MW 397.4 g/mol). As mentioned previously, oxaliplatin is the active pharmaceutical ingredient in Eloxatin™.
  • Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00027
  • Oxaliplatin is useful as an antitumor agent, since it has a therapeutic activity similar to that of cisplatin and relatively low nephrotoxicity and emetogenicity (vomiting). Production processes for oxaliplatin is well known in the art (e.g., JP-A-9-40685; U.S. Pat. Nos. 4,169,846, 5,338,874; 5,959,133; 5,298,642; and 5,290,961 (the disclosures of which are hereby incorporated in their entirety). Oxaliplatin is further described in Chaney S G et al. “Recognition and processing of cisplatin-and oxaliplatin-DNA adducts.” Crit Rev Oncol Hematol. (2005) 53: 3-11 (herein incorporated by reference in its entirety).
  • In certain embodiments, the oxaliplatin concentration encapsulated within the liposome is about 1 mg/ml, for example about 0.8 mg/ml.
  • Generally, the liposome composition of the present invention contains from about 1 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 1 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid. For example, from about 10 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from 10 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid.
  • In certain embodiments, the compositions contain from about 1 to about 45 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 40 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 35 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 30 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 25 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 20 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 15 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 10 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 5 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 45 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 35 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 25 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 20 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 15 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, from about 5 to about 10 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 1 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 2 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 4 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 5 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 10 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 15 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 20 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 30 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, about 40 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid, or about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid.
  • In certain embodiments, the compositions contain from about 1 to about 145 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 120 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 115 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 100 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 90 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 70 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 60 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 50 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 1 to about 25 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 140 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 125 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 100 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 80 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 50 μg TF/mg lipid, from about 10 to about 25 μg TF/mg lipid, about 1 μg TF/mg lipid, about 5 μg TF/mg lipid, about 10 μg TF/mg lipid, about 25 μg TF/mg lipid, about 40 μg TF/mg lipid, about 50 μg TF/mg lipid, about 70 μg TF/mg lipid, about 100 μg TF/mg lipid, about 120 μg TF/mg lipid, about 140 μg TF/mg lipid, or about 150 μg TF/mg lipid.
  • In some embodiments, from about 0.5 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 1 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid. In some embodiments, from about 5 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 10 to about 100 μg/mg. In certain embodiments, from about 2 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 3 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 4 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 2 to about 40 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 3 to about 40 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 4 to about 40 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 2 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 10 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 3 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 10 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 4 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 10 to about 150 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 5 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 100 μg TF/mg lipid; from about 5 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 100 μg TF/mg lipid; or from about 0.5 to about 50 μg oxaliplatin/mg lipid and from about 5 to about 100 μg TF/mg lipid.
  • In certain embodiments, the oxaliplatin concentration in the liposome formulation is 0.8+/−10% mg/ml.
  • In certain embodiments, where the drug is oxaliplatin, the oxaliplatin may be dissolved in a solution (e.g., an aqueous solution). In some embodiments, the solution includes a sugar (e.g., trehalose, maltose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, mannitol, glycerol, dextrose, fructose, etc.) The concentration of the sugar may be of several percent. For example sugar concentrations (v/v) of about 0.1-12%; 0.5-12%, 1%-12%, 2%-8%, 2%-6%, 2%-5%, 2%-4%, 2%-5%, 2%-6%, 2%-8%, 2%-9%, 2%-10%, 4%-10%, 4%-9%, 4%-8%, 4%-6%, 3%-4%, about 2%, about 3%, about 4%, about 5%, about 6%, about 7%, about 8%, about 9% or about 10%. In certain embodiments the solution includes a sugar and is aqueous. It is intended that the solution in which oxaliplatin is dissolved can also contain additional components, including those known to the skilled artisan.
  • In certain embodiments, the sugar concentration is about 5%, about 7%, about 8%, about 9% or about 10%. In other embodiments, the sugar concentration is about 5% to about 10%. In some embodiments, the sugar is dextrose and the concentration of dextrose in the oxaliplatin solution is about 5%. In some embodiments, the sugar is dextrose and the concentration of dextrose in the oxaliplatin solution is about 9%. In certain embodiments, the sugar is sucrose and the concentration of sucrose in the oxaliplatin solution is about 9%. In certain embodiments, the sugar is sucrose and the concentration of sucrose in the oxaliplatin solution is about 10%.
  • In some embodiments, the concentration of sugar in solution may be, for example about 50 mg/ml to about 150 mg/ml, about 50 mg/ml to about 130 mg/ml, about 50 mg/ml to about 120 mg/ml, about 50 mg/ml to about 100 mg/ml, about 80 mg/ml to about 100 mg/ml, about 90 mg/ml to about 150 mg/ml, about 90 mg/ml to about 130 mg/ml, about 60 mg/ml, about 80 mg/ml, about 90 mg/ml, about 100 mg/ml, about 110 mg/ml, about 105 mg/ml, about 120 mg/ml, or about 140 mg/ml.
  • The solution may also contain other ingredients known to those of skill in the art, such as, but not limited to, salts, buffers, sugar alcohol, etc. In certain embodiments, the solution in which oxaliplatin is dissolved contains sodium phosphate (e.g., monobasic and/or dibasic sodium phosphate).
  • In certain embodiments, the concentration of sodium phosphate may be about 5 to about 15 mM. For example, from about 5 to about 12 mM, from about 5 to about 10 mM, from about 5 to about 7 mM, from about 7 to about 12 mM, from about 7 to about 15 mM, from about 9 to about 12 mM, about 5 mM, about 7 mM, about 10 mM, about 12 mM or about 15 mM.
  • In certain embodiments, the sugar solution may additionally include about 1.0 to about 1.5 mg/ml sodium phosphate. For example, about 1.2 to about 1.5 mg/ml, 1.0 to about 1.7 mg/ml, 1.0 to about 2 mg/ml, 1.0 to about 2.5 mg/ml, 1.0 to about 3 mg/ml, 0.5 to about 3.5 mg/ml sodium phosphate.
  • In some embodiments, the solution pH will be about 6.5 to about 7.5, be about 6.7 to about 7.5, be about 7 to about 7.5, about 7, about 7.5, about 6.8, or about 6.5.
  • In some embodiments, the drug is oxaliplatin, and is contained in a solution of about 9% sucrose. In some embodiments, the drug is oxaliplatin, and is contained in a solution of about 9% sucrose in an oxaliplatin concentration of about 1 mg/ml. In some embodiments, the drug is oxaliplatin, and is contained in a solution of about 105 mg/ml sucrose. In some embodiments, the drug is oxaliplatin, and is contained in a solution of about 105 mg/ml sucrose in an oxaliplatin concentration in liposome solution of about 1 mg/ml. In certain of these embodiments, the solution further contains sodium phosphate. In certain embodiments, oxaliplatin is in a concentration of about 0.8+/−10% mg/ml of liposome solution.
  • Labeled Compounds
  • A variety of labeled compounds may also be included in the lipid-containing compositions of the present invention. Generally, the labeled compound may be an agent useful in carrying out in vivo diagnostic procedures.
  • As with the incorporation and use of drugs as described herein, the amount of labeled compound to be included in the lipid-containing compositions, and formulations thereof, as described herein can be readily determined by the skilled artisan in view of the teaching herein provided and depending on the labeled compound selected and the use intended for the composition or formulation, taking into account factors specific to both the labeled compound and the individual to be diagnosed, as described further herein.
  • Exemplary labeled compounds include, for example, materials comprising radioisotopes (e.g., 3H, 14C, 67Ga, 111In, 125I, 131I, 133Xe, etc.), material comprising fluorescent moieties (e.g., fluorescein, fluorescein isothiocyanate, etc.), material comprising enzyme (e.g., peroxidase, alkaline phosohatase, etc.), as well as additional labeled compounds known to those of skill in the art.
  • As will be appreciated by the skilled artisan, the selection of the labeled compound and methods used in diagnosis will depend upon the organ (e.g., liver, pancreas, prostate, etc.), tissue (e.g., malignant or non-malignant or tissue type (e.g., breast, etc.)) to be investigated. For example, lipid-containing compositions (e.g., targeted liposomes, liposome-containing compositions, etc.) incorporating 125I are particularly useful for identifying the presence and determining the severity (e.g., initially, during a course of treatment, after treatment) of various cancers (e.g., breast cancer, gastric cancer, colorectal cancer, colon cancer, etc.) by gamma-counter.
  • Targeting Factors
  • Unless otherwise noted, the terms “targeting factor” and “targeting ligand” may be used interchangeably herein.
  • The lipid-containing compositions described herein are characterized by incorporating an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine modified with a targeting factor (i.e., TF-NωPE) directed to a particular target cell. The term “targeting factor” refers to a moiety that can bind to a receptor or a surface antigen present on the surface of a target cell. In certain embodiments, the targeting factors are directed to cell surface receptors on a particular target cell. The targeting factor is often a protein or a peptide that can be attached to a lipid component of the lipid-containing composition.
  • Most effectively, targeting factors are selected such that the targeted receptor or antigen is present only on cells that are targeted for the delivery of the drug or labeled compound (e.g., pathogenic cells) and not present on healthy cells. Alternatively, a greater number of receptors or antigens are expressed on the target cells (e.g., pathogenic or diseased cells) compared to non-targeted (e.g., healthy) cells. Preferably, the receptor or antigen that binds the targeting factor is either not present or present in low numbers on healthy cells such that binding with the targeting factor does not occur with frequency. In other words, targeting factors need to selectively deliver the liposomes as described herein (including encapsulated drug) to the targeted cells (e.g., pathogenic, unhealthy, etc.). Selective delivery of the encapsulated drug to the targeted cells thus reduces the occurrence of adverse effects due to the effect of encapsulated drug or labeled compound on non-targeted (e.g., healthy) cells, thereby also reducing the adverse effects experienced by the individual to whom the composition, or formulation thereof, is administered.
  • Exemplary targeting factors include, but are not limited to, transferrin, folic acid, folate, hyaluronic acid, sugar chains (e.g., galactose, mannose, etc.), fragments of monoclonal antibodies, asialoglycoprotein, etc., as well as other targeting factors known to the skilled artisan.
  • In particular embodiments, the targeting factor is a protein or peptide directed to a cell surface receptor (e.g., transferrin, folate, folic acid, asialoglycoprotein, etc.).
  • In other embodiments, the targeting factor is directed to an antigen (e.g., fragments of monoclonal antibodies (e.g., Fab, Fab′, F(ab′)2, Fc, etc.)). It is not intended that targeting factors include intact or whole monoclonal antibodies. The term “whole antibody” or “intact antibody,” and cognates thereof, as used herein generally refer to antibody IgG of immune globulin. A fragment of a monoclonal antibody generally refers to a decomposition product of the monoclonal antibody, for example, a fragment obtained by using protease digestion, such as pepsin, etc.
  • In certain embodiments, the targeting factor is not directed to an antigen (e.g., is not a fragment of a monoclonal antibody, e.g., Fab, Fab′, F(ab′)2, Fc, etc).
  • In a certain embodiments, the targeting factor is transferrin.
  • Transferrin (Tf) is an iron binding protein with a molecular weight of 80,000, which is synthesized in hepatocytes and found in the blood. Transferrin supplies iron (Fe) to the cells through Tf receptors on the surface of each cell. The transferrin receptor is generally expressed in tumor tissues in a larger amount compared with normal tissues regardless of the types of the tumors. Tumor cell membranes are known to over-express transferrin receptors to maintain cell proliferation. See Shindelman J E, Ortmeyer A E, Sussman H H. “Demonstration of the transferrin receptor in human breast cancer tissue. Potential marker for identifying dividing cells.” Int J Cancer. (1981) 27(3):329-34; Lloyd J M, O'Dowd T, Driver M, Tee D E. “Demonstration of an epitope of the transferrin receptor in human cervical epithelium—a potentially useful cell marker.” J Clin Pathol. (1984) 37(2):131-5; and Habeshaw J A, Lister T A, Stansfeld A G, Greaves M F. “Correlation of transferrin receptor expression with histological class and outcome in non-Hodgkin lymphoma.” Lancet. (1983) 1(8323): 498-501. Binding of the therapeutic agents to transferrin will therefore enhance the uptake of the drug into tumor cells through the transferrin receptor. While not being limited to a mechanism of action, the likely route of uptake of transferrin liposomes as described herein is represented schematically in FIGS. 2 and 3. Transferrin is commercially available, or can be produced recombinantly as described in, for example, U.S. Pat. No. 5,026,651, which is hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • While not being bound by theory, it is believed that the conjugation of transferrin (Tf) to the MADE occurs by the reaction of a primary amine with the NωPE which results in the formation of a carboxylic acid amide bond between the lipid anchor and the protein.
  • In certain embodiments, the molar ratio of Tf to total lipid present in the targeted liposome product is approximately 0.00014:1 mol/mol (Tf:total lipid) (0.015, wt/wt). In other embodiments, the molar ratio of Tf:total lipid is from about 0.016 to about 0.029:about 126 about 158 mM/mM.
  • Lipid-Containing Compositions
  • The lipid-containing compositions described herein include targeted liposomes incorporating derivatized lipids, additional lipids and encapsulated drug or labeled compound, as well as the intermediates used to prepare the targeted liposomes, including lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions, as described herein, where the lipid-containing compositions (including targeted liposomes) are free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as, but not limited to, polyethylene glycol. The lipid-containing compositions also include liposomes which incorporate a TF, but do not include a drug or labeled compound (e.g., blank liposomes).
  • As used herein, the term “hydrophilic polymer” and cognates thereof, refers to polymers such as polyethylene glycol (PEG) and other polyethoxylated polymers that are used in the liposome field to shield liposomes in an attempt to enhance the circulatory half-life of the liposome. It is intended that this term encompasses free hydrophilic polymers associated non-covalently with the liposomes as well as hydrophilic polymers that are in some way conjugated or covalently linked to a particular component of the liposome (e.g. PEG-modified lipids, etc.). Such hydrophilic polymers are also alternatively referred to in the field as “water-soluble” polymers. Additional exemplary hydrophilic polymers include, but are not limited to, polyvinyl alcohol, polylactic acid, polyglycolic acid, polyvinylpyrrolidone, polyacrylamide, polyglycerol, polyaxozlines, etc.
  • As used herein, the term “lipid mixture,” and cognates thereof, refer to mixtures of lipid components as described herein, where the lipid mixture does not incorporate solution, for example, aqueous solution (e.g., water, buffer or a mixture of water and a water-miscible solvent (e.g., sugar (e.g., trehalose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, dextrose, fructose, etc.), sugar alcohol (e.g., sorbitol, maltitol, lactitol, glycerol, mannitol, etc), alcohol (e.g., ethanol, t-butanol, etc.), etc.)) or organic solvent.
  • The term “liposome-containing composition,” and cognates thereof, refers to mixtures of lipids and, optionally, drug(s) or labeled compound(s), in which aqueous solution (e.g., water, buffer (e.g., acetate buffer, phosphate buffer, citrate buffer, borate buffer, tartrate buffer, etc.) or mixture of water and a water-miscible solvent) has been incorporated by mixing (e.g., one or more of, stirring, shaking, etc.). The aqueous solution may also include additional components such as one or more sugars (e.g., trehalose, maltose, sucrose, lactose, mannose, dextrose, fructose, etc.), sugar alcohol (e.g., sorbitol, maltitol, lactitol, mannitol, glycerol, etc.), alcohol (e.g., ethanol, t-butanol, etc.), etc. And the aqueous solution may also include organic solvent ((e.g., esters (e.g., ethyl acetate, butyl acetate, etc.), aliphatic hydrocarbons (e.g., hexane, heptane, etc.), aromatic hydrocarbons (e.g., toluene, xylene, etc.), halogenated hydrocarbons (e.g., chloroform, dichloromethane, dichloroethane, etc.), ethers (e.g., THF, dioxane, diethyl ether, isopropyl ether, etc.), cyclic hydrocarbons (e.g., cyclohexane, etc.), DMF, DMSO, etc.) or mixtures thereof). The liposome-containing composition will generally contain a non-homogenous mixture of lipids, aqueous solution, and liposomes having a broad distribution around 100-10,000 nm and a mean diameter of 500-2,000 nm. Characterization of exemplary liposome-containing compositions is further provided in the Examples.
  • In certain embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions do not incorporate hydrophilic polymers. In particular embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions do not incorporate PEG.
  • In some embodiments, the intermediate lipid mixtures include at least two different neutral lipids or one or more phospholipids, and an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the lipid components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the mixture is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. Optionally, an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition. In certain embodiments, the lipid mixture does not include a drug or labeled compound. In particular embodiments, the lipid-mixture may be treated to form a liposome-containing composition or a liposome formulation.
  • In some embodiments, the intermediate lipid mixtures include at least two different neutral lipids or one or more phospholipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid components and drug/labeled compound are described in greater detail herein and wherein the mixture is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. Optionally, an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition, for example, as where the drug or labeled compound is added as an aqueous solution of drug/labeled compound. In certain embodiments, the liposome-containing composition can be treated (e.g., by one or more of extrusion, size exclusion chromatography, etc. or methods known in the art) to form a liposome.
  • In some embodiments, the lipid mixtures include one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the lipid components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the mixture is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. The mixtures may also be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.). Optionally, an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • In some embodiments, the intermediate lipid mixtures include one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the lipid components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the mixture is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. The mixtures may also be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.). Optionally, an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition. In some embodiments, the lipid mixture does not include a drug or labeled compound. The lipid mixture may be treated to form a liposome-containing composition or a liposome formulation.
  • In some embodiments, the intermediate lipid mixtures include one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid and drug/labeled compound components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the composition is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. The mixtures may also be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.). Optionally, an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • In certain embodiments, the intermediate lipid-containing compositions include a liposome containing one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug, wherein the lipid and drug components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. The liposomes may also be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.). In some embodiments, the lipid mixture does not include a drug or labeled compound. The lipid mixture may be treated to form a liposome-containing composition or a liposome formulation.
  • In certain embodiments, the lipid mixtures include one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting-factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid, targeting factor and drug/labeled compound components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. In some embodiments of the lipid mixtures, the liposomes are substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct or decomposition products associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.). In particular embodiments, the lipid mixture is a liposome-containing composition (e.g., where drug or labeled compound is added as an aqueous solution). Optionally, an aqueous solution as herein described may be mixed with the lipid components to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • In certain embodiments, the targeted liposomes include liposomes containing one or more phospholipids or at least two different neutral lipids, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and a targeting-factor modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid, targeting factor and drug or labeled compound components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. In some embodiments of the targeted liposomes, the liposomes are substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct or decomposition products associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.). However, in some embodiments, the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine may be present in the initial stages in the preparation of the targeted liposomes (e.g., NHS-NG-PEs (e.g., NHS-NG-DOPE, NHS-NG-DSPE, etc.), for example, prior to hydrolysis of the succinimidyl ester which may yield, for example NHS and NG-DOPE in the final formulation. In certain embodiments, where SuccNωPE is not incorporated into the interior of the liposome, the liposome or liposome-containing composition can also be free or substantially free of NHS, as in when TF-NωPE is pre-formed and used as starting material. In particular embodiments, the targeted liposomes are substantially free of DCC and EDC. In certain embodiments, the targeted liposomes are substantially free of DCC.
  • Additionally, each of the liposome-containing compositions as described herein can be treated to produce liposomes. The production of liposomes is well known in the art and, additionally, can be accomplished according to the methods described herein, for examples as described for production methods A and B, described in greater detail below. Production methods for liposomes from liposome-containing compositions include, but are not limited to, extrusion, sonication, reverse phase vesicle, freeze-thaw, size exclusion chromatography, ultrafiltration, etc. and combinations thereof. The liposomes formed from the liposome-containing compositions herein described may incorporate drug or labeled compound or may be free of drug or labeled compound (e.g., for liposomes also referred to herein also as “blank liposomes”). In particular embodiments, the liposome-containing compositions, liposomes (including blank liposomes) and targeted liposomes maybe formulated as pharmaceutical formulations and, additionally, may be used in the methods of treatment or diagnosis and/or kits described herein.
  • The term “substantially free” refers to levels of materials that are undetectable or minimally detectable by routine analytical methods used in the field. For example, HPLC (see e.g., European Phmaracopoeia 5th Ed.), TLC, gas chromatography, etc., as well as other analytical methods known to the skilled artisan.
  • For example, the lipid-containing compositions may contain less than about 0.1%, less than about 0.5%, less than about 1%, less than about 2%, less than about 3%, less than about 4%, less than about 5%, or less than about 6% by weight of a particular starting material, byproduct or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine to the total lipid content. In particular embodiments, the compositions will contain less than about 10%, less than about 7%, less than about 5%, less than about 3%, less than about 2%, or less than about 1% total impurities (e.g., % sum of starting material, byproduct and decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine).
  • In some embodiments, the targeted liposomes include liposomes containing a phosphatidylcholine (e.g., neutral, anionic or cationic), cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and an encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid, targeting factor and drug components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is a neutral phosphatidyl choline.
  • In particular embodiments, the targeted liposomes include liposomes containing a phosphatidyl choline (e.g., neutral, anionic or cationic), cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and encapsulated drug or labeled compound, wherein the lipid components and drug or labeled compound are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is a neutral phosphatidyl choline.
  • In particular embodiments, the targeted liposomes include liposomes containing a phosphatidyl choline (e.g., neutral, anionic or cationic), cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and encapsulated oxaliplatin, wherein the lipid components are described in greater detail herein and wherein the liposome is free of non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and hydrophilic polymers, such as polyethylene glycol. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is a neutral phosphatidyl choline.
  • In certain embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions (including targeted liposomes and blank liposomes), and formulations thereof, described herein may further contain lipids obtained by derivatizing phosphatidylglycerol, sphingosine, ceramide, a cholesterol derivative or the like with a dicarboxylic acid. These dicarboxylic acid-derivatives may be prepared as described herein for the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines and according to preparation methods known to the skilled artisan.
  • In some embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions (including targeted liposomes and blank liposomes), and formulations thereof, described herein do not include anionic lipids (e.g., phosphatidylserines, phosphatidylinsitosols, phosphatidylglycerols, etc.) or cationic lipids (e.g., sphingosine, DOTAP, DOTMA, DC-CHOL, etc.). In particular embodiments, the compositions are free of anionic lipids. In other embodiments, the compositions are free of cationic lipids. In certain embodiments, the compositions are free of cationic and anionic lipids.
  • In some embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions, the composition comprises a drug. In other embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions comprise a labeled compound.
  • In certain embodiments of the lipid-containing compositions, the drug is oxaliplatin, the targeting factor (TF) is transferrin (Tf) and the lipid components include: DMPC or DSPC, and, cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, and an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, and a transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, wherein the transferrin-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a transferrin linked to an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine by a carboxylic acid amide bond.
  • In some embodiments, the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine and targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine are NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • In particular embodiments, the lipid components of the lipid-containing compositions are DMPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE. In other embodiments, the lipid components are DSPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE. In still other embodiments, the lipid components are DMPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE. In certain other embodiments, the lipid components are DSPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE. In certain of these embodiments, the targeting factor (TF) is transferrin and the drug is oxaliplatin.
  • In particular embodiments, the lipid components are DPPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE. In other embodiments, the lipid components are POPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE. In still other embodiments, the lipid components are DPPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE. In certain other embodiments, the lipid components are POPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE. In certain of these embodiments, the targeting factor (TF) is transferrin and the drug is oxaliplatin.
  • In particular embodiments, the lipid components are HSPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE. In other embodiments, the lipid components are EPC, cholesterol, NG-DOPE and TF-modified NG-DOPE. In still other embodiments, the lipid components are HSPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE. In certain other embodiments, the lipid components are EPC, cholesterol, NG-DSPE, and TF-modified NG-DSPE. In certain of these embodiments, the targeting factor (TF) is transferrin and the drug is oxaliplatin.
  • Ratios of Lipid Components
  • Generally, the molar percent of starting materials NG-DOPE will be between about 2.5 mole % to about 4.5 mol %, compared to the total lipid content. Additionally, the molar percent of starting materials NHS-NG-DOPE will be between about 0.5 mole % to about 2.5 mol %, compared to the total lipid content. In some embodiments, the relative mole ratio of NG-DOPE to NHS-NG-DOPE will be about 3.4:1. In certain embodiments, the relative mole % ratio of NG-DOPE to NHS-NG-DOPE may be about 4:1. In particular embodiments, where a neutral phospholipid and a neutral lipid are present, the molar ratio of (e g., DMPC:Chol:NG-DOPE:NHS-NG-DOPE) may be 43.0:38.5:3.42:1, which can also be expressed as 50:45:4:1 by mol %.
  • In certain embodiments, the relative mol % of additional lipid(s) to NωPE to SuccNωPE (e.g., at least two neutral lipids:NωPE:SuccNωPE or one or more phospholipids:NωPE:SuccNωPE or (one or more phospholipids+neutral lipid(s)):NωPE:SuccNωPE) may be from about 98 mol % to about 87 mol % additional lipids: from about 1 mol % to about 12 mol % NωPE: about 0.5 mol % to about 1% SuccNωPE; where the total mol % of all components is 100 mol %. For example, additional lipids:NωPE:SuccNωPE may be approximately 95:4:1, 90:9:1, 92:7:1, 93:6:1, etc.
  • In particular embodiments, where the additional lipids include a phospholipid and another lipid such as cholesterol, cholesterol derivatives, etc., the range of mol % for each lipid component is from about 30 mol % to about 64%, where the total of additional lipids is from about 98 mol % to about 87 mol %.
  • In certain embodiments, where the additional lipids are two different neutral lipids, the range of mol % for each neutral lipid is from about 30 mol % to about 64%, where the total of neutral lipids is from about 98 mol % to about 87 mol %.
  • In an exemplary embodiment, where one additional lipid is a phosphatidyl choline and a second additional lipid is cholesterol or a cholesterol derivative, the mol % of the phosphatidyl choline is from about 30 to about 70 mol %, (e.g., from about 50 to about 64 mol %, from about 40 to about 65 mol %, from about 40 to about 60 mol %, from about 50 to about 62 mol %, from about 55 to about 60 mol %, from about 35 to about 55 mol %, about 30 mol %, about 40 mol %, about 45 mol %, about 50 mol %, about 55 mol %, about 60 mol %, about 65 mol %, about 70 mol %) and the mol % of the cholesterol or cholesterol derivative is from about 30 to about 60 mol % (e.g., from about 32 to about 45 mol %, from about 32 to about 42 mol %, from about 32 to about 40 mol %, from about 40 to about 60 mol %, from about 35 to about 55 mol %, from about 35 to about 60 mol %, from about 45 to about 60 mol %, from about 35 to about 45 mol %, about 30 mol %, about 35 mol %, about 40 mol %, about 45 mol %, about 50 mol %, about 55 mol % or about 60 mol %). In some embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is about 50 mol %, about 52 mol %, about 55 mol %, about 58 mol %, about 60 mol %, about 62 mol % and the cholesterol or cholesterol derivatives is from about 30 mol %, about 32 mol %, about 34 mol %, about 35 mol %, about 37 mol %, about 38 mol %, about 40 mol %, about 42 mol %, about 43 mol %, about 45 mol %.
  • In particular embodiments, the mol % of NωPE is about 1 to about 11 mol %, about 1 to about 10 mol %, about 1 to about 8 mol %, about 1 to about 6 mol %, about 1 to about 5 mol %, about 1 to about 4 mol %, about 1 to about 3 mol %, about 1 to about 2 mol %, about 2 to about 10 mol %, about 2 to about 5 mol %, about 1 mol %, about 2 mol %, about 3 mol %, about 4 mol %, about 5 mol %, about 7 mol %, about 8 mol %, about 9 mol % about 10 mol %, about 11 mol %, or about 12 mol %.
  • In certain embodiments, the relative mol % of the first additional lipid:second additional lipid:NωPE:SuccNωPE is, for example 50:45:4:1. In some embodiments, the first additional lipid is a phosphatidylcholine (e.g., DMPC, DOPC, DPPC, DSPC, etc.) and the second additional lipid is cholesterol. In some embodiments, the PE of the NωPE is DOPE or DSPE. In particular embodiments, the NωPE is NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE. In some embodiments, the lipids are DMPC:Chol:NG-DOPE:NHS-NG-DOPE and their relative mol % is 50:45:4:1. In other embodiments, the lipids are DSPC:Chol:NG-DSPE:NHS-NG-DSPE and their relative mol % is 50:45:4:1. In other embodiments, the lipids are DSPC:Chol:NG-DSPE:NHS-NG-DSPE and their relative mol % is 62:33:4:1.
  • In some embodiments, the total mol % of NωPE and TF-NωPE (NωPE+TF-NωPE) is about 2 to about 13 mol % of total lipid content. For example, about 2 to about 12 mol %, about 2 to about 10 mol %, about 2 to about 8 mol %, about 2 to about 6 mol %, about 2 to about 4 mol %, about 2 mol %, about 3 mol %, about 4 mol %, about 5 mol %, about 6 mol %, about 7 mol %, about 8 mol %, about 9 mol %, about 10 mol %, about 11 mol %, or about 12 mol %.
  • Generally, the total mol % of TF-NωPE is about 0.002 to about 0.2 mol % relative to total lipid content. For example, in some embodiments, the total mol % of TF-NωPE is about 0.002 to about 0.15 mol %, total mol % of TF-NωPE is about 0.002 to about 0.1 mol %, 0.002 to about 0.05 mol %, about 0.01 to about 0.03 mol %, about 0.005 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.007 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.007 to about 0.05 mol %, about 0.01 to about 0.025 mol %, about 0.015 to about 0.025 mol %, about 0.01 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.02 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.04 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.06 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.08 to about 0.2 mol %, about 0.002 mol %, about 0.008 mol %, about 0.01 mol %, about 0.02 mol %, about 0.03 mol %, about 0.025 mol %, about 0.015 mol %, about 0.06 mol %, about 0.08 mol %, about 0.1 mol %, about 0.15 mol %, or about 0.2 mol %.
  • Characterization of Liposomes and Liposome-Containing Compositions
  • In addition to characterizing the lipid-containing compositions by the ratios of components (e.g., ratios of lipids, ratio of drug/labeled compound to lipid, etc.), the liposome-containing compositions as described herein may also be characterized (e.g., physicochemical properties, etc.) using standard analytical methods, as will be appreciated by the skilled artisan. Such analytical methods include, but are not limited to and where appropriate, determination of mean diameter, encapsulated volume, net charge (zeta potential), amount of entrapped (i.e., encapsulated) drug, particle size, stability under various conditions (e.g., in storage, as prepared for administration, in vitro), osmotic properties, amount of conjugated targeting factor, etc. Exemplary analytical methods for such characterization are set forth below, as well as in the Examples, and additional methods known to the skilled artisan may also be used to characterize the compositions.
  • As will be appreciated by the skilled artisan, the drug content of liposomes can be determined using established methods for HPLC analysis, with appropriate controls, as routinely practiced in the art and, additionally, as described in the Examples. Using appropriate controls, the identity of the encapsulated drug can also be determined by HPLC or, for certain drugs (e.g., platinum containing drugs) by analytical methods such as ICP-MS (Inductively Coupled Plasma-Mass Spectrometry) as is practiced by those of skill in the field.
  • In certain embodiments, the amount of drug (e.g., oxaliplatin, etc.) or labeled compound encapsulated within the liposome or liposome-containing composition may be from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 15 mg/ml within the liposome. For example, the drug concentration may be from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 15 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml to about 10 mg/ml, about 0.1 mg/ml to about 10 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml to about 5 mg/ml; about 0.5 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml to about 2 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml to about 1.5 mg/ml, about 0.8 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml, about 0.8 mg/ml to about 2 mg/ml, about 0.8 mg/ml to about 1.5 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 3 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 2 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 1.7 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 1.5 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 1.4 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml to about 1.3 mg/ml, about 0.5 mg/ml, about 0.7 mg/ml, about 0.8 mg/ml, about 0.9 mg/ml, about 1 mg/ml, about 1.1 mg/ml, about 1.2 mg/ml, about 1.3 mg/ml, about 1.4 mg/ml, about 1.5 mg/ml, about 1.6 mg/ml, about 2 mg/ml, about 3 mg/ml, about 4 mg/ml, about 5 mg/ml, about 6 mg/ml, about 7 mg/ml, about 8 mg/ml, about 9 mg/ml, about 10 mg/ml or about 15 mg/ml within the liposome.
  • The electric potential at the shear plane is called the zeta potential of a liposome. As is known the skilled artisan, the zeta potential of liposomes can be experimentally determined using appropriate instrumentation, for example as measured by an ELS-6000 (Otsuka Electronics, Japan) with the laser-Doppler microelectrophoresis method or other instrumentation and protocols available to the skilled artisan. For example, J. Colloid and Interface Sci., 39, 670-675(1972), nition.com/en/products/zeecom_s.htm, etc.
  • In certain embodiments, the liposomes (including the targeted liposomes and the liposomes of the liposome-containing composition) as described herein will exhibit an overall net negative zeta potential. In some embodiments, the zeta potential is from about −10 mV to about −200 mV. For example, from about −50 mV to about −150 mV, from about −50 mV to about −130 mV, from about −60 to about −120 mV, from about −50 to about −100 mV, from about −75 mV to about −90 mV, from about −80 mV to about −90 mV, from about −80 mV to about −85 mV, from about −85 mV to about −90 mV, from about −75 mV to about −85 mV, from about −70 mV to about −90 mV, about −75 mV, about −80 mV, about −85 mV, about −83 mV, about −90 mV, about −100 mV, about −120 mV.
  • After the intravenous injection of small liposomes, they are thought to pass through the fenestrae of the liver sinusoids and will rapidly come into contact with hepatocytes. Liposomes of intermediate size are thought to be retained within the blood compartment and can circulate for a considerable length of time. However, large liposomes pass more slowly through the liver sinusoids, and are rapidly taken up by Kupffer cells. Thus the size of the liposome is very important to determine the behavior in vivo. See, for example, Liu et al., Biochim. Biophys. Acta (1992) 1104(1):95-101; Harashima et al., J. Drug Target. (1995) 3(4):253-261; (which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety) etc.
  • Liposome particle size can be obtained from the correlation function by using various algorithms using Photon Correlation Spectroscopy (PCS; Dynamic Light Scattering or Quasi-Elastic Light Scattering (QELS)). The particle size obtained by these techniques is comparable to the mean diameter determined by PCS. PCS uses standard deviation and χ2 to describe the size distribution. In PCS systems, χ2 determines whether the system is unimodal (Gaussian distribution) or multimodal (Nicomp distribution). The mean particle size can be determined using intensity weighted measurements and is reported from the Gaussian distribution if χ2≦5. If χ2>5, then the mean of the principal peak in a Nicomp distribution. Such analysis will be familiar to the skilled artisan, as will suitable hardware, for example Nicomp QELS Particle Sizer, PSS Model 380ZLS, S/N 0103301; pssnicomp.com/zetaspec.htm.
  • In certain embodiments of the liposomes, particularly the targeted liposomes, described herein the liposome mean diameter will be from about 50 to about 275 nm. For example, the liposome mean diameter may be from about 50 to about 200 nm, from about 50 to about 265 nm, from about 50 to about 250 nm, from about 50 to about 225 nm, from about 50 to about 175 nm, from about 50 to about 150 nm, from about 50 to about 120 nm, from about 50 to about 100 nm, from about 75 to about 250 nm, from about 75 to about 200 nm, from about 75 to about 175 nm, from about 75 to about 150 nm, from about 75 to about 120 nm, from about 75 to about 100 nm, from about 90 to about 100 nm, from about 90 to about 120 nm, from about 90 to about 150 nm, from about 90 to about 200 nm, from about 95 to about 100 nm, from about 95 to about 120 nm, from about 95 to about 125 nm, from about 95 to about 130 nm, from about 95 to about 150 nm, from about 95 to about 175 nm, about 90 nm, about 95 nm, about 100 nm, about 120 nm, about 130 nm, or about 150 nm. For a particular liposome composition, the targeted liposome will be approximately about 15 to about 25 nm greater in diameter than the a liposome formed of the same components but with the targeting factor not incorporated.
  • The liposomes (e.g., targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, liposomes in liposome-containing compositions) described herein can also be characterized by the concentration of targeting ligand that is incorporated into the liposome. Depending on the targeting ligand selected, various means of quantifying the amount of targeting ligand will be apparent to the skilled artisan. For example, as described in the examples, the transferrin (Tf) content of liposomes can be determined by use of electrophoretic migration (e.g., as measured by SDS-PAGE) the liposome compared to appropriate controls.
  • In brief, confirmation of transferrin content in liposomes can be evaluated using two assays for the content and/or identity of transferrin conjugated to liposomes. Firstly, the electrophoretic migration of transferrin the liposome as analyzed by SDS-PAGE can be compared to the migration pattern of purified conjugated transferrin, e.g., TF-NωPE. In addition, the electrophoretic migration of conjugated transferrin in can also be compared to free transferrin reference standard. Additional support for the identity of transferrin in liposomes can be obtained using ELISA, a research-grade formulation that demonstrates specific binding of anti-transferrin antibody to the targeted liposomes. The concentration of transferrin-targeted liposomes can be measured using colorimetric protein quantification assays, such as a BCA, an assay well known to the skilled artisan. The skilled artisan in view of the teachings herein will also appreciate similar methods and others known in the field for determining the amount of a variety of targeting factors.
  • Briefly, the amount of transferrin in a liposome can be analyzed using the bicinchoninic acid (BCA) assay reagent. Copper (II) is reduced to copper (I) by protein under alkaline conditions. The copper (I) ion generated forms a soluble, intensely colored complex with BCA. The total microparticle-bound protein is measured by the reaction of a known amount of microparticle suspension with the BCA reagents. Once color formation occurs, the microparticles are removed by filtration and the color is measured spectrophotometrically.
  • In some embodiments, the concentration of targeting ligand incorporated in the liposome will be from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 5.0 mg/ml, from about 0.5 mg/ml to about 2.0 mg/ml, from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.0 mg/ml, from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 3.0 mg/ml, from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.5 mg/ml, from about 1.0 mg/ml to about 2.0 mg/ml, or from about 1.3 mg/ml to about 2.5 mg/ml.
  • The role of ferric ion is very important in binding transferrin to the surface of tumor cells. Therefore, the ferric ion content of targeted liposomes incorporating Tf is another meaningful way of characterizing the liposomes. While a number of methods for determining ferric ion content will be known to those of skill in the art, one method is ICP-MS.
  • Where the a liposome contains transferrin, the ferric ion content of the liposome may be, for example, from about 0.25 μg/mL to about 3 μg/mL, 0.4 μg/mL to about 3 μg/mL, 0.25 μg/mL to about 2 μg/mL, 0.25 μg/mL to about 1.5 μg/mL, 0.25 μg/mL to about 1 μg/mL, 0.4 μg/mL to about 2 μg/mL, 0.4 μg/mL to about 1.5 μg/mL, 0.5 μg/mL to about 2 μg/mL, about 0.5 μg/mL to about 1.4 μg/mL, or about 0.5 μg/mL to about 1.5 μg/mL.
  • The liposomes, including targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, may also be characterized by their osmotic pressure at a given temperature. The osmotic pressure at a given temperature depends upon the molar concentration of sugar (sucrose) solution. And it also depends on the total ion density and the size of the molecules within the solution. Normally osmotic pressure can be measured using an instrument known as an osmometer, which measures osmotic pressure in suitable pressure units, as will be appreciated by the skilled artisan.
  • In certain embodiments the osmotic pressure of the liposomes, particularly the targeted liposomes and blank liposomes, at room temperature will be from about 310 to about 410 mOsm/kg. For example, the osmotic pressure may be from about from about 310 to about 400 mOsm/kg, from about 310 to about 380 mOsm/kg, from about 320 to about 360 mOsm/kg, from about 315 to about 375 mOsm/Kg, from about 320 to about 375 mOsm/Kg, from about 315 to about 370 mOsm/Kg, from about 320 to about 370 mOsm/Kg, about 360 mOsm/Kg, about 350 mOsm/Kg, about 340 mOsm/Kg, about 370 mOsm/Kg or about 380 mOsm/Kg at room temperature.
  • Under the various conditions described herein (e.g., conditions for storage, prepared for administration and/or in vitro conditions) the osmotic pressure may vary less than about 25%, less than about 20%, less than about 15% when monitored over a particular time period associated with the various conditions as described herein. For example, 360+/−50 mOsm/kg.
  • Production of Lipid-Containing Compositions
  • There are three main requirements for drugs and labeled compounds intended for administration to individuals in the course of therapy, namely, efficacy, safety, and assurance of quality. Despite proven efficacy and safety, the ability to use a drug in therapy is undermined if its quality (e.g., purity, homogeneity, reproducibility of dosage, stability over time, etc.) cannot be consistently guaranteed during manufacture and distribution. Methods of production of drugs or labeled compound that do not assure consistently high quality drug also increase the likelihood of adverse reactions in the individuals to whom the drug is administered. Throughout the lifetime of a drug or labeled compound, it is important that the product that is manufactured and distributed meet the same standards as the product that initially received regulatory approval. Thus, the ability to consistently produce drugs or labeled compounds of high quality is necessary for producing safe drug or labeled compound products and drugs or labeled compound that can be routinely and easily manufactured and purified are advantageous from both a commercial and a safety perspective. Where, for example, efficacy of a labeled compound refers to its ability to be useful in the diagnosis of a particular disease or conditions in conjunction with the particular diagnostic methods (e.g., the activity of the labeled compound (for example, ability to be visualized by gamma counter, etc.) is not impaired by an unacceptable level batch to batch or during storage.
  • Described below are general methods for the production of the compositions described herein that can be used to consistently produce high quality (e.g., of high purity, homogeneity, etc.) targeted liposomes (and intermediates thereof) and blank liposomes. These methods are also represented schematically in FIGS. 4 (production method A) and 5 (production method B).
  • The succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines and N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines as described herein are useful as components of phospholipid complexes such as liposomes, polymer micelles, micro- and nano-spheres, emulsions and water-soluble polymers. The preparation of these PE derivatives is described herein and methods for their production are also known in the art, as mentioned previously.
  • In particular, the succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines and N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines are also useful as components of the lipid-containing compositions as described herein. The lipid-containing compositions can be prepared according to the methods described herein, though modifications of these methods will also be apparent to the skilled artisan. For example, various methods known to the skilled artisan may be used in liposome formation from lipid components (e.g., sonication, stirring, extrusion, dehydration, etc.) As, for example, as described in U.S. Pat. App. Pub. No. 2004/0142025, the contents of which are hereby incorporated by reference in its entirety.
  • Use of the general methods described herein, including in the Examples, to produce the targeted liposomes also encompasses methods for the production of the other lipid-containing compositions (e.g., lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions, blank liposomes, and intermediate liposomes), as described herein.
  • Production Method A
  • Production method A is depicted schematically in FIG. 4.
  • A: Production of NωPE:SuccNωPE:Additional Lipid Mixture (Intermediate 1)
  • The succinimidyl esters of N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (SuccNωPE) and N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (NωPE) as described herein are mixed with additional lipid(s) ((e.g., at least one phospholipid(s) (e.g. PC (e.g., DMPC, DSPC, etc.), PI, sphingomyelin, phosphatidic acid, etc.) and at least one other additional lipid (e.g., cholesterol)), then dissolved in a suitable solvent (e.g., ethanol, t-BuOH, chloroform, isopropylether, etc.). The amount of the solvent is generally 1 to 100 v/w (vs. total lipid weight). In certain embodiments, this is 2 to 20 v/w.
  • The SuccNωPE and NωPE used as described in the preceding paragraph can be prepared and purified by methods described herein or by methods known to the skilled artisan. The SuccNωPE and NωPE, as well as other components described herein for the production of the targeted liposomes and intermediates thereof, should be of sufficient purity and homogeneity to ultimately yield targeted liposomes of sufficient purity and homogeneity to fall within regulatory guidelines for the administration of the targeted liposomes to individuals and in accordance with good laboratory practice (GLP) and good manufacturing practice (GMP) guidelines.
  • Where an additional lipid(s) (in additional to one or more phospholipids) is used in combination with the phospholipid, the ratio of phospholipid(s) to other additional lipid(s) is about 2:1. A mixing ratio of the SuccNωPE derivatives to the phospholipids is from about 1 to about 12% (1:99 to 12:88), or about 3-6% (3:97 to 6:94) of the total concentration/ratio of (NHS-NGPE+NGPE) to (CHOL+Phospholipid). For example, exemplary ratio include 50:45:4:1 (e.g., PC:Chol:NG-PE:NHS-NG-PE), where, for example 17.5 mg of NHS-NG-DOPE, 63.1 mg of NG-DOPE, 312 mg of Chol and 607 mg of phospholipids in 1 g of mixture.
  • B: Production of Drug:NωPE:SuccNωPE:Additional Lipid Mixture (Intermediate 2)
  • The NωPE:SuccNωPE:additional lipid mixture prepared in step A is then mixed with aqueous solution (e.g., buffer, etc.) containing the drug or labeled compound to be encapsulated (e.g., anticancer agent (e.g., oxaliplatin, topoisomerase I inhibitor, vinca alkaloid, etc.)) to obtain the drug:NωPE:SuccNωPE:neutral lipid mixture (Intermediate 2).
  • Where the drug is oxaliplatin (l-OHP), the concentration of the oxaliplatin solution is about 8 mg/ml in an approximately 9% sucrose solution. For example, the concentration of oxaliplatin in the targeted liposome is about 0.8 mg/mL+/−10%.
  • C: Production of Drug:NωPE:SuccNωPE:Additional Lipid Liposome (Intermediate 3)
  • The drug:NωPE:SuccNωPE:additional lipid mixture (Intermediate 2) obtained in step B is then sonicated or stirred followed by evaporation of the solvent to form the drug:NωPE:SuccNωPE:additional lipid liposome (Intermediate 3). Methods and conditions for performing sonication, stirring and evaporation and means for accomplishing these steps are well understood by the skilled artisan and are also further described in the Examples. See for example, methods of production by reverse phase vesicle (REV) methods, U.S. Pat. No. 4,235,871 (incorporated by reference in its entirety). General liposome production methods such as simple hydration methods and ethanol injection methods, known to the skilled artisan, can be also used.
  • The drug:NωPE:SuccNωPE:additional lipid liposome formed as described above is then extruded by size and the drug:NωPE:SuccNωPE:additional lipid liposome is isolated. Optionally, ultrafiltration can then be used to concentrate the liposome solution.
  • Where the liposome contains l-OHP (drug), DMPC (additional lipid/phospholipid (neutral)), cholesterol (CHOL, additional lipid/neutral lipid), N-glutaryl-DOPE (NG-DOPE) and NHS-NG-DOPE, a liposome with a mean diameter of about 0.2 micrometer (200 nm) can be isolated. Similarly sized liposomes can also be obtained for liposomes containing l-OHP (drug), DSPC (additional lipid/phospholipid (neutral), cholesterol, N-glutaryl-DSPE (NG-DSPE) and NHS-NG-DSPE. Exemplary target amounts of the lipid components are, for example, about 40 mg/mL DMPC (an additional lipid/phosphatidyl choline/phospholipid/neutral lipid), about 20 mg/mL CHOL (additional lipid/neutral lipid) and about 5 mg/mL NG-DOPE (combined amount of NG-PE and NHS-NG-PE). An exemplary ratio for the lipid components is 50:45:5 (additional lipid 1 (e.g. a phosphatidyl choline)):additional lipid 2 (e.g., CHOL):NG-PE (e.g., NG-DOPE+NHS-NG-DOPE).
  • D: Production of Drug:NωPE:TF-NωPE:Additional Lipid Liposome (Targeted Liposome)
  • The drug:NωPE:SuccNωPE:additional lipid liposome formed as described in step C can then be functionalized with the targeting factor of choice to produce the drug:NωPE:TF-NωPE:additional lipid liposome (also referred to as the “targeted liposome”).
  • Attachment of the targeting factor (TF) (e.g., functionalization of the intermediate liposome (Intermediate 3) with targeting factor) is accomplished by covalently binding the targeting factor to SuccNωPE by reaction of the succinimidyl moiety with the targeting factor. Through appropriate reaction conditions, succinimidyl groups on the exposed surface of the liposome (on the exterior of the lipid bilayer, where the drug or labeled compound is encapsulated in the interior of the liposome) can be covalently modified to form targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamines (TF-NωPE). Attachment of the targeting factor to the liposome results in the formation of the drug:NωPE:TF-NωPE:additional lipid liposome (targeted liposome).
  • More specifically, under appropriate conditions, the succinyl carboxyl moiety of the SuccNωPE as described herein is functionalized. If the targeting factor has an amino group(s), the amino group(s) on the targeting factor is reacted with the succinyl carboxyl moiety and forms carboxylic acid amide bond. Conditions appropriate for this reaction are further described herein, including in the Examples, and will also be well understood by the skilled artisan. The skilled artisan will also be able to modify the reaction conditions to optimize conditions for particular combinations of targeting factor and liposomes without undue experimentation given the teaching herein.
  • Various targeting factors as described herein and known to the skilled artisan can be obtained commercially or produced by methods known to the artisan of ordinary skill
  • When, for example, transferrin is selected as the targeting factor, transferrin is can be commercially obtained as purified protein, for example, from Celliance Corp., GA, USA. Transferrin can also be obtained using recombinant methods well understood in the art (e.g., by using prokaryotic cell (E. coli, etc.), by using eukaryotic cell (CHO, BHK, etc.), etc.). As is well understood, transferrin can be obtained and used in the targeted liposomes in either its apo or holo forms. Alternatively, targeted liposomes incorporating apo-transferrin can be treated with ferric compounds, such as ferric citrate, iron (III) chloride, etc., to produce targeted liposomes incorporating holo-transferrin derivatized liposome.
  • An exemplary amount of transferrin as targeting factor is, for example, about 2 mg/mL transferrin. Such an amount would be appropriate for an exemplary targeted liposome containing about 40 mg/mL DMPC, about 20 mg/mL CHOL and about 5 mg/mL NG-DOPE (combined amount of NG-PE and NHS-NG-PE).
  • Upon functionalization of the liposome (intermediate 3) with targeting factor as described above to obtain the targeted liposomes, the resulting liposomes can optionally be further purified using methods known to those of skill in the art, including those purification methods described herein, particularly those described in connection with step C, above.
  • Where the liposome contains l-OHP (drug), DMPC, cholesterol (CHOL), N-glutaryl-DOPE (NG-DOPE) and Tf-NG-DOPE, a liposome with a mean diameter of about 0.05 micrometer to about 0.2 micrometer (about 50 nm to about 200 nm) can be isolated. Similarly sized liposomes can also be obtained for liposomes containing l-OHP (drug), DSPC, cholesterol, N-glutaryl-DSPE (NG-DSPE) and NHS-NG-DSPE.
  • Production of the targeted liposomes by the above-described method (referred to for convenience as production method A) reproducibly produces targeted liposomes of high purity and homogeneity. In particular, the targeted liposomes are substantially free of the non-NHS starting materials (described herein) and by-products (e.g., acylated urea compounds, etc.) associated with the generation of SuccNωPEs. In particular, preparation and purification of Succ NωPEs prior to liposome formation yields liposomes (intermediate 3) and targeted liposomes substantially free of carbodiimide starting materials (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.) used to functionalize NωPEs to form SuccNωPEs. As mentioned previously, drugs and labeled compounds, including targeted liposomes incorporating drugs or labeled compounds, which are intended for administration to individuals in the course of therapy or diagnosis, must necessarily be of high quality.
  • Optionally, the lipid mixtures described in A (intermediate 1) can be treated with targeting factor to form a lipid mixture containing TF-NωPE. Further, this lipid mixture may be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition. Finally, the liposome-containing composition may be treated to produce a liposome formulation. Optionally, the aqueous solution may include a drug or labeled compound.
  • Alternative Production Method (Method B)
  • Production method B is depicted schematically in FIG. 5.
  • A. Production of Drug: NωPE:Additional Lipids Liposome
  • The targeted liposomes as described herein can also be produced by dissolving the additional lipids and NωPE in a suitable solvent (e.g., ethanol, t-BuOH, chloroform, isopropylether, etc.), dispersing the resultant solution in an aqueous solution optionally containing a drug or labeled compound, and then performing ultrasonication or reverse phase vesicle of the resultant dispersion to form a liposome (drug:NωPE:neutral lipids). The liposome solution may be concentrated by ultrafiltration.
  • As a non-limiting example, the liposomes can be produced by reverse phase vesicle (REV) method (U.S. Pat. No. 4,235,871, incorporated by reference). Of course, general liposome composition methods such as simple hydration methods and ethanol injection methods can be also used.
  • In order to stably retain the NωPE(s) in the lipid bilayer, the NωPE(s) can be prepared and purified, and then NωPE(s), together with the additional lipids (e.g., phospholipid(s), cholesterol, etc.) are used to prepare the liposome according to methods known to the skilled artisan.
  • As a non-limiting example, additional lipids (e.g., one or more phospholipid (e.g., DSPC, DMPC, etc.), and, optionally, another additional lipid (e.g., cholesterol, etc.) and at least one NωPE are mixed together and dissolved in a suitable organic solvent.
  • Where the additional lipids are a phospholipid and cholesterol, the mixing ratio of the phospholipid and the cholesterol may be, for example, about 1:1, for example, about 1.1:1, about 1.2:1, about 0.9:1 (e.g., DMPC and cholesterol, 50:45 (mol %). The content of the NωPE(s) as a proportion of total lipid content is, for example, 6% relative to the phospholipid. Then, the resultant solution is mixed with a solution of oxaliplatin in an aqueous buffer. The NωPE can be about 0.8 mol % to about 12 mol % to total lipid content. For example, from about 1 mol % to about 10 mol %, about 1 mol % to about 8 mol %, about 1 mol % to about 6 mol %, about 1 mol % to about 5 mol %, about 1 mol % to about 4 mol %, about 1 mol % to about 3 mol %, about 1 mol % to about 2 mol %, about 2 mol % to about 12 mol %, about 2 mol % to about 10 mol %, about 3 mol % to about 8 mol %, about 1 mol %, about 2 mol %, about 3 mol %, about 4 mol %, about 5 mol %, about 6 mol %, about 8 mol %, about 10 mol %, or about 12 mol %.
  • The concentration of drug or labeled compound in solution can be as described herein, and, in particular as above for production method A. Similarly, the solution containing the drug or labeled compound includes the solution components as described herein.
  • Liposomes incorporating l-OHP (drug), DSPC, cholesterol and N-glutaryl-DSPE (NG-DOPE) prepared by this method can be isolated to provide an oxaliplatin-containing liposome (e.g., by gel-filtration, by size exclusion chromatography, by ultrafiltration, by ultracentrifugation, etc.) having a mean diameter of about 0.2 μm.
  • B. Production of Drug: SuccNωPE:NωPE:Additional Lipids Liposome
  • Following step A, a portion of the NωPE present in the liposome prepared in step A (drug:NωPE:additional lipids liposome) is functionalized to yield a liposome incorporating SuccNωPE (i.e., drug: SuccNωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposome), which can later be modified to form TF-NωPE.
  • In order to form SuccNωPE, the carboxyl group at a terminus of the NωPE is modified to form a succinimidyl group. Such functionalization can be accomplished using the methods described for the production of SuccNωPE(s).
  • For example, a carbodiimmide (e.g., EDC, DCC, etc.) and N-hydroxysulfosuccinimide (NHS) are reacted in the presence of the liposome to yield drug:SuccNωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposome.
  • C. Production of Drug: TF-NωPE:NωPE:Additional Lipids Liposome
  • After step B, the drug: SuccNωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposome prepared in step B is reacted with targeting factor to form drug: TF-NωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposome. The methods and conditions for the reaction are as described for production method A, step D.
  • The drug: TF-NωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposomes obtained by production method B can be purified and concentrated using methods as described herein and known to the skilled artisan.
  • Comparison of Production Methods
  • Production method A has several advantages over production method B, though both can be used to obtain drug:TF-NωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposomes (targeted liposomes, optionally containing either drug or labeled compound). Most notably, the liposomes obtained by method A will be free or substantially free of impurities (e.g., non-NHS starting materials and/or by-products) related to the production of the SuccNωPEs. In particular, as noted previously, targeted liposomes prepared by production method A will be free, or substantially free, of e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., EDC, DCC, etc.), and acylated ureas. In certain embodiments, where SuccNωPE is not incorporated into the interior of the liposome, the liposome or liposome-containing composition can also be free or substantially free of NHS. Additionally, the larger a scale of reaction, the more a preparation time. The time for production method A is substantially shorter than production method B.
  • While purification of the drug: TF-NωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposomes prepared by production method B will reduce the amount of such impurities, it is more difficult to purify liposomes (e.g., the drug: SuccNωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposomes obtained in step B of production method B) than lipids (e.g., SuccNωPEs prepared and purified prior to step A of production method A). As some of the SuccNωPE is likely oriented to the interior of the liposomes (e.g., the succinimidyl ester functionality is on the interior of the lipid bilayer and inaccessible to reaction with targeting factor), it is likely that targeted liposomes prepared by production method A might have some residual SuccNωPE incorporated therein.
  • An additional advantage of production method A is that the relative content of TF-NωPE vs. NωPE in the final drug: TF-NωPE:NωPE:additional lipids liposomes can be controlled more accurately when production method A is used. The relative amounts of these lipids are directly related to the relative amounts of the SuccNωPE and NωPE used as starting materials in step A of production method A. Thus, the amount of TF-modified SuccNωPE can also be controlled more accurately.
  • When production method B is used, the relative amounts of NωPE vs. SuccNωPE are dependent upon the reaction efficiency of method B step B. This reaction is believed to go to completion for about approximately 10% of the NωPE present in the liposome, but experimental variation would be expected from batch to batch. The low reaction efficiency is likely due, in part, to the steric hindrance of the pre-formed liposome. When SuccNωPE is formed from isolated NωPE (lipid only), there is far less steric hindrance and the reaction goes farther to completion. Also, subsequent to formation of the SuccNωPE (in lipid only form), the resultant product can be purified from the reaction mixture, thus removing unreacted NωPE, carbodiimmide and NHS, as well as other by-products that may form during the reaction.
  • The liposomes formed by either method appear to be more homogeneous (and therefore can be used to produce a more reproducible drug/diagnostic product) than liposomes that incorporate PEG or other hydrophilic polymers, such as those described in the Background section of the present specification. In general, when PEG or other hydrophilic polymers are used to increase the circulation time of liposomes (e.g., to shield the liposomes from uptake by the RES), their use results in liposomes with a distribution of molecular size-due to the broad distribution of the PEG or hydrophilic polymers themselves. This distribution increases the difficulties associated with manufacture (e.g., reproducibility and/or purification) and may also increase the variability in clinical efficacy. Targeted liposomes prepared by either method A or B should be superior in these respects.
  • Additional Production Methods
  • Lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions (which may be used to prepare liposomes) may also be prepared by modification of production methods A and B. For example, in some embodiments, lipid mixtures and liposome-containing compositions incorporating additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE or additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE:drug/labeled compound (where “additional lipid component(s)” refers to one or more phospholipids (e.g., one or more neutral, one or more anionic, one or more cationic phospholipids or combinations of two or more of the foregoing), optionally additionally comprising one or more additional lipids as described herein (e.g., cholesterol or a derivative thereof); or at least two different neutral lipids as described herein, (e.g., at least one phospholipid(s) (e.g. PCs (e.g., DMPC, DSPC, etc.), PI, sphingomyelin, phosphatidic acid, etc.) and at least one other neutral lipid (e.g., cholesterol)) may be prepared by the production methods described below, as well as other modifications of the methods envisioned by the skilled artisan in view of the teaching of the present specification. The additional lipids, NωPE, TF-NωPE and, where present, drug or labeled compound components may be as described throughout the present specification. Similarly, the relative amounts of the components are also as described through the present specification.
  • In certain embodiments, the lipid mixture produced in the first step of production method B (the lipid mixture produced by dissolving the additional lipids and NωPE in a suitable organic solvent) may be modified to incorporate NHS and then modified with a TF to produce a additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE lipid mixture. This lipid mixture can then be mixed with aqueous solution (optionally containing drug or labeled compound) to form a liposome-containing composition. Alternatively, a drug or labeled compound can be incorporated after the liposome-containing composition has been prepared. In some embodiments, drug or labeled compound free of aqueous solution can be incorporated in the lipid mixture, formed after modification with NHS and TF, to form a additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE:drug/labeled compound lipid mixture. This lipid mixture can subsequently be mixed with an aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition.
  • In some embodiments, the lipid mixture produced in the first step of production method B (the lipid mixture produced by dissolving the additional lipid component(s) and NωPE in a suitable solvent) may be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition (additional lipid component(s):NωPE). This liposome-containing composition may then either be treated with NHS and TF and subsequently mixed with drug or labeled compound to form a additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE:drug/labeled compound liposome-containing composition. Alternatively, the additional lipid component(s):NωPE liposome-containing composition may be treated with drug or labeled compound and then modified with NHS followed by TF.
  • In some embodiments, the lipid mixture produced in the first step of production method B (the lipid mixture produced by dissolving the additional lipid component(s) and NωPE in a suitable solvent) may then be mixed with drug or labeled compound (optionally including aqueous solution) to form a lipid mixture (where the drug or labeled compound does not include aqueous solution) or liposome-containing composition. Where a lipid mixture is formed, the lipid mixture can then be treated with NHS and TF to form a additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE:drug/labeled compound lipid mixture, which can then be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition. Alternatively, where a liposome-containing composition is formed (e.g., when the drug or labeled compound is incorporated in aqueous solution), this liposome-containing composition can subsequently be treated with NHS and TF to also yield a additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE:drug/labeled compound liposome-containing composition.
  • In a further alternative production method, method C, individual components are simultaneous mixed in organic solvent to form a lipid mixture (C-1) (e.g., components: additional lipid component(s); NωPE; TF-NωPE or components: additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE:drug or labeled compound), where the TF-NωPE is prepared and optionally purified prior to admixture. Lipid mixture C-1 can then be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition C-2 (additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE (optionally containing drug or labeled compound). Where the liposome-containing composition so formed does not contain drug or labeled compound, the drug or labeled compound may be added after formation of the liposome-containing composition (C2-A). Alternatively, where a drug or labeled compound including an aqueous solution is used as an initial starting component, the liposome-containing composition can be formed simultaneously upon the mixing of all the starting components.
  • C-2 (optionally containing drug or labeled compound) or C2-A, may then be treated to form a liposome (C-3). Where C-3 does not include a drug or labeled compound, the liposome will be an blank liposome, as previously described (e.g., additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE liposome). Where C-3 includes a drug or labeled compound, the liposome will be a targeted liposome as described herein. Where C-3 is an blank liposome, a drug or labeled compound may, as previously described, be added to the blank liposome in a subsequent step to form a targeted liposome, which may be performed immediately after preparation of C-3 or after a delay, which may include storage of the C-3 blank liposome for a period of time.
  • In a further alternative production method, method D, individual components are simultaneous mixed in organic solvent to form a lipid mixture (D−1) (e.g., components: additional lipid component(s); NωPE; or components: additional lipid component(s):NωPE:drug or labeled compound). Lipid mixture D-1 can then be mixed with aqueous solution to form a liposome-containing composition D-2 (additional lipid component(s):NωPE:(optionally containing drug or labeled compound). Liposome-containing composition D-2 can then be mixed with TF-NωPE to form a liposome-containing composition D-3 (additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE (optionally containing drug or labeled compound)), where the TF-NωPE is prepared and optionally purified prior to admixture. Where the liposome-containing composition so formed does not contain drug or labeled compound, the drug or labeled compound may be added after formation of the liposome-containing composition (D3-A). Alternatively, where a drug or labeled compound including an aqueous solution is used as an initial starting component, the liposome-containing composition can be formed simultaneously upon the mixing of all the components.
  • D-3 (optionally containing drug or labeled compound) or D3-A, may then be treated to form a liposome (D-4). Where D-4 does not include a drug or labeled compound, the liposome will be an blank liposome, as previously described (e.g., additional lipid component(s):NωPE:TF-NωPE liposome). Where D-4 includes a drug or labeled compound, the liposome will be a targeted liposome as described herein. Where D-4 is an blank liposome, a drug or labeled compound may, as previously described, be added to the blank liposome in a subsequent step to form a targeted liposome, which may be performed immediately after preparation of D-4 or after a delay, which may include storage of the D-4 blank liposome for a period of time.
  • As with lipid mixtures, liposome-containing compositions, and liposomes (including targeted liposomes, blank liposomes, etc.) formed by production method A, the lipid-containing compositions prepared by production method C or method D will be substantially free of non-NHS starting material, byproduct and/or decomposition product associated with synthesis of the succinimidyl ester of an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine (e.g., carbodiimmides (e.g., DCC, EDC, etc.), acylated urea compounds, etc.), so long as the starting material (e.g., TF-NG-PE) is substantially free of these substances prior to the initial step of production method C or method D. Where SuccNωPE is not incorporated as a starting material (and therefore not incorporated into the interior of the liposome), the liposome or liposome-containing composition can also be free or substantially free of NHS, as in when TF-NωPE is pre-formed and used as starting material. In particular embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions prepared by production method C or method D are substantially free of DCC and EDC. In certain embodiments, the lipid-containing compositions prepared by production method C or method D are substantially free of DCC.
  • In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) includes one or more phospholipid (e.g., a phosphatidyl choline, etc.) and a cholesterol or cholesterol derivative. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is DMPC, POPC, DSPC, etc. as herein described. In certain embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is DMPC or DSPC. In particular embodiments, the additional lipid(s) are a phospholipid and cholesterol. In certain embodiments, the phospholipid is a neutral phospholipid.
  • In certain embodiments, the additional lipid component(s) include at least two different neutral lipids, which include a phospholipid (e.g., a phosphatidyl choline, etc.) and a cholesterol or cholesterol derivative. In particular embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is DMPC, POPC, DSPC, etc. as herein described. In certain embodiments, the phosphatidyl choline is DMPC or DSPC. In particular embodiments, the at least two different neutral lipids are a phospholipid and cholesterol.
  • In some embodiments, the NωPE is an NG-PE. In particular embodiments, the NωPE is Nω-DOPE or Nω-DSPE. In certain embodiments, the NωPE is NG-DOPE or NG-DSPE.
  • In particular embodiments, the TF is for example, asialoglycoprotein, folate, transferrin, etc. In certain embodiments, the TF is transferrin (Tf). In some embodiments, the TF-NωPE is a Tf-NωPE (e.g., Tf-NG-DOPE or Tf-NG-DSPE).
  • In particular embodiments, the drug is, for example, an anticancer agent (e.g., oxaliplatin, topoisomerase I inhibitor, vinca alkaloid, etc.). In other embodiments, the lipid mixture or liposome-containing composition includes a labeled compound. In some embodiments, the lipid mixture or liposome-containing composition does not include a labeled compound or drug.
  • As mentioned previously, each of the lipid mixtures may be mixed with an aqueous solution to form liposome-containing compositions and each of the liposome-containing compositions may be treated to form the corresponding liposomes (e.g., targeted liposomes (e.g., incorporating drug or labeled compound), intermediate liposomes, blank liposomes, etc.), as described in detail herein.
  • With respect to the variations of the production methods described herein, it is intended that the modification of NωPE with NHS, the modification of NHS-NωPE with TF, the preparation of liposome-containing compositions from lipid mixtures, and the preparation of liposomes from liposome-containing compositions may be accomplished by the skilled artisan as described herein without undue experimentation given the teaching provided in the present specification, including, in particular, the detailed description of production methods A and B and as presented in the examples.
  • Pharmaceutical Formulations
  • In another aspect, the present invention provides pharmaceutical formulations for treatment or diagnosis of individuals in need thereof, comprising lipid-containing compositions as described herein and one or more pharmaceutically acceptable carriers, excipients, diluents, stabilizers, preservatives, or other inactive ingredients, including combinations of the foregoing, known to skilled artisans and described further herein.
  • In certain embodiments of the pharmaceutical formulations, the lipid-containing composition is a targeted liposome as described herein. In other embodiments, the lipid-containing composition is a liposome-containing composition. In some embodiments, the lipid-containing composition is an blank liposome. In certain embodiments, the composition comprises a drug. In other embodiments, the composition comprises a labeled compound.
  • In certain embodiments, the carrier may include one or more of sterile water, a buffer solution or saline, diluent, and combinations thereof.
  • The pharmaceutical formulations may further comprise one or more of different salts, sugars, proteins, starch, gelatin, plant oils, polyethylene glycol and the like, including combinations of two or more of the foregoing.
  • An additional aspect of the invention includes use of the compositions and formulations thereof as described herein in the manufacture of a medicament. Particularly, the manufacture of a medicament for use in the treatment or diagnosis of conditions as described herein. Further, the active compositions and formulations thereof, variously described herein, are also intended for use in the manufacture of a medicament for use in treatment or diagnosis of the conditions and, in accordance with the methods, described herein, unless otherwise noted.
  • Use of the Compositions
  • Administration
  • As noted previously, in one aspect is provided methods of treatment or diagnosis of conditions as described herein using the drug- or labeled compound-containing lipid-containing compositions (e.g., targeted liposomes, drug-/labeled compound-containing liposome-containing compositions) and pharmaceutical formulations as described herein.
  • In one embodiment, the methods may be practiced as a therapeutic approach towards the treatment of the conditions described herein. Thus, in a specific embodiment, the drug-containing lipid-containing compositions or pharmaceutical formulations may be used to treat the conditions described herein in individuals in need thereof, including humans. The methods generally comprise administering to the individual an amount of a composition, or formulation described herein, effective to treat the condition.
  • In another embodiment, the methods may practiced as a diagnostic approach towards the diagnosis of the conditions described herein. Thus, in a specific embodiment, the labeled compound-containing lipid-containing compositions or pharmaceutical formulations may be used to diagnosis the conditions described herein in individuals in need thereof, including humans. The methods generally comprise administering to the individual an amount of a composition, or formulation described herein, effective to diagnosis the condition. Such administration is generally undertaken in conjunction with methods to detect the condition.
  • In some embodiments, the individual is a mammal, including, but not limited to, human, bovine, horse, feline, canine, rodent, or primate. In other embodiments, the individual is a human.
  • The terms, “pharmaceutically effective amount” or “therapeutically effective amount” refer to an amount of a composition sufficient to treat a specified disorder, condition or disease or one or more of its symptoms and/or to prevent the occurrence of the disease or disorder. In reference to cancers, a pharmaceutically or therapeutically effective amount comprises an amount sufficient to, among other things, cause a tumor to shrink or to decrease the growth rate of the tumor.
  • The terms “an amount effective to diagnose” or “diagnostically effective amount” or “amounts effective for diagnosis” cognates thereof, refer to an amount of a composition sufficient to diagnose a specified disorder, condition or disease, and/or one or more of its manifestations, where diagnosis includes identification of the existence of the disease and/or detection of the extent or severity of the disease. For example, in reference to cancers, a “diagnostically effective amount” comprises an amount sufficient to detect, for example, the presence and/or concentration of one or more of malignant cells, tumor(s) or other manifestation of the cancer. Often, diagnosis will be carried out with reference to a baseline or background detection level observed for individuals without the condition. Levels of detection above background or baseline levels (elevated levels of detection) are indicative of the presence and, in some cases, the severity of the condition.
  • When used with respect to methods of treatment and the use of drug-containing lipid-containing compositions, an individual “in need thereof” may be an individual who has been diagnosed with or previously treated for the condition to be treated. With respect to methods of diagnosis and the use of labeled compound-containing compositions, an individual “in need thereof” may be an individual who is suspected to have a condition, is at risk for a condition (e.g., a family history of the condition, life-style factors indicative of risk for the condition (e.g., smoking as a risk factor for lung cancer, etc.)) or has previously been diagnosed with the condition (e.g., diagnosis can include monitoring of the severity (e.g., progression/regression) of the disease over time and/or in conjunction with therapy).
  • In certain embodiments, the condition to be treated or diagnosed is cancer. In some embodiments the cancer may be a gastric, colon, colorectal or breast cancer. In certain embodiments, the cancer is a colon cancer. In other embodiments, the cancer is a breast cancer. In still other embodiments, the cancer is a gastric cancer. In some embodiments the cancer is cancer of the pancreas, non small cell lung cancer, small cell lung cancer, brain cancer, liver cancer, renal cancer, prostate cancer, bladder cancer, ovarian cancer, or hematological malignancies (e.g., leukemia, lymphoma, multiple myeloma, etc.).
  • The drug-containing compositions, including formulations described herein, may be used alone or in conjunction with (e.g., prior to, concurrently with, or after) other modes of treatments (e.g., adjunctive cancer therapy, combined modality treatments). For example, in combination with other therapeutic agents (e.g., cancer chemotherapeutic agents as described herein and known to those of skill in the art (e.g., alkylating agents, taxanes, metabolic antagonist, antitumour antibiotic, plant alkaloids, hormone therapy drug, molecular target drug, etc.)), surgery, and/or radiation therapy. Where the condition being treated is cancer, the compositions described herein can be administered in conjunction with one or more of other anticancer agents or cytotoxic compounds as described herein and as know in the art, one or more additional agents to reduce the occurrence and/or severity of adverse reactions and/or clinical manifestations thereof, surgery (e.g., to remove a tumor or lymph nodes, etc.) or radiation. Where one or more of surgery or radiation are part of the treatment regimen, the compositions may be administered before, concurrently, or after the radiation therapy or surgery. Likewise, the compositions, and formulations thereof, as described herein may be administered before, concurrently, or after the administration of one or more anticancer agents. The targeted liposomes and formulations thereof described herein may also be administered in conjunction with (e.g., prior to, concurrently with, or after) drugs to alleviate the symptoms associated with the condition or the treatment regimen (e.g., drugs to reduce vomiting, hair loss, immunosuppression, diarrhea, rash, sensory disturbance, anemia, fatigue, stomatitis, hand foot syndrome, etc.). The targeted liposomes may also be administered at more than one stage of (including throughout) the treatment regimen (e.g., after surgery and concurrently with and after radiation therapy, etc.).
  • The labeled compound-containing compositions, including formulations described herein, may be used alone or in conjunction with (e.g., prior to, concurrently with, or after) modes of treatments (e.g., adjunctive cancer therapy, combined modality treatments). For example, the compositions may be used to monitor the progress of treatment. For example, to determined if the condition being treated is detectable before, after or concurrently with a treatment regimen (as described above with respect to methods of treatment).
  • In certain embodiments, the compositions are administered prior to or after surgery (e.g., removal of a tumor or lymph nodes, etc.). In other embodiments, the compositions are administered after surgery and prior to, concurrently with or after radiation therapy. The optimal combination of one or more of surgery and/or radiation therapy in conjunction with administration of the compositions described herein, and, optionally, additional one or more chemotherapeutic agents, can be determined by an attending physician based on the individual and taking into consideration the various factors effecting the particular individual, including those described herein.
  • In particular embodiments, the drug-containing compositions or pharmaceutical formulations may be administered in combination with one or both of 5-fluorouracil and/or leucovorin. In other embodiments, the drug-containing composition or pharmaceutical formulations may be administered in combination with one or more other anti cancer drugs such as capecitabine, UFT/LV (tegafur-uracil and leucovorin), irinotecan, anti EGFR antibody (e.g., cetuximab, etc.), anti VEGF antibody (e.g., avastin, etc.), tyrosine kinase inhibitor (e.g., erlotinib), etc. Such administration may also be combined with a treatment regimen including radiation therapy and/or surgery. In certain embodiments, the encapsulated drug in the targeted liposome is oxaliplatin.
  • In conjunction with the methods of use described herein, the lipid-containing compositions or pharmaceutical formulations of the present invention may be administered parenterally. Parenteral administration may be accomplished via bolus injection (IV), infusion (IV), intraperitoneal injection, or via local injection (such as intracranial injection). In some embodiments, the administration is via a bolus injection or continuous infusion.
  • Continuous intravenous infusion may be administered over a period of minutes or hours. For example, but not limited to, from about 10 minutes to about 5 hours, from about 15 minutes to about 4 hours; from about 30 minutes to about 4 hours; from about 45 minutes to about 4 hours, from about 60 minutes to about 4 hours, from about 45 minutes to about 3 hours, from about 60 minutes to about 2 hours, from about 90 minutes to about 3 hours, from about 90 minutes to about 2 hours, about 10 minutes, about 15 minutes, about 20 minutes, about 30 minutes, about 45 minutes, about 50 minutes, about 60 minutes, 80 minutes, about 1.5 hours, about 2 hours, about 2.5 hours, about 3 hours, about 3.5 hours, about 4 hours, about 5 hours, about 12 hours, about 24 hours, about 36 hours, or about 48 hours.
  • Formulation and Dosage
  • As noted previously, the lipid-containing compositions and pharmaceutical formulations as described herein may be administered to individuals in need thereof for the treatment or diagnosis of conditions as described herein in conjunction with the methods of use described herein.
  • The lipid-containing compositions described herein, and, in particular the targeted liposomes described herein, will generally be used in an amount effective to achieve the intended result, for example in an amount effective to treat or prevent the particular condition being treated. The composition(s) may be administered therapeutically to achieve therapeutic benefit. By therapeutic benefit is meant eradication or amelioration of the underlying disorder being treated and/or eradication or amelioration of one or more of the symptoms associated with the underlying disorder such that the patient reports an improvement in feeling or condition, notwithstanding that the patient may still be afflicted with the underlying disorder. Therapeutic benefit also includes halting or slowing the progression of the disease, regardless of whether improvement is realized.
  • In some embodiments, where the condition being treated is a cancer, an effective amount is an amount sufficient to reduce tumor growth (e.g., as measured by rate of increase of mean tumor volume prior to and/or after treatment). In certain embodiments, an effective amount is an amount sufficient to decrease mean tumor volume (e.g., where mean tumor volume after treatment is reduced compared to mean tumor volume prior to treatment).
  • The amount of compositions administered in order to administer an effective amount of encapsulated drug (e.g., oxaliplatin) will depend upon a variety of factors, including, for example, the particular condition being treated, the mode of administration, the severity of the condition being treated and the age and weight of the patient, the bioavailability of the composition, the adverse effects experienced by the individual being treated, etc. Determination of an effective dosage is well within the capabilities of those skilled in the art in view of the teachings provided herein.
  • In certain embodiments, the dose of encapsulated oxaliplatin administered at a particular time point will be in the range from about 1 to about 400 mg/m2/day. For example, in the range from about 1 to about 350 mg/m2/day, 1 to about 300 mg/m2/day, 1 to about 250 mg/m2/day, 1 to about 200 mg/m2/day, 1 to about 150 mg/m2/day, 1 to about 100 mg/m2/day, from about 5 to about 80 mg/m2/day, from about 5 to about 70 mg/m2/day, from about 5 to about 60 mg/m2/day, from about 5 to about 50 mg/m2/day, from about 5 to about 40 mg/m2/day, from about 5 to about 20 mg/m2/day, from about 10 to about 80 mg/m2/day, from about 10 to about 70 mg/m2/day, from about 10 to about 60 mg/m2/day, from about 10 to about 50 mg/m2/day, from about 10 to about 40 mg/m2/day, from about 10 to about 20 mg/m2/day, from about 20 to about 40 mg/m2/day, from about 20 to about 50 mg/m2/day, from about 20 to about 90 mg/m2/day, from about 30 to about 80 mg/m2/day, from about 40 to about 90 mg/m2/day, from about 40 to about 100 mg/m2/day, from about 80 to about 150 mg/m2/day, from about 80 to about 140 mg/m2/day, from about 80 to about 135 mg/m2/day, from about 80 to about 130 mg/m2/day, from about 80 to about 120 mg/m2/day, from about 85 to about 140 mg/m2/day, from about 85 to about 135 mg/m2/day, from about 85 to about 135 mg/m2/day, from about 85 to about 130 mg/m2/day, or from about 85 to about 120 mg/m2/day. The does administered at a particular time point may also be about 130 mg/m2/day, about 120 mg/m2/day, about 100 mg/m2/day, about 90 mg/m2/day, about 85 mg/m2/day, about 80 mg/m2/day, about 70 mg/m2/day, about 60 mg/m2/day, about 50 mg/m2/day, about 40 mg/m2/day, about 30 mg/m2/day, about 20 mg/m2/day, about 15 mg/m2/day, or about 10 mg/m2/day.
  • The dose administered may be higher or lower than the dose ranges described herein, depending upon, among other factors, the bioavailability of the composition, the tolerance of the individual to adverse side effects, the mode of administration and various factors discussed above. Dosage amount and interval may be adjusted individually to provide plasma levels of the composition that are sufficient to maintain therapeutic effect, according to the judgment of the prescribing physician. Skilled artisans will be able to optimize effective local dosages without undue experimentation in view of the teaching provided herein.
  • Dosages may also be estimated using in vivo animal models, as will be appreciated by those skill in the art.
  • Multiple doses (e.g., continuous or bolus) of the compositions as described herein may also be administered to individuals in need thereof of the course of hours, days, weeks, or months. For example, but not limited to, daily, every other day, every 10 days, weekly, monthly, twice weekly, three times a week, twice monthly, three times a month, four times a month, five times a month, every other month, every third month, every fourth month, etc.
  • Kits
  • Also provided are kits for administration of the compositions described herein, including pharmaceutical formulations comprising the compositions.
  • In certain embodiments the kits may include a dosage amount (e.g., as used for therapy or diagnosis) of at least one lipid-containing composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, as disclosed herein. Kits may further comprise suitable packaging and/or instructions for use of the composition. Kits may also comprise a means for the delivery for the composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, such as a syringe for injection or other device as described herein and known to those of skill in the art.
  • In some embodiments the kits may include a dosage amount (e.g., as used for therapy or diagnosis) of a blank liposome, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, as disclosed herein. Kits may further comprise suitable packaging and/or instructions for use of the composition. Kits may also comprise a means for the delivery for the composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof, such as a syringe for injection or other device as described herein and known to those of skill in the art. Additionally, in certain embodiments, the kit may contain a separate dosage amount of the drug or labeled compound to be incorporated into the blank liposome.
  • Additionally, the lipid-containing composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof may be assembled in the form of kits. The kit provides the lipid-containing composition, or pharmaceutical formulation thereof and reagents to prepare a composition for administration. The composition may be in a dry or lyophilized form, or in a solution, particularly a sterile solution. When the composition is in a dry form, the reagent may comprise a pharmaceutically acceptable diluent for preparing a liquid formulation. Such diluents include those known to those of skill in the art, for example, sugar solutions, e.g., dextrose, sucrose, etc. In certain embodiments the kits may includes sugar solutions of about 1% to about 20%, about 1% to about 18%, about 1% to about 15%, about 1% to about 10%, about 3% to about 10%, about 3% to about 6%, about 1%, about 2%, about 3%, about 4%, about 5%, about 6%, about 7%, about 8%, about 9%, about 10%, about 12%, about 15%, about 18%, or about 20% sugar. In certain embodiments, the solution may be a dextrose solution (e.g., about 1%, about 2%, about 5% dextrose, etc.). In certain embodiments, the lipid-containing composition may be, for example, a targeted liposome, blank liposome, lipid mixture, or liposome-containing composition (optionally containing drug or labeled compound).
  • The kit may also contain a device for administration or for dispensing the compositions, including, but not limited to syringe, pipette, or other device known to those of skill. When in a wet form, the composition may be stored in an ampoule or other sterile sealed container, including those known to persons of skill in the art.
  • The kits may include other therapeutic compounds for use in conjunction with the compounds described herein. In one embodiment, the therapeutic agents are other anticancer agents. These agents may be provided in a separate form, or mixed with the compounds of the present invention, provided such mixing does not reduce the effectiveness of either the additional therapeutic agent of the compositions and formulations described herein. Similarly the kits may include additional agents for adjunctive therapy. For example, agents to reduce the adverse effects of the drug (e.g., anti-nausea agents, anti-alopecia agents, immuno-enhancing agents, etc.).
  • The kits will include appropriate instructions for preparation and administration of the composition, side effects of the compositions, and any other relevant information. The instructions may be in any suitable format, including, but not limited to, printed matter, videotape, computer readable disk, or optical disc.
  • In another aspect of the invention, kits for treating an individual who suffers from or is susceptible to the conditions described herein are provided, comprising a first container comprising a dosage amount of a lipid-containing composition or formulations thereof as disclosed herein, and instructions for use. The container may be any of those known in the art and appropriate for storage and delivery of intravenous formulations. In certain embodiments the kit further comprises a second container comprising a pharmaceutically acceptable carrier, diluent, adjuvant, etc. for preparation of the composition to be administered to the individual.
  • Kits may also be provided that contain sufficient dosages of the compositions or formulations thereof as disclosed herein to provide effective treatment for an individual for an extended period, such as a week, 2 weeks, 3, weeks, 4 weeks, 6 weeks, 8 weeks, 3 months, 4 months, 5 months, 6 months, 7 months, 8 months, 9 months or more.
  • Kits may also include multiple doses of the lipid-containing composition or formulations thereof and instructions for use and packaged in quantities sufficient for storage and use in pharmacies, for example, hospital pharmacies and compounding pharmacies.
  • All patents, patent applications and publications referred to herein are hereby incorporated herein by reference in their entirety.
  • EXAMPLES
  • The present invention is further described with reference to the following Examples; however, these Examples are not limiting the scope of the present invention.
  • Example 1 Cytotoxicity Test for Oxaliplatin
  • An oxaliplatin (l-OHP) solution was prepared by dissolving oxaliplatin in a 9% sucrose solution (sucrose/distilled water) at a concentration of 8 mg/ml. The cell viability was determined using a commercially available cytotoxicity assay kit (WST-1 kit, Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan).
  • AsPC-1 cells (provided by Dr. Hironobu Yanagie of Research Center for Advanced Science and Technology, the University of Tokyo, Japan) cultured in RPMI 1640 medium supplemented with 10% FCS (fetal calf serum; SIGMA, USA) were treated with concentrations of l-OHP solutions [200×(½)(0-10) nM] at 37° C. in 5% CO2 for 48 hours. Then, the medium was removed and a substrate (WST-1, Cell Counting Kit, Dojindo Laboratories, Japan) was added to the cells which were incubated at 37° C. in 5% CO2 for 2 hours to develop the colored product. The developed color was measured at an absorbance of 450 nm (reference wavelength: 620 nm) on an Immuno Mini NJ-2300 (Cosmo Bio Co., Ltd., Japan).
  • The results are shown in FIG. 6. The cytotoxicity of l-OHP was found to be LD50>8 μg/ml.
  • Example 2 Determination of the Number of Transferrin Receptors on the Cell Surface
  • Human normal leukocytes and human malignant tumor-derived cell lines (K562, MKN45P and HL60) were used in the experiment and obtained as follows: K562:TKG0210 (Cell Resource Center for Biomedical Research, Institute of Department, Aging and Cancer, Tohoku University, Japan); MKN45P: Dr. Hisae Iinuma, Teikyo University School of Medicine, Japan; HL60:TKG0345 (Cell Resource Center for Biomedical Research, Institute of Department, Aging and Cancer, Tohoku University, Japan).
  • The number of Tf (transferrin) receptors on the cell surface of each was determined by Scatchard analysis (Comp. Biochem. Physiol., 116B, 137-160 (1949), using Microsoft Excel). A solution of 125I-labeled Tf (Na—125I (PerkinElmer Japan Co., Ltd., Japan) and h-Tf (T-4132, SIGMA, USA) were combined by iodogen method (Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 122, 319-325 (1984)) was added to each cell culture at different concentrations ranging from [300×(½)(0-9) nM] at 4° C. and incubated for 1 hour.
  • The concentration of 125I-labeled Tf was determined by protein quantification assay by the Lowry method (J. Biol. Chem., 193, 265-270 (1951)) and the radioactivity was measured using a gamma counter (Auto Well Gamma System ARC-300, Aloka Co., Ltd., Japan]. Briefly, the solution was centrifuged to precipitate the cells, and the cell fraction was washed with an ice-cooled PBS (180×g (gravity), for 3 min, which was repeated 3 times, followed by the measurement of radioactivity with a gamma counter to determine the concentration of Tf bound to the cell surface. The number of cells was determined by protein quantification assay, using the Lowry method (J. Biol. Chem., 193, 265-270 (1951)).
  • For each data point, the concentration of unbound Tf was determined by subtracting the concentration of bound Tf from the known concentration of Tf added. The Scatchard plot was drawn by plotting the concentration of bound Tf on the horizontal axis and the ratio of the concentration of bound Tf to the concentration of unbound Tf on the vertical axis. The number of the bound Tf (i.e., the number of the receptors) was determined from the x intercept of the graph, as described in Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 80 2263-2266 (1983); J. Cell Physiol., 132, 492-500 (1987); Proc. Natl. Acad. Sci. USA, 92 3318-3322 (1995); J. Pharm. Sci., 84, 216-220 (1995); Eur. J. Biochem., 186, 367-373 (1989); J. Biol., Chem., 258, 4715-4724 (1983), which are hereby incorporated by reference in their entirety.
  • The number of 125I-Tf bound to the cell surface in the different cell types are shown in FIG. 7. It was determined that the number of transferrin (Tf) receptors on the cell surface of the cell lines derived from human malignant tumors was significantly higher than that in normal leukocytes.
  • Example 3 Preparation of NHS-NG-DOPE
  • A mass of 200 mg of NG-DOPE (Avanti Polar Lipids, Inc., USA) (Cat. No. 870242, MW 880.13)) was weighed into a conical flask with 2 legs. To the flask was added 39.2 mg NHS (Sigma, USA, MW=115.09). Next, 5 mL of chloroform/Ethyl acetate (1:1 (v/v), Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) was added and swirled to begin dissolving the NG-DOPE and NHS. Slight cloudiness observed.
  • Following initial mixing, a stir bar was added and the flask set up (balloon filled with nitrogen gas) to blow nitrogen gas gently into one leg of the flask and sealed with rubber stopper. Stirring under nitrogen was accomplished using a stir bar and stir plate. The second leg was sealed with a tube. The reaction was performed at ambient temperature (20-23° C.). The mixture was stirred for 5-10 minutes. A 20 μL sample of Lipid+NHS reaction mixture was set aside for use as a TLC control.
  • In a separate flask, a solution of DCC (99%, Aldrich, USA, MW: 206.33 g/mol) was prepared by dissolving 70 mg of DCC in 5 mL ethyl acetate. The DCC dissolved quickly in the solvent to yield a clear solution. The DCC solution so prepared (approximately 5 mL) was then added dropwise to the lipid/NHS reaction mixture over 10-15 minute period. The reaction mixture became more cloudy upon addition of DCC.
  • TLC was performed on the control (lipid/NHS) and on an aliquot of lipid/NHS/DCC at time 0 for reference, as follows. Sample was spotted 50 μg (2.5 μL of 20 mg/mL) on TLC plate (aluminum sheet-silica gel 60F254 from EM Science (Gibbstown, N.J., USA) Cat No. SP05554M), dried and then placed in the developing chamber where solvent (70% chloroform, 28% methanol, 2% water) was allowed to migrate. The solvent front was marked and then the TLC plate was dipped in ammonium molybdate (5% ammonium molybdate in 10% H2SO4) and dehydrated with dryer.
  • The lipid/NHS/DCC reaction mixture was stirred under nitrogen flow and the formation of product was monitored (Rf 0.3-0.4) over time.
  • After 18 hours, conversion to NHS-NG-DOPE was not complete conversion after 18 hours, and more NHS (26 mg in 2 mL ethyl acetate) and DCC (47 mg in 1 mL ethyl acetate) were added. Reaction progression was again tested by TLC at T=20 hr.
  • The reaction was allowed to proceed over the weekend at ambient temperature with nitrogen flow and stirring (protected from light). Some starting materials remained prior to purification.
  • Purification:
  • The reaction mixtures was chilled reaction on ice for ˜30 minutes. The chilled reaction mixture was then filtered through a Buckner funnel and then washed 3 times with 2×5 mL chloroform. All of the liquid obtained was collected and dried by rotary evaporation. A semi-solid paste was obtained after evaporation. The paste was then resuspended in 2-3 mL chloroform.
  • Silica gel for purification of the suspended paste was prepared using silica (400 mesh) 4 g—hydrated in chloroform. The silica gel was packed onto a 1 cm×28 cm column with stopcock. The approximate size of the bed was 1 cm×14 cm. The column was equilibrated with chloroform (gravity packed).
  • Sample was loaded onto the equilibrated (but not dried) silica gel column. Added 10 mL chloroform to column (5×2 mL). Collected 5×2 mL fractions. Flow rate was a function of gravity, but 5×10 mL fractions collected in 10-20 min and designated fractions 1-5.
  • Next, 50 mL chloroform/methanol (90/10, vol/vol) was added to the column (5×10 mL). And 5×10 mL fractions were collected and designated fractions 6-10.
  • After collection of fractions 6-10, a volume of 100 mL chloroform/methanol (5/1 (v/v)) was added to the column (10×10 mL). And additional 10×10 mL fractions were collected and designated fractions 11-15.
  • Fractions 6-15 were assayed (5 μL aliquot) by TLC as described above.
  • Following TLC of fractions 6-15, fractions 7-11 were pooled and dried to a thin film using rotary evaporation. The final product obtained after evaporation was 130 mg (65% yield), as determined by TLC against the unpurified reaction product and comparison with a standard product (NHS-NG-DOPE) obtained from NOF (Japan).
  • Example 4 Preparation of NHS-NG-DOPE
  • Pre-prepared and purified NG-DOPE (200 mg) (NOF Corporation Japan) and NHS (N-hydroxysulfosuccinimide; 34 mg) were weighed and placed in a 5 mL conical flask with 2 openings. One opening was sealed with a rubber stopper and a stir bar was added through the remaining opening.
  • The flask was then placed under vacuum and filled with nitrogen gas flowing gently (repeat at three times). The flask was then kept under nitrogen using a nitrogen balloon.
  • After placing under nitrogen, to the flask was added 2.5 mL dry chloroform, was then stirred using the stir bar and stir plate. The reaction was performed at ambient temperature for approximately 30 minutes and swirling was used to dissolve the starting materials. A 20 μL sample of Lipid+NHS was set aside for use in the TLC control/monitoring of the reaction.
  • A solution of 61 mg of DCC (1,3-dicyclohexylcarbodiimide) dissolved in 2.5 mL dry chloroform (clear, dissolved quickly) was prepared then prepared. The DCC solution was added dropwise to the lipid/NHS mixture over a 15 minute period. The solution turned cloudy upon addition of DCC.
  • At time 0, a TLC (70% chloroform, 30% methanol, 5% water) on lipid/NHS and lipid/NHS/DCC was performed to monitor the reaction by spotting 50 mg of chloroform on the TLC plate, allowing to dry, which was then placed in the reaction chamber (70% chloroform, 30% methanol, 5% water) to migrate.
  • The reaction mixture continued with stirring under nitrogen flow and the formation of product (Rf 0.3-0.4) was monitored over time.
  • The reaction was allowed to proceed over a time period of 2-3 days at ambient temperature with nitrogen flow and stirring.
  • The reaction mixture was then filtered through a Bruchner funnel and washed twice with 2×5 mL chloroform. The entire solution was collected and dried by rotary-evaporation. A semi-solid paste was obtained.
  • The semi-solid paste was resuspended in 2×3 mL chloroform, and then filtered and dried. This process was repeated three times. Finally, after three times the product was resuspended in 2×3 mL chloroform.
  • Column silica gel was prepared by mixing silica in chloroform which was then packed on a 1 cm×28 cm column with stopcock. The approximate size of the column bed was 1 cm×14 cm. The column was equilibrated with chloroform (gravity packed).
  • Samples were loaded onto equilibrated (but not dried) silica gel column. Then, was added 100 mL chloroform to column and aliquots were collected in 100 mL fractions. The flow rate was a function of gravity. (Fraction 1)
  • Fraction 1. Added 100 mL chloroform/methanol (90/10, vol/vol) to column. Collected 100 mL fractions. (Fraction 2)
  • Added 200 mL chloroform/methanol (50/10, vol/vol) to column (20×10 mL). Collected 20×10 mL fractions. (Fraction 3-23.)
  • Fractions 1 to 23 were assayed using 5 mL aliquots via TLC.
  • Fractions 9 through 22 were pooled and dried to a thin film using rotary-evaporation and lyophilization. The final weight of NHS-NG-DOPE from these fractions was 61.9 mg (27.9% yield).
  • Example 5 Preparation of Lipid Mixture (NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH)
  • 583 mg of DMPC (NOF corporation, Japan), 299 mg of cholesterol (Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) and 75.7 mg of NG-DOPE (NOF corporation, Japan) were mixed and dissolved in t-BuOH (10 v/w vs. lipids (10 mL)) at 45-50° C.
  • The resulting solution was poured into a vial and frozen for about 8 hours on a shelf at −40° C. It was depressurized to about 0.1 mmHg and kept at reduced pressure for 2 days with rising the temperature from −40° C. to 25° C. stepwise, from which process a lyophilized lipid mixture was obtained.
  • A powder of the lyophilized lipid mixture as obtained above was mixed with 20 mg of powdery Tf-NG-DOPE (as prepared in Example 29) and crashed. A homogeneous powder of lipid mixture was thus obtained, with a lipid ratio of 50:45:5 (DMPC:Chol:NG-DOPE+Tf-NG-DOPE).
  • Example 6 Preparation of Liposome-Containing Compositions
  • Lipid mixtures were prepared according to the previous examples with the components as detailed below:
  • Entry 1: DMPC/Chol/NG-DOPE (155 mg/79.4 mg/16.1 mg)
  • Entry 2: DMPC/Chol/NG-DOPE (155 mg/79.4 mg/16.1 mg)
  • Entry 3: DMPC/Chol/NG-DOPE/NHS-NG-DOPE (152 mg/77.9 mg/15.8 mg/4.38 mg)
  • Entry 4: DMPC/Chol/NG-DOPE/NHS-NG-DOPE (152 mg/77.9 mg/15.8 mg/4.38 mg)
  • Entry 5: DMPC/Chol/NG-DOPE/Tf-NG-DOPE (148 mg/76.0 mg/15.4 mg/4.8 mg)
  • Entry 6: DMPC/Chol/NG-DOPE/Tf-NG-DOPE (148 mg/76.0 mg/15.4 mg/4.8 mg)
  • Entries 1, 3 and 5 were each hydrated and stirred with 300 mM of aqueous sucrose solution (20 v/w vs. lipids (5 mL) (5 mL of sucrose solution (20 v/w) was added to the dry lipid mixture and stirred) for 30 min. at 40-45° C. Entries 2, 4 and 6 were each hydrated and stirred with an aqueous solution of l-OHP (8 mg l-OHP/mL, 20 v/w vs. lipids (5 mL) in a 300 mM sucrose solution) for 30 min. at 40-45° C. A liposome-containing mixture was thus obtained.
  • Liposome diameter was determined by QELS and the results are shown in FIG. 8. The liposomes present in the liposome-containing mixture have a mean diameter of 500-2,000 nm and have a broad distribution of sizes around 100-10,000 nm.
  • Example 7 Preparation of Oxaliplatin-Containing Liposome (NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH)
  • The composition of the liposome was as follows:
  • Dimyristoyl phosphatidylcholine (1,2-dimyristoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphocholine: DMPC) (NOF Corporation, Japan)
  • Cholesterol (CH) (Solvay Pharmaceuticals B.V., Netherlands)
  • N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (N-glutaryl-1,2-dioleoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphoethanolamine, sodium salt: DOPE-CO—(CH2)3—COOH; hereinafter represented by NG-DOPE) (NOF Corporation, Japan)
    Succ-N-glutaryl-dioleoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (N-(succinimidyl-glutaryl)-1,2-dioleoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphoethanolamine, sodium salt: DOPE-CO—(CH2)3—CO—OSu; hereinafter represented by NHS-NG-DOPE) (NOF Corporation, Japan)
    DMPC:CH:NG-DOPE:NHS-NG-DOPE=50:45:4:1 (m/m).
  • As the aqueous phase, an aqueous solution of l-OHP (8 mg/ml, in a 300 mM sucrose solution) was used.
  • A mixture of DMPC, CH, NG-DOPE and NHS-NG-DOPE (at the mole ratio of 50:45:4:1) was dissolved in 4 v/w (vs. total lipid weight) of warm ethanol/t-butanol/water solvent. The lipid solution was injected into 300 mM sucrose solution containing about 8 mg/ml l-OHP at about 45° C., so that the concentration of the solvent became about 14% v/v.
  • The suspension was passed through an Extruder that was lapped over five pieces of 100 nm filters (Cat. No. 112105, Whatman plc, UK) under pressure of about 200-800 psi at about 45° C. The liposome was thus obtained, having an average diameter in the vicinity of 100 nm. Liposome diameter was determined using QELS.
  • 6 L of phosphate buffered saline (pH 7.9), 6 L of transferrin (Cat. No. 4455, Selorogicals, GA, USA) solution (20 mg/ml), and 18 L of liposome suspension were mixed and stirred at 30° C. for 15-60 min. This resulted in a reaction mixture which contained 4 mg/ml of transferring and 20 mg/ml of lipids.
  • The quantitative analysis of transferrin was performed by the bicinchoninic acid (BCA) assays according to instructions provided by the vendor.
  • The increase of molecular weight after incorporation of transferrin was investigated by SDS-PAGE (Sodium Dodecyl Sulfate polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis). The analysis of NG-DOPE was performed by high-performance liquid chromatography (HPLC) with evaporative light scattering detector (ELSD2000, Alltech, MD, USA) using a Silicagel column (YMC PVA Silica Column, 4.6×250 mm, 5 μm).
  • Example 8 Preparation of Oxaliplatin-Containing Liposome (NG-DSPE:Tf-NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH)
  • The composition of the liposome was as follows:
  • Distearoyl phosphatidylcholine (1,2-distearoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphocholine: DSPC) Cholesterol (CH)
    N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (N-glutaryl-1,2-distearoyl-sn-glycero-3-phosphoethanolamine, sodium salt: DSPE-(CH2)3—COOH; hereinafter represented by NG-DSPE)
    DSPC:CH:NG-DSPE=2:1:0.2 (mol/mol).
  • As the aqueous phase, an aqueous solution of l-OHP (8 mg/ml, in a 9% sucrose solution) was used, as described in Example 1.
  • A mixture of DSPC (MC8080, NOF, Japan), cholesterol (038-03005, Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) and NG-DSPE (Dr. Kazuo Maruyama, Teikyo University, Faculty of Pharmaceutical Sciences, Japan) at the ratio of 2:1:0.2 (m/m) was dissolved in chloroform and isopropyl ether.
  • To the resultant solution, a solution of l-OHP (in a 9% sucrose solution) was added, and then the resulting mixture was sonicated for about 15-30 minutes. The solution was then evaporated by rotary evaporation at 60° C. to remove the solvent and the freeze/thawing was repeated five times. The suspension was frozen (by being immersed in dry-ice/acetone bath) and thawed (by being left to stand and immersed in warm water). This was repeated five times.
  • Then, the resultant product was sized at 60° C. using EXTRUDER filters (twice at 400 nm and then five times at 100 nm), (Lipex™ Extruder, Model No. T-001, Northern Lipids Inc., Canada) and ultracentrifuged (200,000×g, 60 min, about 4° C.). The precipitate was resuspended in a 9% sucrose solution or MES buffer (pH 5.5) (MES buffer. Cat. No. 345-01625, Dojindo Laboratories, Japan) to obtain l-OHP-encapsulated NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposome.
  • Subsequently, the l-OHP-encapsulated NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposome was derivatized with transferrin (Tf). To the thus obtained l-OHP-encapsulated NG-DSPE liposome, 1-ethyl-3-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)carbodiimide hydrochloride (EDC; Cat. No. #22980, Pierce Biotechnology, Inc., USA) (in an amount of 2.7% relative to the weight of the lipid) and N-hydroxysulfosuccineimide (S—NHS; 038-0432, Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) (in an amount of 7.3% relative to the weight of the lipid) were added, and the mixture was left at room temperature for 10 minutes.
  • Then, to the resultant solution, transferrin (Tf) (in an amount of 20% relative to the weight of the lipid; (Cat. No. T4132, SIGMA, USA) was added and stirred at room temperature for 3 hours. A 1 mM PBS (Phosphate buffered saline) solution of transferrin (Tf) ((in an amount of 20% relative to the volume of the total reaction mixture) and 1 mM PBS were added (in an amount of 20% relative to the volume of the total reaction mixture), and the resulting solution stirred at room temperature for 1 hour.
  • To the thus obtained apo-form of Tf-NG-DSPE liposome, 10-40 eq. (vs. transferrin) of iron citrate-sodium citrate (Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) was added to the suspension and stirred at room temperature for 15 minutes. The resultant solution was ultrafiltrated as above. The precipitate was then resuspended in a 9% sucrose solution, whereby a holo-form of Tf-NG-DSPE liposome was obtained. The solution was ultrafiltrated (200,000×g, 60 min, about 4° C.) and then the precipitate was resuspended in a 9% sucrose solution.
  • The quantitative analysis of transferrin was performed by the bicinchoninic acid (BCA) assays, performed in accordance with the vendor's instruction (Cat. No. 23227, BCA™ Protein Assay Kit, Pierce Biotechnology, Inc., USA).
  • The increase in molecular weight upon derivatization was investigated by SDS-PAGE (Sodium Dodecyl Sulfate polyacrylamide gel electrophoresis). The analysis of NG-DSPE was performed by high-performance liquid chromatography (HPLC) with evaporative light scattering detector (ELSD2000, Alltech, MD, USA) using a Silicagel column (YMC PVA Silica Column, 4.6×250 mm, 5 μm).
  • Example 9 Preparation of PEGylated Oxaliplatin-Containing Liposomes
  • Following the experimental protocol in Example 8, DSPC:cholesterol:DSPE-PEG(2K)-OMe:DSPE-PEG(3.4K)-COOH liposomes (Tf-PEG-liposomes) were prepared. In these liposomes the ratio of components was as follows: DSPC:cholesterol:DSPE-PEG(2K)-OMe:DSPE-PEG(3.4K)-COOH=2:1:0.16:0.03.
  • This liposome contained 6% by mole of PEG-lipid and 1% by mole of PEG-COOH-lipid, and Tf is bound to the liposome through PEG-COOH.
  • Also made by the method of Example 8 were Tf/PEG-DSPE liposomes (Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes).
  • In these liposomes the ratio of components was as follows: DSPC:cholesterol:DSPE-PEG(2K)-OMe:NG-DSPE=2:1:0.16:0.03.
  • This liposome is derivatized with PEG, and the Tf was bound to the liposome through NG-DSPE. PEG-derivatized liposomes can also be produced by the methods described in U.S. Pat. App. Pub. Nos. 2003/0224037 and 2004/0022842, the disclosures of which are hereby incorporated in their entirety.
  • Example 10 Preparation of Blank Liposome
  • A mixture of DMPC, Chol (Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan), NG-DOPE (NOF Corporation, Japan) and NHS-NG-DOPE (NOF Corporation, Japan) (at the mole ratio of 50:45:4:1; 410 g of DMPC, 211 g of Chol, 43 g of NG-DOPE and 12 g of NHS-NG-DOPE, respectively) was dissolved in 4 v/w (vs. total lipid weight) of warm ethanol/t-butanol/water solvent. The resulting suspension with a volume of 20 L was incubated at 45° C. with stirring and passed through an Extruder (Stevested Machinery & Engineering Ltd., Canada) that was lapped with five stacking of polycarbonate 100 nm filters (Cat. No. 112105, Whatman plc, UK) under pressure of about 200-800 psi at about 45° C. The liposomes were thus obtained, having an average diameter in the vicinity of 100 nm. Liposome diameter was determined by QELS.
  • The liposome suspension, PBS buffer (pH 7.9) and PBS solution of transferrin (Cat. No. 4455, Selorogicals, GA, USA) (pH 7.0) were mixed at the ratio of 3:1:1 (v/v), then stirred for 15-60 min. at 30° C. Approximately 6 L blank liposome was thus obtained.
  • 20 g (about 19 mL) of liposome solution was poured into a vial and frozen for about 8 hours on a shelf at −40° C. It was depressurized to about 0.1 mmHg and kept in the reduced pressure for 2 days with rising temperature from −40° C. to 25° C. stepwise over the 2-day period. At the completion of this process about 3.5 g of lyophilized blank liposome was thus obtained. The liposomes were subsequently stored at 4° C.
  • Example 11 Encapsulation of Oxaliplatin in Pre-Prepared Blank Liposome
  • An aqueous solution of l-OHP (8 mg/mL, in a 300 mM sucrose solution) was added to about 3.5 g of lyophilized blank liposome and rehydrated by stirring for 2 hours at 40° C. After stirring, liposomal l-OHP was separated from free l-OHP by fractionation using Sephadex G-25 (φ1×45 cm). The liposome l-OHP and free l-OHP were monitored by VIS 600 nm and UV 210 nm respectively.
  • The amount of l-OHP and cholesterol was measured. The l-OHP concentration was calculated for the case of condensing the liposome fraction to the original cholesterol concentration finally, the yield of l-OHP was measured by comparison of the l-OHP concentration of liposome and a feeding concentration of l-OHP.
  • Total l-OHP concentration for the case of condensing the liposome fraction to the original cholesterol concentration was 210 m/mL. And the yield of l-OHP was 2.6%.
  • This indicates 210 μg/mL of l-OHP was encapsulated into the lyophilized blank liposome.
  • Example 12 Comparison of Liposome Levels in Blood and Organs
  • A comparative study was carried out to evaluate the blood retention and accumulation in organs of l-OHP-encapsulated Tf-modified liposome compositions in tumor-bearing mice. Male BALB/c mice aged 5 weeks were used as the animal models, and Colon 26 cells (derived from mouse colon cancer) were used as the tumor cells. The cells were obtained from Laboratory of Biopharmaceutics, Teikyo University School of Pharmaceutical Sciences, Japan.
  • Colon 26 cells (2×106 cells) subcultured in vitro were subcutaneously implanted into the dorsal region of the mice. A mouse bearing a tumor with a diameter of about 8 to 10 mm (after 8 to 10 days growth on average) was used as the colon cancer-bearing mouse. A solution of each of the liposomes prepared in Examples 8 and 9 or l-OHP (8 mg/ml in a 9% sucrose solution) was injected into the tail vein. The concentration of oxaliplatin was adjusted at 5 mg l-OHP/kg body weight in each case. As the liposomes, Tf-NG-DSPE liposome ((▪); Example 8), Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposome ((
    Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-P00001
    ); Example 9) and Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome ((♦); Example 9) were used.
  • Blood, plasma, liver, spleen, kidney, heart, lung and tumor tissues were collected from 3 mice at each time point for each group at 1, 3, 6, 24, 48 and 72 hours after the administration. The Pt concentration in the blood, each organ and tumor tissues were determined using atomic absorption (AA), and the l-OHP concentration was calculated and reported as the ratio (%) to the dose. The concentrations in the blood are shown in FIG. 9.
  • Tf-NG-DSPE liposome showed substantially the same blood retention until 3 hours after the administration compared with Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome and Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposome. However, after 6 hours, Tf-NG-DSPE liposome showed some blood retention, but it disappeared more quickly from the blood compared with the PEG liposomes. The concentrations in the tumor tissues are shown in FIG. 10. Tf-NG-DSPE liposome showed substantially the same accumulation to tumor tissues as Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome and Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposome, despite being retained at a lower concentration in the blood over time.
  • From the above results, it was found that about 6 hours of retention time in the blood after administration is necessary and sufficient deliver a sufficient concentration of a drug to tumor tissue at a significant level or higher in mice. It is considered that a retention time in the blood longer than this may increase the possibility of causing an adverse effect on a normal tissue.
  • Example 13 Preparation of Diagnostic Liposome and Accumulation of 125I in Tumor Tissue
  • Liposomes were prepared in the same manner as in Example 7 with the exception that [125I]-Tyraminyl inulin (in PBS solution) replaced l-OHP and DMPC/CH/NG-DOPE/Tf-NG-DOPE/[125I]-Tyraminyl inulin liposomes were obtained. Lipid components were obtained also as described in Example 7. Two liposome formulations were prepared, with the components as shown below. The liposome lacking Tf-NG-DOPE served as a control for non-targeted distribution of the liposome.
  • Targeted Liposome: DMPC/CH/NG-DOPE/Tf-NG-DOPE (63.3/31.7/4/1 (m/m))
    Non-Targeted Liposome (control): DMPC/CH/NG-DOPE (63.3/31.7/5 (m/m))
  • 125I was bound to tyraminyl inulin by combining Na—125I (PerkinElmer Japan Co., Ltd., Japan) and tyraminyl inulin (Dr. Kazuo Maruyama, Teikyo University, Faculty of Pharmaceutical Sciences, Japan) using the iodogen method (Biochem. Biophys. Res. Commun., 122, 319-325 (1984), incorporated by reference in its entirety). 125I-Tyraminyl inulin was thus obtained. 125I-Tyraminyl inulin/PBS(−) solution at a concentration of about 1 mg/mL was then encapsulated into the liposome as described in Example 7.
  • 100 μl of each of the liposome solutions was injected into the tail vein of murine colon cancer-bearing mice described in Example 12. Tumor tissue and tail were collected from 5 mice at each time point for each group at 1, 6, 24 and 48 hours after the administration. The weight of the tumor tissue was measured and the radioactivity (unit: cpm) in the tumor tissue and the tail was measured using a gamma counter (Aloka Auto Gamma System ARC-300, Japan). Results were evaluated as the distribution amount in the tumor tissue (% of dose/g-tumor)=[(count value in the tumor tissue)−(value of b.g.)]×100/[(count value of Std.)−(count value in the tail)]/(weight of tumor tissue (g)). The half-life radioactive of 125I is approximately 60 days.
  • The radioactivity of 100 μl of the administered solution (standard: Std.) was defined as 100% and the count value of an empty test tube was defined as the value of the background (b.g.). The results are shown in FIG. 11. As is apparent from FIG. 11 Tf-modified liposome shows high accumulation to a tumor tissue, while non-targeted liposomes do not show a high accumulation. These results demonstrate that a liposome encapsulating a radioactive compound are useful for the detection of tumor tissue.
  • Example 14 Comparison of Antitumor Effects of Liposomes
  • A comparative study was carried out to evaluate the antitumor effects on colon cancer Colon 26-bearing mice for l-OHP-encapsulated Tf-modified liposome compositions (Tf-PEG-liposomes prepared in Example 9, Tf-NG-DSPE:NG-DSPE:DSPC:CH liposomes prepared in Example 8, Tf/PEG-NG-DSPE liposomes prepared in Example 9; 9 mice in each group) and for each of the liposome compositions to which transferrin is not bound ((−)TF; 6 mice in each group).
  • The tumor-bearing mice were prepared in the same manner as in Example 12. As the control, a solution of l-OHP (8 mg/ml in a 9% sucrose solution) was used. The date when 1-OHP was administered at doses of 5 mg/kg was defined as the start date, and on day 4, l-OHP was administered at doses of 5 mg/kg again. The size of the tumor on day 0 was defined as 1, and the size was shown as the ratio based on this starting size. The size of the tumor was measured on day 0, 2, 5, 7, 10, 13, 15, 18 and 21, and the survival days were surveyed.
  • The results are shown in FIG. 12.
  • As can be seen in FIG. 12, the liposome compositions to which transferrin is bound exhibited an inhibitory effect on tumor growth. On the other hand, the liposome compositions to which transferrin is not bound had a weaker inhibitory effect on tumor growth compared with that of the liposome compositions to which transferrin was bound. From the results depicted in FIGS. 9 and 10, it was found that about 6 hours of retention time in the blood after administration is necessary and sufficient for a liposome to which transferrin is bound to have an inhibitory effect on tumor growth and to make the concentration of a drug accumulating to a tumor tissue be significant and substantially the same level. It is considered that a retention time in the blood longer than this may increase the possibility of causing an adverse effect on a normal tissue.
  • Example 15 Optimization of NG-DSPE Content
  • In order to determine the optimal blending ratio of NG-DSPE in a liposome, the blood retention of NG-DSPE in which an anticancer agent was not encapsulated was investigated in normal mice. Liposome compositions in which an anticancer agent was not encapsulated were prepared in the same manner as in Example 8, but using water instead of a solution of l-OHP as the aqueous phase, with differing amounts of NG-DSPE.
  • The total molar amount of the total lipid components constituting a liposome is defined as 100% and the contents of NG-DSPE are shown as the ratio (% by mole) of NG-DSPE to the total lipid components. In addition, a liposome containing 6% by mole of MPB lipid (MPB-DSPE) or PDP lipid (PDP-DSPE) as the constituent lipid was also prepared. MPB liposome is obtained by forming a liposome by binding maleimide-phenylbutyrate (MPB) to the amino group of the ethanolamine of the lipid, and binding Tf to the liposome through MPB (870013(16:0), Avanti Polar Lipids, Inc, USA). PDP (870205(16:0, Avanti Polar Lipids, Inc, USA) liposome is obtained by forming a liposome by binding 2-pyridylthio propionate (PDP) to the amino group of ethanolamine of the lipid, and binding Tf to the liposome through PDP.
  • In the experiment, 105 mice (ICR male, 6 weeks of age) (Tokyo Laboratory Animal Science Co., Ltd., Japan) were used. As the tracer, 125I was bound to tyraminyl-inulin, (prepared as described in Example 13) and this inulin solution at a concentration of about 1 mg/ml was encapsulated into the liposome. The weight of the collected blood and organs for each case was measured, and the radioactivity (unit: cpm) of the liposome marker was measured using a gamma counter (Aloka Auto Gamma System ARC-300, Japan). In addition, the radioactivity of each administered solution (100 μl) to the tail vein was measured. The radioactivity of 100 μl of the administered solution (standard: Std.) was defined as 100%, and the value (% of dose) for each organ was expressed as a percentage. The total blood amount was estimated to be 7.3% of the body weight, and the liposome amount in the blood was expressed as the amount in the total blood. The count value of an empty test tube was defined as the value of the background (b.g.), which was subtracted from the count value for each sample.

  • Distribution amount in the blood (%)=[(count value of the blood)−(value of b.g.)]×(body weight of mouse (g))×0.073×100/[(count value of Std.)−(count value of tail)×(weight of blood (g))].
  • The results are shown in FIG. 13. With regard to the concentration in the blood after 6 hours, NG-DSPE liposome shows high blood retention when the lipid content is 3% by mole or higher. As for the maleimide-liposome (MPB 6%), the blood retention was low.
  • Example 16 Effect of Tf and Dicarboxylic Acid on Blood Retention
  • In order to investigate the effects of the presence or absence of the liposome-bound transferrin and the types of dicarboxylic acids (e.g., glutaryl, succinyl, etc.), the blood retention of a transferrin-bound liposome in which an anticancer agent was not encapsulated was examined in normal mice. The experimental method was the same as described in Example 15.
  • A liposome containing a phospholipid to which succinic acid was bound instead of glutaric acid was prepared.
  • NG-DSPE (glutaric) was prepared as follows. In the dark under a nitrogen gas stream, DSPE (ME-8080, NOF Corporation, Japan) was suspended in dehydrated chloroform of 10 times the volume of DSPE. Then, 1.3 equivalent amounts of triethylamine (208-02643, Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) were added, and a dehydrated chloroform solution of glutaric acid anhydrous (G0071, Tokyo Chemical Industry, Japan) (dissolved in dehydrated chloroform of the same volume as DSPE) was added dropwise at room temperature. After completion, the solution was reacted at 30° C. for 2 hours while stirring.
  • Then, the reaction solution was washed 3 times with an acetate buffer (pH 4.5), and the organic layer was dehydrated with magnesium sulfate and filtrated by suction filtration with a water flow aspirator. Then, the filtrate was concentrated under reduced pressure at 30° C. When it became oily (about 2 times the volume of DSPE), methanol was added to form crystals, and then filtered. It was dissolved in chloroform again, and this procedure was repeated twice. Then, the crystal was dried under reduced pressure at room temperature, whereby a target product was obtained as white crystal. NG-DSPE liposome was prepared by the same method as in Example 8.
  • The results are shown in FIG. 14. The liposome to which transferrin is bound through dicarboxylic acid (NG-DSPE: N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine, NS-DSPE: N-succinyl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine) shows high blood retention. However, in the case of the liposome to which transferrin is bound through an S—S bond by maleimide (MPB), the blood retention was low even though the same ligand, transferrin, was bound.
  • Example 17 Electrophoretic Analysis of Liposomes
  • As one example of analytical methods for characterizing the liposomes, an example of electrophoresis is shown. Liposome was dissolved and denatured at 95° C. for 5 min in sample buffer containing 2.5% of SDS and 5% of 2-mercaptoethanol. By using about 7.5% to 10% polyacrylamide gel (Funakoshi, Easy gel (II), precast gel, Japan), 5 μl of each sample was applied on the gel, and electrophoresis was carried out under a constant current of 20 mA for 1 to 2 hours.
  • After the electrophoresis, the gel was silver stained with a silver staining kit (Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Silver Staining II Kit Wako, Japan). The results are shown in FIG. 15 for the following liposomes: lane 6 (transferrin-N-glutaryl-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine-liposome (Tf-NG-DSPE liposome)); lane 5 (transferrin-polyethyleneglycol-distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine-liposome (Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome)) are shown. Lanes 1-4, contain h-apo-Tf (240 ng), h-apo-Tf (120 ng), h-apo-Tf (60 ng), and h-apo-Tf (30 ng), respectively.
  • In the case of the comparative example, Tf-PEG-DSPE liposome, since polyethyleneglycol has some molecular weight distribution, a complicated electrophoresis image with several bands appeared. In the case of Tf-NG-DSPE liposome, a single band appeared, which is much more easily analyzed and enhances the ability to purify the liposome. These results indicate that, for the liposome composition according to the present invention, an analytical assay method is simpler than that for a PEG-derivatized liposome composition.
  • Example 18 Effect of Free PE on Liposome Compositions
  • In order to investigate the effects of the presence of free phosphatidyl ethanolamine (non-NG-PE) in a liposome, the binding ability of Tf was measured for Tf-NG-DSPE liposome and a liposome prepared by adding distearoyl phosphatidyl ethanolamine (DSPE) (no NG present). Tf-NG-DSPE liposome was prepared from DSPC (64 parts), CH (32 parts) and NG-DSPE (4 parts), and Tf-NG-DSPE+DSPE liposome was prepared from DSPC (64 parts), CH (32 parts), NG-DSPE (4 parts) and DSPE (10 parts) in the same manner as in Example 8.
  • Subsequently, Tf was bound to NG-DSPE by using 10 equivalent amounts of NHS and ECD/HCl and 0.05 equivalent amounts of Tf. Then, the liposome samples in an amount corresponding to 1 mg of lipid were separated by SDS-PAGE, and the bands were visualized by silver staining as described in Example 17.
  • The results are shown in FIG. 16. It was found that, in the case of NG-DSPE+DSPE liposome to which 10% by mole of DSPE was added, the bound amount of Tf was significantly low compared with that of NG-DSPE liposome that contained no non-NG-DSPE. It is likely that this is because the amino group of Tf and the amino group of DSPE compete each other in the reaction where Tf is bound to the carboxyl group of NG-DSPE.
  • Example 19 Comparison of Liposome Levels in Blood and Organs
  • Using the protocols described in Example 12, the levels of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH (Tf-NG-DOPE:NG-DOPE) liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) and Tf-PEG-DSPE liposomes (prepared as in Example 9) in blood and tumor were compared. The results for the amount of liposome retained in blood are depicted in FIG. 17 and the amount of liposome detected in tumors is shown in FIG. 18.
  • The results in FIGS. 17 and 18 show that while the Tf-NG-DOPE:NG-DOPE liposomes show a lower accumulation in the blood (FIG. 17) than the Tf-PEG-DSPE liposomes, they were able to deliver a greater amount of oxaliplatin to the tumor (FIG. 18). Lower accumulation of liposomes in the blood is likely to reduce the adverse systemic effects of the oxaliplatin.
  • Example 20 Comparison of Liposome Antitumor Effects in Colon 26 Tumor-Bearing Mice
  • Using the protocols described in Example 14, the effect of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) and Tf-PEG-DSPE liposomes (prepared as in Example 9) on colon 26 tumors in mice were compared. The results are depicted in FIG. 19.
  • As can be seen in FIG. 19, both liposomes show an inhibition of tumor growth compared to oxaliplatin solution, however, as noted in Example 19, the accumulation of less of the NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH in blood (plasma) will likely mean that these liposomes are better tolerated by the individuals to whom they are administered.
  • Example 21 Liposome Antitumor Effects on Xenograft HCT-116 Colon Tumor Model
  • The antitumor efficacy of the NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) when administered against subcutaneously implanted HCT-116 human colon tumor xenografts. The test was performed at Southern Research Institute, AL, USA] in male athymic NCr-nu mice (02/A/08F17T9, Frederick Cancer Research and Development Center, MD, USA; 50 mice) was studied, with oxaliplatin in solution used as a reference compound. The antitumor activity of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes is summarized in FIG. 20.
  • NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes were administered intravenously (i.v.) every four days for four injections (q4d×4) as doses of 15 and 10 mg/kg/injection. Oxaliplatin was administered on the same schedule at a dose of 15 mg/kg/injection. Vehicle (about 10.3% sucrose) and blank liposome control groups were injected on the same schedule.
  • Mean tumor volume for the HCT-116 colon tumor model, following treatment with NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes every 4 days was 28.9% of the control tumor volume for the 15 mg/kg group and 35.9% of the control tumor volume for the 10 mg/kg group. The antitumor activity of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes was also compared to non-liposomal oxaliplatin in the HCT-116 model, where NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes showed greater efficacy in terms of relative tumor volume, when administered at 15 mg/kg (28.9% of the control tumor volume) every four days (4×). Non-liposomal oxaliplatin delivered at 15 mg/kg every four days (4×) yielded 39.3% of the control tumor volume.
  • Example 22 Liposome Antitumor Effects on Xenograft HT-29 Colon Tumor Model
  • The antitumor efficacy of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) when administered against subcutaneously implanted HT-29 human colon tumor xenografts. The test was performed at Panapharm Laboratories Co., Ltd., Japan in female athymic BALB/cA Jcl-nu mice (CLEA Japan, Inc., Japan; 50 mice) and the results are summarized in FIG. 21. Groups of 4 mice were administered NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at doses of 6.7, 10 or 15 mg/kg, or vehicle control. The vehicle and 6.7 and 10 mg/kg treated groups were injected on days 10, 14 and 19 and the 15 mg/kg treated group was injected on days 10 and 14.
  • The mean tumor volume for the HT-29 colon tumor model, following treatment with NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes was 66.3% of the control tumor volume for the 6.7 mg/kg group and 39.5% of the control tumor volume for the 10 mg/kg group (p value 0.01).
  • Example 23 Liposome Antitumor Effects on Xenograft MKN45 Gastric Tumor Model
  • The antitumor efficacy of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) when administered against subcutaneously implanted MKN45 human gastric tumor xenografts. The test was performed at Panapharm Laboratories Co., Ltd., Japan in male athymic BALB/cA Jcl-nu mice (CLEA Japan, Inc., Japan; 50 mice) was studied and is summarized FIG. 22.
  • Groups of 4 mice were administered NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at doses of 6.7, 10 or 15 mg/kg, or vehicle control. The vehicle and 6.7 and 10 mg/kg treated groups were injected on days 7, 12 and 24 and the 15 mg/kg treated group was injected on days 7 and 24. The mean tumor volume for the MKN45 gastric tumor model following treatment with NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes was 65.4% of the control tumor volume for the 6.7 mg/kg group (p value ≦0.05), 49.6% of the control tumor volume for the 10 mg/kg group (p value ≦0.01), and 48.5% of the control tumor volume for the 15 mg/kg group (p value ≦0.01; delivered every 17 days).
  • Example 24 Liposome Antitumor Effects on Xenograft COLO 205 Colon Tumor Model
  • The antitumor efficacy of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) when administered against subcutaneously implanted COLO 205 human colon tumor xenografts The test was performed at Southern Research Institute, AL, USA in male athymic NCr-nu mice (01/A/09F3T8, Federic Cancer Research and Development Center, MD, USA) was studied, with oxaliplatin in solution used as a reference compound and is summarized in FIG. 23.
  • Into 40 mice NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes were administered by i.v. injection every four days for three injections (q4d×3) at doses of 10 and 5 mg/kg/injection. Oxaliplatin was administered at a dose of 5 mg/kg/injection on the same schedule. The control group was injected on the same schedule. Advanced-stage tumors were retreated beginning on day 47 for all groups.
  • NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes were administered every other day for two injections at doses of 15 and 10 mg/kg/injection followed by treatment every other day for six injections at doses of 4 and 2 mg/kg/injection, respectively. Oxaliplatin was administered on the same schedule at doses of 10 and 2 mg/kg/injection. The control group was treated on the same schedule.
  • The mean tumor volume for the COLO 205 colon tumor model following treatment with NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes administered initially at doses of 10 and 5 mg/kg, with subsequent treatment of advanced stage, previously treated tumor with NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at doses of 15 and 10 mg/kg, followed by NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes at doses of 4 and 2 mg/kg using various treatment schedules, was between 53.2% and 69.5% of the control tumor volume (p value 0.05 or 0.01).
  • Example 25 Encapsulation of Oxaliplatin in Targeted Liposomes
  • In order to measure the proportion of oxaliplatin encapsulated in NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH (Tf-NG-DOPE:NG-DOPE) liposomes prepared as in Example 7, the following procedure was used.
  • The extent of encapsulation was determined by passing an aliquot of the sample down a 3,000 MWCO (molecular weight cut-off) spin column (30K MWCO cellulose ultrafilter membrane column, Cat. No. 42410, Millipore Corp., USA) and measuring oxaliplatin concentration in the eluent using HPLC with isocratic elution of 1% acetonitrile in diluted phosphoric acid water solution (pH 3.0).
  • The level of oxaliplatin was determined following membrane filtration using HPLC analysis to quantify the levels of unencapsulated (free) drug. The trapping efficiencies of 3 batches, prepared as in Example 7, were greater than 98% (see Table 1).
  • TABLE 1
    The Ratio of Encapsulation of Oxaliplatin in Lipsome
    Lot
    I II III
    % of encapsulation 98.8 99.6 99.1
  • Example 26 pH of Targeted Liposomes
  • The pH of targeted liposomes can be determined by place the liposomes of the invention in distilled water and measuring with a standard pH meter as described below.
  • The pH of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes (prepared as in Example 7) was determined by pH meter (VWR Model 8000), with an Ag/AgCl gel-filled electrode. The pH values for 4 lots of liposome ranged from pH 7.17-7.23, as shown in Table 2 below.
  • TABLE 2
    pH of Liposome
    Lot
    1 2 3 4
    pH 7.17 7.17 7.23 7.20
  • The appearance of the liposomes at varying pHs are summarized in Table 3. These results indicate that a low pH led to aggregation, sedimentation, and precipitation, which may be due to protonation of NG-DOPE and Tf followed by aggregation of the bilayer and denaturation of transferrin.
  • TABLE 3
    Condition of Liposome at Various pH Values
    pH Observations
    7.19 Liquid, translucent, light pink
    6.98 Liquid, translucent, no change as compared to no addition, light
    pink
    6.83 Liquid, translucent, no change as compared to no addition, light
    pink
    6.37 Liquid, small white precipitates upon addition, clears within a
    minute to as compared to no addition, light pink
    5.53 Liquid, white precipitates upon addition, clears within a minute but
    is slightly more cloudy, slightly white in color
    5.07 Liquid, small white precipitates, cloudy, white in color
    4.33 Increased viscosity, significant amount of white precipitates, very
    cloudy, white in color
    3.72 Very viscous, sample does not move when the microcentrifuge
    tube is turned, white in color upside down, opaque, white in color
  • Example 27 Identification of Conjugated Transferrin and SDS-PAGE Pattern of Transferrin in Targeted Liposomes
  • This study was performed to confirm transferrin conjugation to NG-DOPE in the NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes prepared as in Example 7. When transferrin is conjugated to NG-DOPE, the complex shows a higher molecular weight than non-conjugated transferrin in this method.
  • Liposome was dissolved and denatured at 95° C. for 5 min in sample buffer containing 2.5% of SDS and 5% of 2-mercaptoethanol. The samples were then applied to 5-10% gradient polyacrylamide gel and then they were electrophoresed in the presence of SDS. Migrated protein bands were visualized by using a brilliant blue G-colloidal (B2025, SIGMA, USA).
  • The transferrin in the liposome was detected as transferrin conjugated to NG-DOPE, which showed a higher molecular weight than that of intact transferrin (see FIG. 24). A minor band with a lower molecular weight was detected as free transferrin.
  • The ratio of free transferrin to transferrin conjugated to NG-DOPE on the SDS-PAGE (FIG. 24) was calculated as the area of the peak using Scion Image soft ware (freely available at www.microsoft.com.DirectX). The ratio of free Tf in total Tf of NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposome was approximately 4.7%.
  • Example 28 Analysis of Osmotic Pressure
  • The osmotic pressure at a given temperature depends on sucrose and salts such as sodium chloride and phosphate buffer. It does not depend on the solute, but on the total ion density and the size of the molecules within the solution. Normally osmotic pressure can be measured using an instrument known as an osmometer, which measures osmotic pressure in suitable pressure units.
  • The osmotic pressure NG-DOPE:Tf-NG-DOPE:DMPC:CH liposomes prepared as in Example 7 at room temperature was measured using an osmometer (Vapro Vapor Pressure Osmometer Model 5520, Wescor, Inc., USA). The osmolarity values for 3 preparations of liposomes ranged from 360-370 mOsm/kg, as reported in Table 4.
  • TABLE 4
    Osmolarity Pressure
    Lot
    A B C
    Osmolarity 360 370 368
    (mOsm/Kg)
  • Example 29 Isolation of Tf-NG-DOPE
  • 900 mL of EtOH was added to 100 mL of blank liposome (DMPC/Chol/NG-DOPE/Tf-NG-DOPE) (as prepared in Example 10 prior to lyophilization) and stirred fully. The mixture was then centrifuged (9,000 rpm, 10 min, 20° C.; CF16RX, Hitachi Koki Co., Ltd., Japan) and a pellet was obtained.
  • 100 mL of EtOH was then added to this pellet and stirred fully. The mixture was centrifuged (9,000 rpm, 10 min, 20° C.; CF16RX, Hitachi Koki Co., Ltd., Japan) again and off-white (light orange) pellet was obtained. This washing process was repeated once more.
  • The obtained pellet above was dried with N2 gas for 30 min. The dried material was then dissolved in 10 mL of distilled water and passed through a sterile filter (0.22 μm) (Millipore Corp., USA).
  • The filtrate was poured into a vial and frozen for about 8 hours on a shelf at −40° C. The sample was depressurized to about 0.1 mmHg and kept under reduced pressure for 2 days with rising temperature from −40° C. to 25° C. stepwise. Approximately 444 mg of Tf-NG-DOPE (about 45% of transferrin content of the blank liposome was thus obtained.
  • Example 30 Preparation of Tf-NG-DSPE
  • 200 μL of NHS (Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) aqueous solution (0.1 mol/L), 200 μL of EDC (N-ethyl-N′-(3-dimethylaminopropyl)-carbodiimide hydrochloride) (Tokyo Chemical Industry Co., Ltd., Japan) aqueous solution (0.25 mol/L) and 1 mL of NG-DSPE solution (2 mmol/L) containing 2% (w/v) of OG (n-octyl-D-glucopyranoside) (Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) in 50 mmol/L MES buffer (pH 5.5) were mixed and stirred for 10 minutes.
  • Surplus reagents were eliminated by Sephadex G-15 column (1.5 cm×20 cm, 0.1% (w/v) of OG in 50 mmol/L HEPES buffer (pH 8.0), GE Healthcare Bio-Sciences Corp., USA) and fractioned to about 1 mL/tube.
  • 5 mL of 1% transferrin (Sigma, USA) aqueous solution was added dropwise to the fractions containing NG-DSPE and stirred gently for 20 hours at 4° C. Identification was by MS determination of each fraction.
  • The reaction product was then fractioned to about 1.7 mL/tube by TOYOPEARL HW-55S column (1.5 cm×45 cm, 0.9% NaCl, Tosoh Bioscience LLC, USA). Tf-NG-DSPE was estimated by mass spectrometry (MALDI-TOF/MS) and SDS-PAGE with CBB (Coomasie Brilliant Blue, Wako Pure Chemical Industries, Ltd., Japan) staining.

Claims (38)

1. A targeted liposome comprising one or more phosphatidylcholines is DOPC or DSPC, an N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, a targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, an encapsulated drug and, at least one additional lipid, which is cholesterol;
wherein the mol % of the one or more phosphatidylcholines is 30-70 mol %;
wherein the targeting factor-modified N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine comprises a transferrin linked to a second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine; and
wherein
the N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 1,
Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00028
and
the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is represented by Formula 3,
Figure US20140363491A1-20141211-C00029
wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are each an acyl group,
wherein the acyl groups are acyl groups from saturated or unsaturated aliphatic carboxylic acids having 16-18 carbon atoms,
wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are the same; and
m and p are equal and are an integer from 2 to 4; and;
wherein the targeted liposome contains from about 10 μg transferrin/mg lipid to about 50 μg transferrin/mg lipid; and,
wherein the liposome does not comprise a non-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine, egg phosphatidylcholine or a hydrophilic polymer.
2-15. (canceled)
16. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the transferrin is in a holo-form but not in an apo-form.
17. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the mean diameter of the liposome is from about 50 nm to about 250 nm.
18. The liposome of claim 1, wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl, and m and p are 3.
19. The targeted liposome of claim 18, wherein the one or more phosphatidylcholine is DOPC.
20-21. (canceled)
22. The targeted liposome of claim 1, wherein m and p are 3.
23. The targeted liposome of claim 1, wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl, stearoyl, or palmitoyl.
24-30. (canceled)
31. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is an anticancer agent.
32. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a cytotoxic drug.
33. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a topoisomerase I inhibitor.
34. The targeted liposome according to claim 33, wherein the topoisomerase I inhibitor is topotecan or irinotecan.
35. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a vinca alkaloid.
36. The targeted liposome according to claim 35, wherein the vinca alkaloid is vincristine, vinblastine, vinleurosine, vinrodisine, vinorelbine or vindesine.
37. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a nucleic acid.
38. The targeted liposome according to claim 37, wherein the nucleic acid is an antisense oligonucleotide or a ribozyme.
39. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a platinum compound.
40. The targeted liposome according to claim 39, wherein the platinum compound is biplatin, cisplatin, carboplatin, ormaplatin, oxaliplatin, zeniplatin, enloplatin, lobaplatin or spiroplatin.
41. The targeted liposome according to claim 40, wherein the platinum compound is oxaliplatin.
42. (canceled)
43. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is an alkylating agent.
44. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a taxane.
45. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a metabolic antagonist.
46. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is an antitumour antibiotic.
47. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a hormone therapy drug.
48. The targeted liposome according to claim 1, wherein the drug is a molecular target drug.
49. The targeted liposome according to claim 41, wherein the oxaliplatin is dissolved in an aqueous solution of a sugar selected from the group consisting of trehalose, maltose, sucrose, mannose, lactose, mannitol, glycerol and dextrose.
50. The targeted liposome of claim 49, wherein the sugar is at a concentration of from about 1 to about 20% percent sugar (v/v).
51. The targeted liposome of claim 41, wherein the concentration of oxaliplatin is from about 0.1 mg/ml to about 25 mg/ml within the liposome.
52. (canceled)
53. The targeted liposome claim 1, wherein the liposome does not comprise a cationic lipid.
54. The targeted liposome of claim 1, wherein the liposome does not comprise an anionic lipid.
55-254. (canceled)
255. The targeted liposome of claim 1, wherein the mol % of the second N-(ω)-dicarboxylic acid-derivatized phosphatidyl ethanolamine is 0.5-2.5 mol %.
256. The targeted liposome of claim 1, wherein the mol % of the one or more phosphatidylcholines is 35-55 mol %.
257. The targeted liposome of claim 1, wherein R1, R2, R5 and R6 are oleoyl or stearoyl.
US14/274,377 2005-03-10 2014-05-09 Novel liposome compositions Abandoned US20140363491A1 (en)

Priority Applications (1)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
US14/274,377 US20140363491A1 (en) 2005-03-10 2014-05-09 Novel liposome compositions

Applications Claiming Priority (5)

Application Number Priority Date Filing Date Title
JP2005067469A JP2006248978A (en) 2005-03-10 2005-03-10 New liposome preparation
JP2005-67469 2005-03-10
US11/371,586 US7829113B2 (en) 2005-03-10 2006-03-08 Liposome compositions
US12/891,568 US8758810B2 (en) 2005-03-10 2010-09-27 Liposome compositions
US14/274,377 US20140363491A1 (en) 2005-03-10 2014-05-09 Novel liposome compositions

Related Parent Applications (1)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US12/891,568 Continuation US8758810B2 (en) 2005-03-10 2010-09-27 Liposome compositions

Publications (1)

Publication Number Publication Date
US20140363491A1 true US20140363491A1 (en) 2014-12-11

Family

ID=36992280

Family Applications (3)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/371,586 Expired - Fee Related US7829113B2 (en) 2005-03-10 2006-03-08 Liposome compositions
US12/891,568 Expired - Fee Related US8758810B2 (en) 2005-03-10 2010-09-27 Liposome compositions
US14/274,377 Abandoned US20140363491A1 (en) 2005-03-10 2014-05-09 Novel liposome compositions

Family Applications Before (2)

Application Number Title Priority Date Filing Date
US11/371,586 Expired - Fee Related US7829113B2 (en) 2005-03-10 2006-03-08 Liposome compositions
US12/891,568 Expired - Fee Related US8758810B2 (en) 2005-03-10 2010-09-27 Liposome compositions

Country Status (22)

Country Link
US (3) US7829113B2 (en)
EP (1) EP1863448B1 (en)
JP (2) JP2006248978A (en)
KR (1) KR101352490B1 (en)
CN (1) CN101170995B (en)
AU (1) AU2006223329B2 (en)
BR (1) BRPI0608297A2 (en)
CA (1) CA2600446A1 (en)
CY (1) CY1116075T1 (en)
DK (1) DK1863448T3 (en)
ES (1) ES2529453T3 (en)
HK (1) HK1111625A1 (en)
HU (1) HUE024290T2 (en)
MX (1) MX2007010996A (en)
NO (1) NO20075136L (en)
NZ (1) NZ561569A (en)
PL (1) PL1863448T3 (en)
PT (1) PT1863448E (en)
RU (1) RU2454229C2 (en)
SI (1) SI1863448T1 (en)
WO (1) WO2006099169A2 (en)
ZA (1) ZA200708600B (en)

Cited By (4)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20140271821A1 (en) * 2013-03-13 2014-09-18 Mallinckrodt Llc Liposomal cisplatin compositions for cancer therapy
US10596191B2 (en) 2015-09-14 2020-03-24 Nippon Kayaku Kabushiki Kaisha Polymer conjugate of hexa-coordinated platinum complex
US10946028B2 (en) 2015-12-22 2021-03-16 Nippon Kayaku Kabushiki Kaisha Polymer conjugate of sulfoxide derivative-coordinated platinum(II) complex
US10988496B2 (en) 2015-06-24 2021-04-27 Nippon Kayaku Kabushiki Kaisha Platinum (IV) complex

Families Citing this family (90)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
KR101376895B1 (en) 2004-05-03 2014-03-25 헤르메스 바이오사이언스, 인코포레이티드 Liposomes useful for drug delivery
JP2006248978A (en) 2005-03-10 2006-09-21 Mebiopharm Co Ltd New liposome preparation
CN101209243B (en) * 2006-12-29 2010-12-08 石药集团中奇制药技术(石家庄)有限公司 Liposome medicament and preparation thereof
EP2187869B1 (en) * 2007-08-17 2015-10-14 Celator Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Improved platinum drug formulations
ES2569215T3 (en) 2007-09-10 2016-05-09 Boston Biomedical, Inc. A new group of inhibitors of the Stat3 pathway and inhibitors of the cancer stem cell pathway
TWI468188B (en) * 2008-01-30 2015-01-11 Univ Tokushima Anti-cancer effect enhancers consisting of oxaliplatin liposomal preparations and anticancer agents comprising the formulation
WO2011005769A1 (en) * 2009-07-06 2011-01-13 Variation Biotechnologies, Inc. Methods for preparing vesicles and formulations produced therefrom
US8956600B2 (en) 2009-08-10 2015-02-17 Taiwan Liposome Co. Ltd. Ophthalmic drug delivery system containing phospholipid and cholesterol
WO2011038068A1 (en) 2009-09-23 2011-03-31 Formatech, Inc. Methods for the preparation of liposomes
US10143652B2 (en) * 2009-09-23 2018-12-04 Curirx Inc. Methods for the preparation of liposomes
WO2011102904A1 (en) * 2010-02-19 2011-08-25 Robert Shorr Imageable lipid-oil-water nanoemulsion therapeutic delivery system
PL2547205T3 (en) 2010-03-19 2024-07-08 1Globe Biomedical Co., Ltd. Novel methods for targeting cancer stem cells
EP2558108A1 (en) * 2010-04-12 2013-02-20 Ramot at Tel-Aviv University Ltd Iron oxide nanoparticles for use in treating non-infectious inflammatory disorders
US20130323319A1 (en) 2010-11-12 2013-12-05 Getts Consulting And Project Management Modified immune-modulating particles
WO2012153616A1 (en) * 2011-05-10 2012-11-15 国立大学法人北海道大学 Lipid membrane structure capable of imigrating to target cell and method for producing same, and method for screening for substance exhibiting effect thereof in target cell
US20140161876A1 (en) * 2011-07-15 2014-06-12 Konica Minolta, Inc. Liposome-containing preparation utilizing dissolution aid, and method for producing same
CA2853829C (en) 2011-07-22 2023-09-26 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Evaluation and improvement of nuclease cleavage specificity
SG11201403756PA (en) * 2012-01-01 2014-11-27 Qbi Entpr Ltd Endo180-targeted particles for selective delivery of therapeutic and diagnostic agents
US9717724B2 (en) 2012-06-13 2017-08-01 Ipsen Biopharm Ltd. Methods for treating pancreatic cancer using combination therapies
AU2013202947B2 (en) 2012-06-13 2016-06-02 Ipsen Biopharm Ltd. Methods for treating pancreatic cancer using combination therapies comprising liposomal irinotecan
ES2738481T3 (en) * 2012-06-21 2020-01-23 Univ Northwestern Conjugated peptide particles
SG10201701063WA (en) 2012-08-10 2017-04-27 Taiho Pharmaceutical Co Ltd Stable oxaliplatin-encapsulating liposome aqueous dispersion and method for stabilizing same
KR20150095809A (en) 2012-12-12 2015-08-21 템플 유니버시티-오브 더 커먼웰쓰 시스템 오브 하이어 에듀케이션 Compositions and methods for treatment of cancer
CN103083239B (en) * 2012-12-26 2015-11-25 中国人民解放军第四军医大学 A kind of bufalin liposome and its preparation method and application
TWI726291B (en) 2013-01-07 2021-05-01 英屬維爾京群島商遠東超級實驗室有限公司 Methods and compositions for treatment of bone, skin, subcutaneous, mucosal and/or submucosal cancer by percutaneous and/or transmucosal administration of interferon
US9468681B2 (en) 2013-03-01 2016-10-18 California Institute Of Technology Targeted nanoparticles
BR112015022476A2 (en) * 2013-03-13 2017-07-18 Mallinckrodt Llc Liposome Oxaliplatin Compositions for Cancer Therapy
WO2014160465A2 (en) 2013-03-13 2014-10-02 Cour Pharmaceuticals Development Company Immune-modifying particles for the treatment of inflammation
WO2014169078A2 (en) 2013-04-09 2014-10-16 Boston Biomedical, Inc. Methods for treating cancer
US20150044192A1 (en) 2013-08-09 2015-02-12 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Methods for identifying a target site of a cas9 nuclease
DK3033102T4 (en) 2013-08-13 2024-02-26 Univ Northwestern PEPTIDE CONJUGATED PARTICLES
US9359599B2 (en) 2013-08-22 2016-06-07 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Engineered transcription activator-like effector (TALE) domains and uses thereof
US9737604B2 (en) 2013-09-06 2017-08-22 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Use of cationic lipids to deliver CAS9
US9228207B2 (en) 2013-09-06 2016-01-05 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Switchable gRNAs comprising aptamers
US9388430B2 (en) 2013-09-06 2016-07-12 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Cas9-recombinase fusion proteins and uses thereof
CA2930015A1 (en) 2013-11-07 2015-05-14 Editas Medicine, Inc. Crispr-related methods and compositions with governing grnas
US11053481B2 (en) 2013-12-12 2021-07-06 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Fusions of Cas9 domains and nucleic acid-editing domains
WO2015183357A2 (en) * 2014-02-21 2015-12-03 The Curators Of The University Of Missouri Compositions and methods for boron neutron capture therapy
US10077453B2 (en) 2014-07-30 2018-09-18 President And Fellows Of Harvard College CAS9 proteins including ligand-dependent inteins
US10098813B2 (en) * 2014-09-03 2018-10-16 Sun Pharmaceutical Industries Limited Perfusion dosage form
EP3212165B1 (en) 2014-10-30 2024-02-28 President and Fellows of Harvard College Delivery of negatively charged proteins using cationic lipids
US9816080B2 (en) 2014-10-31 2017-11-14 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Delivery of CAS9 via ARRDC1-mediated microvesicles (ARMMs)
US11318131B2 (en) 2015-05-18 2022-05-03 Ipsen Biopharm Ltd. Nanoliposomal irinotecan for use in treating small cell lung cancer
EP3337467B1 (en) 2015-08-20 2020-12-09 Ipsen Biopharm Ltd. Combination therapy using liposomal irinotecan and a parp inhibitor for cancer treatment
IL257149B1 (en) 2015-08-21 2024-07-01 Ipsen Biopharm Ltd Methods for treating metastatic pancreatic cancer using combination therapies comprising liposomal irinotecan and oxaliplatin
CA3001467A1 (en) 2015-10-16 2017-04-20 Ipsen Biopharm Ltd. Stabilizing camptothecin pharmaceutical compositions
IL294014B2 (en) 2015-10-23 2024-07-01 Harvard College Nucleobase editors and uses thereof
US20180318216A1 (en) * 2015-11-20 2018-11-08 The Regents Of The University Of California Deformable nano-scale vehicles (dnvs) for trans-blood brain barrier, trans-mucosal, and transdermal drug delivery
CN109678910B (en) 2016-01-25 2021-09-07 沈阳药科大学 Compound and application thereof, platinum complex and liposome thereof
WO2017156015A2 (en) 2016-03-07 2017-09-14 The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary, Department Of Health And Human Services Micrornas and methods of their use
WO2017179614A1 (en) * 2016-04-15 2017-10-19 富士フイルム株式会社 Microneedle array
JP7019201B2 (en) * 2016-08-02 2022-02-15 キュリアールエックス インコーポレーテッド Liposome preparation method
IL308426A (en) 2016-08-03 2024-01-01 Harvard College Adenosine nucleobase editors and uses thereof
US11661590B2 (en) 2016-08-09 2023-05-30 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Programmable CAS9-recombinase fusion proteins and uses thereof
CA3033083A1 (en) 2016-08-12 2018-02-15 L.E.A.F. Holdings Group Llc Polyglutamated antifolates and uses thereof
US11542509B2 (en) 2016-08-24 2023-01-03 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Incorporation of unnatural amino acids into proteins using base editing
SG11201903089RA (en) 2016-10-14 2019-05-30 Harvard College Aav delivery of nucleobase editors
BR112019007844A2 (en) 2016-11-02 2019-07-16 Ipsen Biopharm Ltd treatment of gastric cancer using combination therapies comprising liposomal irinotecan, oxaliplatin, 5-fluoroacyl (and leucovorin)
US11339209B2 (en) 2016-11-14 2022-05-24 Novartis Ag Compositions, methods, and therapeutic uses related to fusogenic protein minion
US11299469B2 (en) 2016-11-29 2022-04-12 Sumitomo Dainippon Pharma Oncology, Inc. Naphthofuran derivatives, preparation, and methods of use thereof
WO2018119359A1 (en) 2016-12-23 2018-06-28 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Editing of ccr5 receptor gene to protect against hiv infection
US11898179B2 (en) 2017-03-09 2024-02-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Suppression of pain by gene editing
EP3592777A1 (en) 2017-03-10 2020-01-15 President and Fellows of Harvard College Cytosine to guanine base editor
JP7191388B2 (en) 2017-03-23 2022-12-19 プレジデント アンド フェローズ オブ ハーバード カレッジ Nucleobase editors comprising nucleic acid programmable DNA binding proteins
EP3634385A4 (en) * 2017-05-12 2021-03-03 Curinanorx, LLC Methods for the preparation of liposomes comprising drugs
US11560566B2 (en) 2017-05-12 2023-01-24 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Aptazyme-embedded guide RNAs for use with CRISPR-Cas9 in genome editing and transcriptional activation
CA3062656A1 (en) 2017-05-17 2018-11-22 Boston Biomedical, Inc. Methods for treating cancer
CN111801345A (en) 2017-07-28 2020-10-20 哈佛大学的校长及成员们 Methods and compositions using an evolved base editor for Phage Assisted Continuous Evolution (PACE)
US11319532B2 (en) 2017-08-30 2022-05-03 President And Fellows Of Harvard College High efficiency base editors comprising Gam
CN111757937A (en) 2017-10-16 2020-10-09 布罗德研究所股份有限公司 Use of adenosine base editor
CN111867593A (en) 2018-02-07 2020-10-30 L.E.A.F.控股集团公司 Alpha polyglutamated antifolate agent and its use
US11730738B2 (en) 2018-02-07 2023-08-22 L.E.A.F. Holdings Group Llc Alpha polyglutamated pralatrexate and uses thereof
CN111954531A (en) 2018-02-07 2020-11-17 L.E.A.F.控股集团公司 Alpha polyglutamated pemetrexed and its use
CA3090875A1 (en) 2018-02-14 2019-08-22 L.E.A.F. Holdings Group Llc Gamma polyglutamated lometrexol and uses thereof
CA3090992A1 (en) 2018-02-14 2019-08-22 L.E.A.F. Holdings Group Llc Gamma polyglutamated tetrahydrofolates and uses thereof
WO2019160736A1 (en) 2018-02-14 2019-08-22 L.E.A.F. Holdings Group Llc Gamma polyglutamated pralatrexate and uses thereof
US20210361575A1 (en) * 2018-04-11 2021-11-25 New Mexico Tech University Research Park Corporation Lipid prodrugs for use in drug delivery
CN108524450A (en) * 2018-04-16 2018-09-14 温州医科大学 Oxaliplatin and MDC1-AS based on magnetic temperature-sensitive cationic-liposome transmit the preparation and application of pharmaceutical carrier altogether
US20190381188A1 (en) 2018-06-13 2019-12-19 California Institute Of Technology Nanoparticles For Crossing The Blood Brain Barrier And Methods Of Treatment Using The Same
CN113453702A (en) 2018-09-28 2021-09-28 哈佛大学的校长及成员们 Cell reprogramming to reverse senescence and promote tissue and tissue regeneration
HRP20240586T1 (en) 2018-10-09 2024-07-19 The University Of British Columbia Compositions and systems comprising transfection-competent vesicles free of organic-solvents and detergents and methods related thereto
CN111721841B (en) * 2019-03-19 2022-07-12 海南长安国际制药有限公司 Detection of lobaplatin-related substances
WO2020191243A1 (en) 2019-03-19 2020-09-24 The Broad Institute, Inc. Methods and compositions for editing nucleotide sequences
CN110292563B (en) * 2019-06-12 2021-07-16 兰州大学 Method for inducing cancer cell apoptosis by using folic acid heat-sensitive liposome-based anion carrier
WO2021178987A1 (en) * 2020-03-04 2021-09-10 Siemens Healthcare Diagnostics Inc. Compositions and methods of using modified liposomes
KR20230023612A (en) 2020-04-02 2023-02-17 마이레큘, 인크. Targeted inhibition using engineered oligonucleotides
DE112021002672T5 (en) 2020-05-08 2023-04-13 President And Fellows Of Harvard College METHODS AND COMPOSITIONS FOR EDIT BOTH STRANDS SIMULTANEOUSLY OF A DOUBLE STRANDED NUCLEOTIDE TARGET SEQUENCE
CN112129871B (en) * 2020-09-04 2021-06-15 斯微(上海)生物科技有限公司 Method for detecting contents of DOPE and M5 phospholipids in composite phospholipid liposome
CN112870164B (en) * 2021-01-25 2021-12-17 山东大学 Double-targeting drug-loaded liposome and preparation method and application thereof
WO2023196851A1 (en) 2022-04-06 2023-10-12 President And Fellows Of Harvard College Reversing aging of the central nervous system

Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7582430B2 (en) * 2004-01-20 2009-09-01 United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Army Immunoliposome-nucleic acid amplification (ILNAA) assay

Family Cites Families (158)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
JPS6041077B2 (en) 1976-09-06 1985-09-13 喜徳 喜谷 Cis platinum(2) complex of 1,2-diaminocyclohexane isomer
US4235871A (en) 1978-02-24 1980-11-25 Papahadjopoulos Demetrios P Method of encapsulating biologically active materials in lipid vesicles
GR75598B (en) 1980-04-29 1984-08-01 Sanofi Sa
US4534899A (en) 1981-07-20 1985-08-13 Lipid Specialties, Inc. Synthetic phospholipid compounds
US4565696A (en) 1983-08-03 1986-01-21 The Regents Of The University Of California Production of immunogens by antigen conjugation to liposomes
US4789633A (en) 1984-04-19 1988-12-06 University Of Tennessee Research Corporation Fused liposome and acid induced method for liposome fusion
US4925661A (en) 1984-04-19 1990-05-15 Leaf Huang Target-specific cytotoxic liposomes
US5736155A (en) 1984-08-08 1998-04-07 The Liposome Company, Inc. Encapsulation of antineoplastic agents in liposomes
US4762915A (en) * 1985-01-18 1988-08-09 Liposome Technology, Inc. Protein-liposome conjugates
EP0211042A1 (en) * 1985-01-18 1987-02-25 Cooper-Lipotech, Inc. Liposome composition and method
US5026651A (en) 1985-04-25 1991-06-25 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Methods and compositions for the production of human transferrin
PH26160A (en) * 1985-08-19 1992-03-18 Univ Texas Pharmaceutical compositions consisting of acylated phospholipids
US4983397A (en) 1985-08-19 1991-01-08 Board Of Regents, University Of Texas System Pharmaceutical compositions consisting of acylated phospholipids
US5384127A (en) 1985-10-18 1995-01-24 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Stable liposomal formulations of lipophilic platinum compounds
JPH0714865B2 (en) 1986-10-28 1995-02-22 武田薬品工業株式会社 Liposome preparation and method for producing the same
US5049390A (en) 1987-09-02 1991-09-17 Allergy Immuno Technologies, Inc. Liposome containing immunotherapy agents for treating IgE mediated allergies
US4853224A (en) 1987-12-22 1989-08-01 Visionex Biodegradable ocular implants
FR2631826B1 (en) 1988-05-27 1992-06-19 Centre Nat Rech Scient PARTICULATE VECTOR USEFUL IN PARTICULAR FOR THE TRANSPORT OF BIOLOGICALLY ACTIVATED MOLECULES AND METHOD FOR THE PREPARATION THEREOF
JPH0720857B2 (en) 1988-08-11 1995-03-08 テルモ株式会社 Liposome and its manufacturing method
DK0436717T3 (en) 1989-08-02 2003-05-05 Mitra Medical Technology Ab System for use in a method of therapeutic or diagnostic treatment
US5013556A (en) 1989-10-20 1991-05-07 Liposome Technology, Inc. Liposomes with enhanced circulation time
DK0555317T3 (en) * 1990-10-09 1995-08-07 Nexstar Pharmaceuticals Inc Phospholipid analog vesicle with a succinimidyl substituent
US5554728A (en) 1991-07-23 1996-09-10 Nexstar Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Lipid conjugates of therapeutic peptides and protease inhibitors
US6509032B1 (en) 1991-08-28 2003-01-21 Mcmaster University Cationic amphiphiles
US5292524A (en) 1991-09-06 1994-03-08 California Institute Of Technology Blood platelet loaded with diagnostic or therapeutic-containing liposome or reconstituted Sendai virus
JPH0776230B2 (en) 1992-01-13 1995-08-16 田中貴金属工業株式会社 Method for producing platinum compound
JPH06287021A (en) 1992-04-22 1994-10-11 Tanaka Kikinzoku Kogyo Kk Optical resolution of optically active platinum complex compound
JP2673331B2 (en) 1993-01-12 1997-11-05 田中貴金属工業 株式会社 Optically pure cis-oxalate (trans-1-1,2-cyclohexanediamine) platinum (▲ II ▼)
US20030190638A1 (en) 1992-05-13 2003-10-09 Board Of Regents, The University Of Texas System Methods of screening for compounds that derepress or increase telomerase activity
US5962316A (en) 1992-10-16 1999-10-05 Cold Spring Harbor Laboratory Cell-cycle regulatory proteins, and uses related thereto
US20030100489A1 (en) 1992-10-16 2003-05-29 Beach David H. Cell-cycle regulatory proteins, and uses related thereto
AU6833994A (en) 1993-05-17 1994-12-12 Liposome Company, Inc., The Incorporation of taxol into liposomes and gels
JP3025602B2 (en) 1993-05-21 2000-03-27 デビオファーム エス.アー. Method for producing optically high purity cis-oxalate (trans-l-l, 2-cyclohexanediamine) platinum (II) complex
US5534241A (en) 1993-07-23 1996-07-09 Torchilin; Vladimir P. Amphipathic polychelating compounds and methods of use
AU683698B2 (en) * 1993-10-06 1997-11-20 Amgen, Inc. Stable protein: phospholipid compositions and methods
WO1995016774A1 (en) 1993-12-17 1995-06-22 Spinal Cord Society Method for inducing dna synthesis in neurons
US6057299A (en) 1994-01-13 2000-05-02 Calydon, Inc. Tissue-specific enhancer active in prostate
US5830686A (en) 1994-01-13 1998-11-03 Calydon Tissue-specific enhancer active in prostate
JP3590983B2 (en) * 1994-03-04 2004-11-17 日本油脂株式会社 Phospholipid derivatives
DE69527194T2 (en) 1994-03-28 2003-02-06 Daiichi Pharmaceutical Co., Ltd. LIPOSOME CONTAINING AN X-RAY OR ULTRASONIC CONTRAST
ATE187160T1 (en) 1994-07-29 1999-12-15 Abbott Lab METHOD FOR PRODUCING A SUBSTITUTED 2,5-DIAMINO-3-HYDROXY HEXANES
KR100365171B1 (en) 1994-08-08 2003-02-19 드바이오팜 에스.아. Pharmaceutically stable oxaliplatinum preparation
ATE198419T1 (en) * 1994-10-14 2001-01-15 Liposome Co Inc ETHERLIPID LIPOSOMES AND THEIR THERAPEUTIC USE
DE69531722T2 (en) 1994-11-11 2004-07-01 Debiopharm S.A. Carcinostatic compositions containing cis-oxaliplatin and one or more other compatible carcinostats
US5786214A (en) 1994-12-15 1998-07-28 Spinal Cord Society pH-sensitive immunoliposomes and method of gene delivery to the mammalian central nervous system
US5580899A (en) * 1995-01-09 1996-12-03 The Liposome Company, Inc. Hydrophobic taxane derivatives
US6008202A (en) 1995-01-23 1999-12-28 University Of Pittsburgh Stable lipid-comprising drug delivery complexes and methods for their production
TW319763B (en) 1995-02-01 1997-11-11 Epix Medical Inc
US5780052A (en) 1995-04-24 1998-07-14 Northeastern University Compositions and methods useful for inhibiting cell death and for delivering an agent into a cell
US5834012A (en) * 1995-05-03 1998-11-10 Roman Perez-Soler Lipid complexed topoisomerase I inhibitors
US20020022264A1 (en) 1995-05-26 2002-02-21 Sullivan Sean M. Delivery vehicles comprising stable lipid/nucleic acid complexes
US6825174B2 (en) 1995-06-07 2004-11-30 East Carolina University Composition, formulations & method for prevention & treatment of diseases and conditions associated with bronchoconstriction, allergy(ies) & inflammation
JPH09278785A (en) 1996-04-10 1997-10-28 Tanaka Kikinzoku Kogyo Kk Production of platinum compound
FR2740686B1 (en) 1995-11-03 1998-01-16 Sanofi Sa STABLE LYOPHILIZED PHARMACEUTICAL FORMULATION
US6428977B1 (en) 1995-12-20 2002-08-06 Curis, Inc. Signalin family of TGFβ signal transduction proteins, and uses related thereto
JP3735921B2 (en) 1996-02-07 2006-01-18 三菱ウェルファーマ株式会社 GPIb / lipid complex and uses thereof
JP4512882B2 (en) 1996-02-09 2010-07-28 チェング ピー―ワン Delivery of bioactive molecules facilitated by receptor ligands
AU2163797A (en) 1996-03-11 1997-10-01 Debiopharm S.A. Binuclear platinum complexes, method for preparing same and pharmaceutical compositions containing said complexes
AU2549297A (en) 1996-03-28 1997-10-17 Board Of Trustees Of The University Of Illinois, The Materials and methods for making improved echogenic liposome compositions
JP3154399B2 (en) 1996-07-04 2001-04-09 デビオファーム エス.アー. Method for producing platinum compound
US6228391B1 (en) 1996-05-02 2001-05-08 Terumo Kabushiki Kaisha Amidine derivatives and drug carriers comprising the same
ES2208946T3 (en) 1996-08-23 2004-06-16 Sequus Pharmaceuticals, Inc. LIPOSOMES CONTAINING A CISPLATIN COMPOUND.
TW520297B (en) * 1996-10-11 2003-02-11 Sequus Pharm Inc Fusogenic liposome composition and method
US6056973A (en) 1996-10-11 2000-05-02 Sequus Pharmaceuticals, Inc. Therapeutic liposome composition and method of preparation
WO1998016240A1 (en) * 1996-10-15 1998-04-23 The Liposome Company, Inc. Peptide-lipid conjugates, liposomes and liposomal drug delivery
SK283760B6 (en) * 1996-10-15 2004-01-08 The Liposome Company, Inc. Pharmaceutical composition for delivery of bioactive agents
AU5729898A (en) 1996-12-18 1998-07-15 Emory University Polycationic oligomers
BR9808221A (en) 1997-03-07 2000-05-16 Sanofi Winthrop Inc Tumor treatment method.
DE19709704C2 (en) 1997-03-10 1999-11-04 Michael Georgieff Use of a liquid preparation of xenon for intravenous administration when inducing and / or maintaining anesthesia
JPH10253632A (en) 1997-03-10 1998-09-25 Nissui Pharm Co Ltd Method, kit and device for analysis
US6120751A (en) * 1997-03-21 2000-09-19 Imarx Pharmaceutical Corp. Charged lipids and uses for the same
US6060082A (en) 1997-04-18 2000-05-09 Massachusetts Institute Of Technology Polymerized liposomes targeted to M cells and useful for oral or mucosal drug delivery
US6524613B1 (en) 1997-04-30 2003-02-25 Regents Of The University Of Minnesota Hepatocellular chimeraplasty
US6272370B1 (en) 1998-08-07 2001-08-07 The Regents Of University Of Minnesota MR-visible medical device for neurological interventions using nonlinear magnetic stereotaxis and a method imaging
AU7984498A (en) 1997-06-25 1999-01-04 Government Of The United States Of America, As Represented By The Secretary Of The Department Of Health And Human Services, The Serum-free cell growth medium
CA2297103A1 (en) 1997-07-15 1999-01-28 The Regents Of The University Of California Isolated dna encoding human calcium activated potassium channel
DE69838584T2 (en) 1997-08-04 2008-06-26 Cell Genesys, Inc., Foster City ENHANCERS OF HUMAN GLANDULAR CALLIQUE, VECTORS CONTAINING HIM, AND METHODS FOR ITS USE
IL134985A0 (en) 1997-10-02 2001-05-20 Epix Medical Inc A method for contrast enhanced diagnostic imaging
US6749863B1 (en) 1997-11-19 2004-06-15 Georgetown University Targeted liposome gene delivery
US6320017B1 (en) 1997-12-23 2001-11-20 Inex Pharmaceuticals Corp. Polyamide oligomers
WO1999041403A1 (en) 1998-02-12 1999-08-19 The Regents Of The University Of California Compositions for receptor/liposome mediated transfection and methods of using same
GB9804013D0 (en) 1998-02-25 1998-04-22 Sanofi Sa Formulations
US6245427B1 (en) 1998-07-06 2001-06-12 DüZGüNES NEJAT Non-ligand polypeptide and liposome complexes as intracellular delivery vehicles
AU762138B2 (en) 1998-10-14 2003-06-19 Debiopharm S.A. Oxaliplatinum preparation packaging
US6723338B1 (en) 1999-04-01 2004-04-20 Inex Pharmaceuticals Corporation Compositions and methods for treating lymphoma
US7311924B2 (en) 1999-04-01 2007-12-25 Hana Biosciences, Inc. Compositions and methods for treating cancer
AU5136100A (en) 1999-05-17 2000-12-05 Avi Biopharma, Inc. Combined approach to treatment of cancer with hcg vaccines
JP2001002592A (en) 1999-06-18 2001-01-09 Dai Ichi Seiyaku Co Ltd Composition for gene-transducing
US6280054B1 (en) * 1999-07-02 2001-08-28 Zight Corporation Image generator having an improved illumination system
US6242188B1 (en) 1999-07-30 2001-06-05 Applied Gene Technologies, Inc. Sample processing to release nucleic acids for direct detection
WO2001011826A1 (en) * 1999-08-09 2001-02-15 Fujitsu Limited Package control device and method
BRPI0013613B8 (en) 1999-08-30 2021-05-25 Debiopharm Sa pharmaceutically stable composition of oxaliplatin for parenteral administration.
CA2733819A1 (en) 1999-12-30 2001-07-12 Judith K. Gwathmey Iron chelator delivery system
CN101041079A (en) 1999-12-30 2007-09-26 诺瓦提斯公司 Novel colloid synthetic vectors for gene therapy
WO2001051003A2 (en) * 2000-01-10 2001-07-19 Yissum Research Development Company Of The Hebrew University Of Jerusalem Use of lipid conjugates in the treatment of disease
US6530944B2 (en) 2000-02-08 2003-03-11 Rice University Optically-active nanoparticles for use in therapeutic and diagnostic methods
US7001735B2 (en) 2000-03-01 2006-02-21 Albert Einstein College Of Medicine Of Yeshiva University Glucose transporter/sensor protein and uses thereof
AU2001236062A1 (en) 2000-03-02 2001-09-12 Yasuo Ikeda Gpib-lipid bond construct and use thereof
JP4449147B2 (en) 2000-03-22 2010-04-14 日油株式会社 Method for producing phosphatidylethanolamine derivative
FR2806727A1 (en) 2000-03-23 2001-09-28 Pf Medicament MOLECULE OF PHARMACEUTICAL INTEREST COMPRISING IN THE N-TERMINAL END A GLUTAMIC ACID OR GLUTAMINE IN THE FORM OF A PHYSIOLOGICALLY ACCEPTABLE ACID ADDITION SALT
DE60132184T2 (en) 2000-04-12 2009-01-15 Liplasome Pharma A/S LIPIDEN-BASED DRUG DISPENSING SYSTEMS AGAINST PARASITIC INFECTIONS
EP1278512A2 (en) 2000-05-03 2003-01-29 MBT Munich Biotechnology AG Cationic diagnostic, imaging and therapeutic agents associated with activated vascular sites
US20030059461A1 (en) 2000-06-06 2003-03-27 Sibtech, Inc. Molecular delivery vehicle for delivery of selected compounds to targets
US20030072794A1 (en) 2000-06-09 2003-04-17 Teni Boulikas Encapsulation of plasmid DNA (lipogenes™) and therapeutic agents with nuclear localization signal/fusogenic peptide conjugates into targeted liposome complexes
EP1370572B1 (en) 2000-09-11 2008-11-26 Institut Pasteur Mitochondrial membrane permeabilization by hiv-1 vpr and methods of screening
US20040234588A1 (en) 2000-09-21 2004-11-25 University Of Georgia Research Foundation, Inc. Artificial lipoprotein carrier system for bioactive materials
EP1324758B1 (en) 2000-10-03 2005-01-12 Debiopharm S.A. Plga/pla-type polymer microspheres encapsulating a water-soluble substance and process thereof
US20030129223A1 (en) * 2000-10-11 2003-07-10 Targesome, Inc. Targeted multivalent macromolecules
WO2002041870A2 (en) * 2000-11-22 2002-05-30 Vectron Therapeutics Ag Production and use of a targeted diagnostic system
US7012072B2 (en) * 2000-12-12 2006-03-14 Debiopharm S.A. Pharmaceutical oxaliplatinum preparation for parenteral administration and method for obtaining same
CN1559007A (en) 2000-12-12 2004-12-29 澳大利亚海洋科学研究院 Assay for paralytic shellfish toxin
US6897196B1 (en) 2001-02-07 2005-05-24 The Regents Of The University Of California pH sensitive lipids based on ortho ester linkers, composition and method
US6703524B2 (en) 2001-02-20 2004-03-09 Lkt Laboratories, Inc. Organoselenium compounds for cancer chemoprevention
EP1368022B1 (en) 2001-03-02 2007-06-20 Debiopharm S.A. Use of a vial containing an oxaliplatinum solution
FI113840B (en) 2001-03-26 2004-06-30 Ctt Cancer Targeting Tech Oy Use of matrix metalloproteinase inhibitors in targeting liposomes
US20040049022A1 (en) 2001-04-24 2004-03-11 Nyce Jonathan W. Composition & methods for treatment and screening
JP2004535388A (en) 2001-04-30 2004-11-25 ターゲティッド ジェネティクス コーポレイション Lipid-containing drug delivery conjugates and methods for their production
US20030082228A1 (en) 2001-05-09 2003-05-01 Inex Pharmaceuticals Corporation Anti-angiogenic therapy using liposome-encapsulated chemotherapeutic agents
US20030108986A1 (en) 2001-06-21 2003-06-12 Euroscreen, S.A. Compositions and methods comprising G-protein coupled receptors
WO2003004505A1 (en) 2001-07-02 2003-01-16 Debiopharm S.A. Oxaliplatin active substance with a very low content of oxalic acid
US20030096299A1 (en) 2001-07-09 2003-05-22 Valerie Wittamer Natural ligand of G protein coupled receptor ChemR23 and uses thereof
EP1424898A4 (en) 2001-08-20 2008-04-02 Transave Inc Treatment of cancers by inhalation of stable platinum-containing formulations
DE10144252A1 (en) 2001-08-31 2003-03-27 Fraunhofer Ges Forschung Nanoparticles with biologically active TNF immobilized on them
AU2002330139A1 (en) 2001-10-03 2003-04-14 Vanderbilt University In vivo panning for ligands to radiation-induced molecules
WO2003044214A2 (en) 2001-11-20 2003-05-30 Baylor College Of Medicine Methods and compositions in checkpoint signaling
JP4468617B2 (en) 2001-12-04 2010-05-26 デビオファーム エス.アー. Method for concomitant administration of anticancer agents and anticancer agents that can be used in combination
US6476068B1 (en) 2001-12-06 2002-11-05 Pharmacia Italia, S.P.A. Platinum derivative pharmaceutical formulations
JP4360915B2 (en) 2002-01-07 2009-11-11 ユーロスクリーン・ソシエテ・アノニム G protein-coupled receptor GPR43 ligand and use thereof
US20030220284A1 (en) 2002-02-22 2003-11-27 Patricia Yotnda Delivery of adenoviral DNA in a liposomal formulation for treatment of disease
US7282567B2 (en) 2002-06-14 2007-10-16 Immunomedics, Inc. Monoclonal antibody hPAM4
CN102174108B (en) 2002-03-01 2016-06-29 免疫医疗公司 The anti-CD74 antibody of internalization and using method
EP1587944A4 (en) 2002-03-01 2007-03-21 Dyax Corp Kdr and vegf/kdr binding peptides and their use in diagnosis and therapy
WO2003082907A1 (en) 2002-03-29 2003-10-09 Euroscreen Sa Ligands for g protein coupled receptor gpr7 and uses thereof
CA2391438A1 (en) 2002-05-01 2003-11-01 Procyon Biopharma Inc. Psp94 diagnostic reagents and assays
US20030228285A1 (en) 2002-05-03 2003-12-11 Mien-Chie Hung Bipartite T-cell factor (Tcf)-responsive promoter
US7460960B2 (en) 2002-05-10 2008-12-02 Epitome Biosystems, Inc. Proteome epitope tags and methods of use thereof in protein modification analysis
US20040022842A1 (en) 2002-06-03 2004-02-05 Mebiopharm Co., Ltd. Liposome preparations containing oxaliplatin
JP3415131B1 (en) 2002-06-03 2003-06-09 メビオファーム株式会社 Liposome preparation
FR2840236B1 (en) 2002-06-03 2005-02-04 Inst Francais Du Petrole ZEOLITHIC MEMBRANE OF LOW THICKNESS, ITS PREPARATION AND USE IN SEPARATION
AU2003244766A1 (en) 2002-06-07 2003-12-22 Immunomedics, Inc. Neutrophil imaging methods in cyctic fibrosis
AU2003250367A1 (en) 2002-06-14 2003-12-31 Immunomedics, Inc. Monoclonal antibody pam4 and its use for diagnosis and therapy of pancreatic cancer
US6790632B2 (en) 2002-06-17 2004-09-14 Stephen Eliot Zweig Membrane receptor reagent and assay
EP2823809B1 (en) 2002-06-28 2016-11-02 Protiva Biotherapeutics Inc. Method and apparatus for producing liposomes
CA2494310A1 (en) 2002-08-01 2004-02-12 Immunomedics, Inc. Alpha-fetoprotein immu31 antibodies and fusion proteins and methods of use thereof
US20040132652A1 (en) 2002-08-30 2004-07-08 Shire Biochem Inc. Pharmaceutical compositions
AU2003290876A1 (en) 2002-11-14 2004-06-15 Kirk Sperber Induction of apoptosis by hiv-1 infected monocytic cells
WO2004045583A1 (en) 2002-11-15 2004-06-03 Nipro Corporation Liposome
AU2003277641B2 (en) 2003-02-17 2009-09-17 Mebiopharm Co., Ltd. Remedy for cancer
US20050003403A1 (en) 2003-04-22 2005-01-06 Rossi Edmund A. Polyvalent protein complex
CA2529027C (en) 2003-06-13 2013-09-10 Immunomedics, Inc. D-amino acid peptides
CA2534639C (en) 2003-07-31 2013-07-30 Immunomedics, Inc. Anti-cd19 antibodies
JP2005154282A (en) 2003-11-20 2005-06-16 Mebiopharm Co Ltd Method for producing gas-sealed liposome
US7212869B2 (en) * 2004-02-04 2007-05-01 Medtronic, Inc. Lead retention means
EP1579850A3 (en) 2004-03-15 2009-12-16 Nipro Corporation A pharmaceutical composition containing liposomes for treating a cancer
JP2006248978A (en) 2005-03-10 2006-09-21 Mebiopharm Co Ltd New liposome preparation
WO2008030818A2 (en) 2006-09-05 2008-03-13 Mebiopharm Co., Ltd. Novel liposome compositions
JP5345792B2 (en) 2008-02-19 2013-11-20 テイ・エス テック株式会社 Vehicle storage seat
JP5331648B2 (en) 2009-10-22 2013-10-30 株式会社日立製作所 How to modify a pulverized coal boiler

Patent Citations (1)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US7582430B2 (en) * 2004-01-20 2009-09-01 United States Of America As Represented By The Secretary Of The Army Immunoliposome-nucleic acid amplification (ILNAA) assay

Cited By (8)

* Cited by examiner, † Cited by third party
Publication number Priority date Publication date Assignee Title
US20140271821A1 (en) * 2013-03-13 2014-09-18 Mallinckrodt Llc Liposomal cisplatin compositions for cancer therapy
US10039716B2 (en) * 2013-03-13 2018-08-07 Mallinckrodt Llc Liposomal cisplatin compositions for cancer therapy
US20180318219A1 (en) * 2013-03-13 2018-11-08 Mallinckrodt Llc Liposomal cisplatin compositions for cancer therapy
US10383823B2 (en) * 2013-03-13 2019-08-20 Mallinckrodt Llc Liposomal cisplatin compositions for cancer therapy
US10988496B2 (en) 2015-06-24 2021-04-27 Nippon Kayaku Kabushiki Kaisha Platinum (IV) complex
US10596191B2 (en) 2015-09-14 2020-03-24 Nippon Kayaku Kabushiki Kaisha Polymer conjugate of hexa-coordinated platinum complex
US11033577B2 (en) 2015-09-14 2021-06-15 Nippon Kayaku Kabushiki Kaisha Polymer conjugate of hexa-coordinated platinum complex
US10946028B2 (en) 2015-12-22 2021-03-16 Nippon Kayaku Kabushiki Kaisha Polymer conjugate of sulfoxide derivative-coordinated platinum(II) complex

Also Published As

Publication number Publication date
AU2006223329A1 (en) 2006-09-21
SI1863448T1 (en) 2015-03-31
ES2529453T3 (en) 2015-02-20
PT1863448E (en) 2015-02-10
KR101352490B1 (en) 2014-02-04
US20060222696A1 (en) 2006-10-05
US20110081404A1 (en) 2011-04-07
JP5438317B2 (en) 2014-03-12
JP2006248978A (en) 2006-09-21
CA2600446A1 (en) 2006-09-21
HUE024290T2 (en) 2016-01-28
EP1863448A2 (en) 2007-12-12
NO20075136L (en) 2007-12-07
NZ561569A (en) 2011-03-31
CN101170995B (en) 2013-01-16
AU2006223329B2 (en) 2011-11-17
RU2007137492A (en) 2009-04-20
PL1863448T3 (en) 2015-05-29
US8758810B2 (en) 2014-06-24
BRPI0608297A2 (en) 2009-12-08
JP2008538105A (en) 2008-10-09
CN101170995A (en) 2008-04-30
EP1863448B1 (en) 2014-11-26
DK1863448T3 (en) 2015-02-16
RU2454229C2 (en) 2012-06-27
KR20080002819A (en) 2008-01-04
CY1116075T1 (en) 2017-02-08
MX2007010996A (en) 2007-11-07
HK1111625A1 (en) 2008-08-15
US7829113B2 (en) 2010-11-09
ZA200708600B (en) 2009-01-28
WO2006099169A3 (en) 2007-02-22
WO2006099169A2 (en) 2006-09-21

Similar Documents

Publication Publication Date Title
US7829113B2 (en) Liposome compositions
WO2008030818A2 (en) Novel liposome compositions
JP7555630B2 (en) Carotenoid Compositions and Uses Thereof
CA2193502C (en) Sphingosomes for enhanced drug delivery
AU2005304914B2 (en) Compositions and methods for stabilizing liposomal camptothecin formulations
EP2611421B1 (en) Nanoparticle-based tumor-targeted drug delivery
US20110002977A1 (en) Liposomal pharmaceutical preparation and method for manufacturing the same
KR20090023548A (en) Cancer tretments
JP2010235634A (en) Liposomal formulation
WO2013008240A2 (en) Liposomes co-encapsulating a bisphosphonate and an amphipathic agent
Qu et al. Targeted delivery of doxorubicin via CD147-mediated ROS/pH dual-sensitive nanomicelles for the efficient therapy of hepatocellular carcinoma
EP1813288B1 (en) Medicinal composition, medicinal preparation, and combination preparation
Maher Harnessing nanomedicine to potentiate the chemo-immuno-2 therapeutic effects of doxorubicin and alendronate co-encapsu-3 lated in pegylated liposomes
EA047345B1 (en) CAROTENOID COMPOSITION AND METHOD FOR ITS OBTAINING
US20160184227A1 (en) Methods and compositions for improving outcomes of liposomal chemotherapy

Legal Events

Date Code Title Description
AS Assignment

Owner name: MEBIOPHARM CO., LTD., JAPAN

Free format text: ASSIGNMENT OF ASSIGNORS INTEREST;ASSIGNORS:OKADA, KAZUSHI;IBUKI, TADAYUKI;KIM, DONGHYUN;AND OTHERS;REEL/FRAME:032988/0656

Effective date: 20060410

STCB Information on status: application discontinuation

Free format text: ABANDONED -- FAILURE TO PAY ISSUE FEE